* i386.c (has_dispatch): Disable for Ryzen.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobe97ceb61b46ed6cedcae8f424b3c05786be96b34
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 This file is part of GCC.
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "memmodel.h"
66 #include "tm_p.h"
67 #include "stringpool.h"
68 #include "insn-config.h"
69 #include "ira.h"
70 #include "cgraph.h"
71 #include "diagnostic.h"
72 #include "fold-const.h"
73 #include "stor-layout.h"
74 #include "varasm.h"
75 #include "version.h"
76 #include "flags.h"
77 #include "rtlhash.h"
78 #include "reload.h"
79 #include "output.h"
80 #include "expr.h"
81 #include "dwarf2out.h"
82 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
83 #include "toplev.h"
84 #include "md5.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "common/common-target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "lra.h"
90 #include "dumpfile.h"
91 #include "opts.h"
92 #include "tree-dfa.h"
93 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
94 #include "rtl-iter.h"
95 #include "stringpool.h"
96 #include "attribs.h"
98 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, unsigned int, const char *,
99 int, bool);
100 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
101 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
102 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
104 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
105 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
106 #endif
108 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
109 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
110 #endif
112 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
113 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
115 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
116 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
117 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
118 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
119 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
120 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
121 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
122 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
123 #else
124 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
125 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
126 #endif
128 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
129 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
130 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
131 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
132 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
133 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
134 #endif
136 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
137 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
138 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
139 #endif
141 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
142 must be kept around forever. */
143 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
145 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
146 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
147 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
148 it. */
149 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
151 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
152 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
153 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
154 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
155 define type declaration DIE's. */
156 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
158 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
166 static const char *debug_macinfo_section_name;
167 static unsigned macinfo_label_base = 1;
168 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
169 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
172 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
173 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
174 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_str_section;
175 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
180 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
181 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 40
183 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
184 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
185 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
186 bytes.
188 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
189 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
191 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
192 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
193 #endif
195 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR
196 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "-4" : "-12")
197 #endif
199 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
200 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
201 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
203 /* CIE identifier. */
204 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
205 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
206 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
207 #else
208 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
209 #endif
212 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
213 information for each routine. */
214 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
215 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
217 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
219 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
220 const char *str;
221 unsigned int refcount;
222 enum dwarf_form form;
223 char *label;
224 unsigned int index;
227 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
229 typedef const char *compare_type;
231 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
232 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
235 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
237 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_line_str_hash;
239 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
240 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
241 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
243 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
244 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
246 2) Strings can use four forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp,
247 DW_FORM_line_strp or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
249 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
250 reference count.
252 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
253 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
254 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
255 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
256 that need it. */
258 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
260 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
262 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
263 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
265 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
267 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
268 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
270 /* The default cold text section. */
271 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
273 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
274 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
276 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
277 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
279 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
281 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
282 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
284 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
285 personality CFI. */
286 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
288 /* .debug_rnglists next index. */
289 static unsigned int rnglist_idx;
291 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
292 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
293 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
295 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
296 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
297 #endif
299 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
300 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
301 #endif
303 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
304 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
305 #endif
307 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
308 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
309 #endif
311 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
312 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
313 #endif
315 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
316 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
317 #endif
318 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
319 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
320 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
321 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
322 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
323 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
324 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
325 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
326 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
327 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
329 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
331 static int
332 matches_main_base (const char *path)
334 /* Cache the last query. */
335 static const char *last_path = NULL;
336 static int last_match = 0;
337 if (path != last_path)
339 const char *base;
340 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
341 last_path = path;
342 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
343 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
345 return last_match;
348 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
350 static int
351 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
352 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
353 int matches, int result)
355 /* Find the type name. */
356 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
357 tree t = type_decl;
358 const char *name = 0;
359 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
360 t = DECL_NAME (t);
361 if (t)
362 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
364 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
365 criterion,
366 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
367 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
368 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
369 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
370 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
371 result,
372 (void*) type_decl, name);
373 return result;
375 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
376 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
378 #else
380 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
381 (result)
383 #endif
385 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
386 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
387 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
389 static unsigned int
390 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
392 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
393 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
394 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
397 static bool
398 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
400 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
401 tree type_decl;
402 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
404 if (generic)
405 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
406 else
407 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
409 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
410 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
411 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
412 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
414 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
416 if (type_decl != NULL)
418 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
419 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
421 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
422 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
425 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
428 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
429 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
430 for collect2 the first time around. */
432 static void
433 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
435 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
437 int flags;
439 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
441 int fde_encoding;
442 int per_encoding;
443 int lsda_encoding;
445 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
446 /*global=*/0);
447 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
448 /*global=*/1);
449 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
450 /*global=*/0);
451 flags = ((! flag_pic
452 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
453 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
454 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
455 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
456 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
457 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
458 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
460 else
461 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
463 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
464 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
465 #else
466 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
467 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
468 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
471 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
473 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
474 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
475 collect2. */
476 if (!back)
478 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
479 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
480 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
481 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
482 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
484 #endif
487 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
488 FOR_EH. */
490 static void
491 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
493 if (for_eh)
494 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
495 else
497 if (!debug_frame_section)
498 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
499 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
500 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
504 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
506 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
507 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
509 switch (cfi)
511 case DW_CFA_nop:
512 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
513 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
514 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
515 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
517 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
518 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
519 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
520 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
521 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
522 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
524 case DW_CFA_offset:
525 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
526 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
527 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
528 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
529 case DW_CFA_restore:
530 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
531 case DW_CFA_undefined:
532 case DW_CFA_same_value:
533 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
534 case DW_CFA_register:
535 case DW_CFA_expression:
536 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
537 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
539 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
540 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
541 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
542 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
544 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
545 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
547 default:
548 gcc_unreachable ();
552 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
554 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
555 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
557 switch (cfi)
559 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
560 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
561 case DW_CFA_offset:
562 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
563 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
564 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
566 case DW_CFA_register:
567 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
569 case DW_CFA_expression:
570 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
571 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
573 default:
574 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
578 /* Output one FDE. */
580 static void
581 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
582 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
583 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
585 const char *begin, *end;
586 static unsigned int j;
587 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
589 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
590 /* empty */ 0);
591 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
592 for_eh + j);
593 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
595 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
597 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
598 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
599 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
600 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
601 "FDE Length");
603 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
605 if (for_eh)
606 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
607 else
608 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
609 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
611 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
612 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
614 if (for_eh)
616 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
617 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
618 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
619 "FDE initial location");
620 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
621 end, begin, "FDE address range");
623 else
625 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
626 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
629 if (augmentation[0])
631 if (any_lsda_needed)
633 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
635 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
637 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
638 + 4 /* CIE offset */
639 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
640 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
641 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
643 size += pad;
644 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
647 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
649 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
651 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
652 fde->funcdef_number);
653 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
654 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
655 false,
656 "Language Specific Data Area");
658 else
660 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
661 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
662 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
663 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
666 else
667 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
670 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
671 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
673 size_t from, until, i;
675 from = 0;
676 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
678 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
680 else if (!second)
681 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
682 else
683 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
685 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
686 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
689 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
690 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
691 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
692 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
693 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
695 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
696 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
697 switch *back* into the table section. */
698 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
699 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
700 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
701 #endif
703 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
704 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
705 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
706 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
708 j += 2;
711 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
713 static bool
714 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
716 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
717 return true;
719 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
720 return true;
722 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
723 return true;
725 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
726 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
727 return false;
729 return true;
732 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
733 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
734 location of saved registers. */
736 static void
737 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
739 unsigned int i;
740 dw_fde_ref fde;
741 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
742 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
743 char section_start_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
744 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
745 char augmentation[6];
746 int augmentation_size;
747 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
748 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
749 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
750 int return_reg;
751 rtx personality = NULL;
752 int dw_cie_version;
754 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
755 if (!fde_vec)
756 return;
758 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
759 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
760 return;
762 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
763 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
764 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
765 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
766 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
767 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
768 if (for_eh)
770 bool any_eh_needed = false;
772 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
774 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
775 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
776 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
777 any_eh_needed = true;
778 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
779 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
782 if (!any_eh_needed)
783 return;
786 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
787 if (flag_debug_asm)
788 app_enable ();
790 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
791 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
793 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
794 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
796 /* Output the CIE. */
797 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
798 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
799 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
801 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
802 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
803 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
804 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
805 "Length of Common Information Entry");
807 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
809 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
810 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
811 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
812 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
813 "CIE Identifier Tag");
815 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
816 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
817 due to overflowing the return register column. */
818 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
819 dw_cie_version = 1;
820 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
821 dw_cie_version = 3;
822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
824 augmentation[0] = 0;
825 augmentation_size = 0;
827 personality = current_unit_personality;
828 if (for_eh)
830 char *p;
832 /* Augmentation:
833 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
834 augmentation section.
835 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
836 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
837 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
838 FDE code pointers.
839 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
840 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
842 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
843 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
844 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
846 p = augmentation + 1;
847 if (personality)
849 *p++ = 'P';
850 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
851 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
853 if (any_lsda_needed)
855 *p++ = 'L';
856 augmentation_size += 1;
858 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
860 *p++ = 'R';
861 augmentation_size += 1;
863 if (p > augmentation + 1)
865 augmentation[0] = 'z';
866 *p = '\0';
869 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
870 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
872 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
873 + 4 /* CIE Id */
874 + 1 /* CIE version */
875 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
876 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
877 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
878 + 1 /* RA column */
879 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
880 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
881 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
883 augmentation_size += pad;
885 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
886 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
887 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
891 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
892 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
895 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
897 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
898 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
899 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
901 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
903 else
904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
906 if (augmentation[0])
908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
909 if (personality)
911 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
912 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
913 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
914 personality,
915 true, NULL);
918 if (any_lsda_needed)
919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
920 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
922 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
924 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
927 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
928 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
930 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
931 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
932 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
933 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
935 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
936 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
938 unsigned int k;
940 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
941 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
942 continue;
944 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
945 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
946 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
949 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
950 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
952 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
953 if (flag_debug_asm)
954 app_disable ();
957 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
959 static void
960 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
962 int enc;
963 rtx ref;
964 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
966 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
968 if (personality)
970 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
971 ref = personality;
973 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
974 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
975 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
976 of the weirder relocation types. */
977 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
978 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
980 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
981 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
982 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
985 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
987 char lab[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
989 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
991 current_function_funcdef_no);
992 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
993 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
995 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
996 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
998 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
999 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1000 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1004 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1005 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1007 dw_fde_ref
1008 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1010 dw_fde_ref fde;
1012 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1013 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1014 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1015 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1016 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1017 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1018 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1019 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1020 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1022 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1023 cfun->fde = fde;
1024 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1026 return fde;
1029 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1030 the prologue. */
1032 void
1033 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1034 unsigned int column ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1035 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1037 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1038 char * dup_label;
1039 dw_fde_ref fde;
1040 section *fnsec;
1041 bool do_frame;
1043 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1045 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1047 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1048 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1049 if (!do_frame
1050 && (!flag_exceptions
1051 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1052 return;
1054 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1055 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1056 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1057 current_function_funcdef_no);
1058 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1059 current_function_funcdef_no);
1060 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1061 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1063 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
1064 if (!do_frame)
1065 return;
1067 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1068 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1069 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1070 do so now. */
1071 fde = cfun->fde;
1072 if (fde == NULL)
1073 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1075 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1076 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1077 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1078 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1079 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1081 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1082 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1083 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1084 if (file)
1085 dwarf2out_source_line (line, column, file, 0, true);
1086 #endif
1088 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1089 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1090 else
1092 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1093 if (!current_unit_personality)
1094 current_unit_personality = personality;
1096 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1097 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1098 function anymore. */
1099 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1100 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1101 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1105 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1106 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1107 been generated. */
1109 void
1110 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1111 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1113 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1115 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1116 function. */
1117 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1118 current_function_funcdef_no);
1119 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1120 current_function_funcdef_no);
1121 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1124 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1125 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1126 been generated. */
1128 void
1129 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1130 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1132 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1133 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1135 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1136 return;
1138 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1139 function. */
1140 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1141 current_function_funcdef_no);
1142 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1143 current_function_funcdef_no);
1144 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1147 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1148 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1149 been generated. */
1151 void
1152 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1153 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1155 dw_fde_ref fde;
1156 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1158 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1159 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1161 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1162 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1164 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1165 function. */
1166 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1167 current_function_funcdef_no);
1168 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1169 fde = cfun->fde;
1170 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1171 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1172 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1175 void
1176 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1178 /* Output call frame information. */
1179 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1180 output_call_frame_info (0);
1182 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1183 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1184 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1185 output_call_frame_info (1);
1188 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1190 static void
1191 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1193 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1194 if (sec == text_section)
1195 text_section_used = true;
1196 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1197 cold_text_section_used = true;
1200 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1201 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1203 void
1204 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1206 section *sect;
1207 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1209 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1211 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1213 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1214 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1215 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1217 else
1219 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1220 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1221 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1223 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1225 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1226 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1227 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1229 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1230 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1232 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1233 sect = current_function_section ();
1234 switch_to_section (sect);
1236 fde->second_in_std_section
1237 = (sect == text_section
1238 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1240 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1241 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1243 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1245 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1246 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1249 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1250 for emitting location expressions. */
1252 /* Data about a single source file. */
1253 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1254 const char * filename;
1255 int emitted_number;
1258 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1260 enum ate_kind {
1261 ate_kind_rtx,
1262 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1263 ate_kind_label
1266 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1267 enum ate_kind kind;
1268 unsigned int refcount;
1269 unsigned int index;
1270 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1272 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1273 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1275 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1278 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1279 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1280 their entire life. */
1281 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1282 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1283 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1284 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1285 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1286 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1287 Only on head of list */
1288 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1289 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1290 hashval_t hash;
1291 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1292 resolved. */
1293 bool resolved_addr;
1294 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1295 bool replaced;
1296 /* True if it has been emitted into .debug_loc* / .debug_loclists*
1297 section. */
1298 unsigned char emitted : 1;
1299 /* True if hash field is index rather than hash value. */
1300 unsigned char num_assigned : 1;
1301 /* True if .debug_loclists.dwo offset has been emitted for it already. */
1302 unsigned char offset_emitted : 1;
1303 /* True if note_variable_value_in_expr has been called on it. */
1304 unsigned char noted_variable_value : 1;
1305 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1306 are the same. */
1307 bool force;
1308 } dw_loc_list_node;
1310 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1311 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1313 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1315 static const char *
1316 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1318 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1320 if (name != NULL)
1321 return name;
1323 return "OP_<unknown>";
1326 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1327 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1328 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1330 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1331 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1332 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1334 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1336 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1337 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1338 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1339 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1340 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1341 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1342 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1344 return descr;
1347 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1348 REG and OFFSET. */
1350 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1351 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1353 if (reg <= 31)
1354 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1355 offset, 0);
1356 else
1357 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1360 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1362 static inline void
1363 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1365 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1367 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1368 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1371 *d = descr;
1374 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1376 static bool
1377 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1379 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1380 return false;
1381 switch (a->val_class)
1383 case dw_val_class_none:
1384 return true;
1385 case dw_val_class_addr:
1386 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1388 case dw_val_class_offset:
1389 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1390 case dw_val_class_const:
1391 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
1392 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
1393 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1394 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1395 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1397 case dw_val_class_loc:
1398 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1399 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1400 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1401 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1402 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1403 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1404 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1405 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1406 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1407 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1408 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
1409 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1410 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1411 case dw_val_class_str:
1412 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1413 case dw_val_class_flag:
1414 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1415 case dw_val_class_file:
1416 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
1417 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1418 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1419 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1421 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1422 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1423 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1425 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1426 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1428 case dw_val_class_vec:
1430 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1431 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1433 return (a_len == b_len
1434 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1437 case dw_val_class_data8:
1438 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1440 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1441 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1442 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1444 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1445 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1446 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1447 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1448 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1449 return false;
1451 gcc_unreachable ();
1454 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1456 static bool
1457 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1459 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1460 return false;
1462 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1463 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1464 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1465 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1466 return false;
1468 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1469 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1472 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1474 bool
1475 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1477 while (1)
1479 if (a == b)
1480 return true;
1481 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1482 return false;
1483 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1484 return false;
1486 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1487 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1492 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1494 static void
1495 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1497 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1498 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1500 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1502 if (!offset)
1503 return;
1505 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1506 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1509 p = NULL;
1510 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1511 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1512 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1513 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1514 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1516 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1517 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1518 if (p != NULL
1519 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1520 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1521 *p += offset;
1523 else if (offset > 0)
1524 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1526 else
1528 loc->dw_loc_next
1529 = uint_loc_descriptor (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset);
1530 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1534 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1536 static void
1537 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1539 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1540 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1541 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1544 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1545 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1547 /* The number of bits that can be encoded by largest DW_FORM_dataN.
1548 In DWARF4 and earlier it is DW_FORM_data8 with 64 bits, in DWARF5
1549 DW_FORM_data16 with 128 bits. */
1550 #define DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS \
1551 (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 128 : 64)
1553 /* Utility inline function for construction of ops that were GNU extension
1554 before DWARF 5. */
1555 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
1556 dwarf_OP (enum dwarf_location_atom op)
1558 switch (op)
1560 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1561 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1562 return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
1563 break;
1565 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1566 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1567 return DW_OP_GNU_entry_value;
1568 break;
1570 case DW_OP_const_type:
1571 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1572 return DW_OP_GNU_const_type;
1573 break;
1575 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1576 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1577 return DW_OP_GNU_regval_type;
1578 break;
1580 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1581 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1582 return DW_OP_GNU_deref_type;
1583 break;
1585 case DW_OP_convert:
1586 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1587 return DW_OP_GNU_convert;
1588 break;
1590 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1591 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1592 return DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret;
1593 break;
1595 default:
1596 break;
1598 return op;
1601 /* Similarly for attributes. */
1602 static inline enum dwarf_attribute
1603 dwarf_AT (enum dwarf_attribute at)
1605 switch (at)
1607 case DW_AT_call_return_pc:
1608 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1609 return DW_AT_low_pc;
1610 break;
1612 case DW_AT_call_tail_call:
1613 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1614 return DW_AT_GNU_tail_call;
1615 break;
1617 case DW_AT_call_origin:
1618 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1619 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1620 break;
1622 case DW_AT_call_target:
1623 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1624 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target;
1625 break;
1627 case DW_AT_call_target_clobbered:
1628 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1629 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered;
1630 break;
1632 case DW_AT_call_parameter:
1633 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1634 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1635 break;
1637 case DW_AT_call_value:
1638 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1639 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value;
1640 break;
1642 case DW_AT_call_data_value:
1643 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1644 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value;
1645 break;
1647 case DW_AT_call_all_calls:
1648 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1649 return DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites;
1650 break;
1652 case DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls:
1653 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1654 return DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites;
1655 break;
1657 case DW_AT_dwo_name:
1658 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1659 return DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name;
1660 break;
1662 default:
1663 break;
1665 return at;
1668 /* And similarly for tags. */
1669 static inline enum dwarf_tag
1670 dwarf_TAG (enum dwarf_tag tag)
1672 switch (tag)
1674 case DW_TAG_call_site:
1675 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1676 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site;
1677 break;
1679 case DW_TAG_call_site_parameter:
1680 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1681 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter;
1682 break;
1684 default:
1685 break;
1687 return tag;
1690 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1692 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1694 static unsigned long
1695 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1697 unsigned long size = 1;
1699 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1701 case DW_OP_addr:
1702 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1703 break;
1704 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1705 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1706 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1707 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1708 break;
1709 case DW_OP_const1u:
1710 case DW_OP_const1s:
1711 size += 1;
1712 break;
1713 case DW_OP_const2u:
1714 case DW_OP_const2s:
1715 size += 2;
1716 break;
1717 case DW_OP_const4u:
1718 case DW_OP_const4s:
1719 size += 4;
1720 break;
1721 case DW_OP_const8u:
1722 case DW_OP_const8s:
1723 size += 8;
1724 break;
1725 case DW_OP_constu:
1726 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1727 break;
1728 case DW_OP_consts:
1729 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1730 break;
1731 case DW_OP_pick:
1732 size += 1;
1733 break;
1734 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1735 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1736 break;
1737 case DW_OP_skip:
1738 case DW_OP_bra:
1739 size += 2;
1740 break;
1741 case DW_OP_breg0:
1742 case DW_OP_breg1:
1743 case DW_OP_breg2:
1744 case DW_OP_breg3:
1745 case DW_OP_breg4:
1746 case DW_OP_breg5:
1747 case DW_OP_breg6:
1748 case DW_OP_breg7:
1749 case DW_OP_breg8:
1750 case DW_OP_breg9:
1751 case DW_OP_breg10:
1752 case DW_OP_breg11:
1753 case DW_OP_breg12:
1754 case DW_OP_breg13:
1755 case DW_OP_breg14:
1756 case DW_OP_breg15:
1757 case DW_OP_breg16:
1758 case DW_OP_breg17:
1759 case DW_OP_breg18:
1760 case DW_OP_breg19:
1761 case DW_OP_breg20:
1762 case DW_OP_breg21:
1763 case DW_OP_breg22:
1764 case DW_OP_breg23:
1765 case DW_OP_breg24:
1766 case DW_OP_breg25:
1767 case DW_OP_breg26:
1768 case DW_OP_breg27:
1769 case DW_OP_breg28:
1770 case DW_OP_breg29:
1771 case DW_OP_breg30:
1772 case DW_OP_breg31:
1773 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1774 break;
1775 case DW_OP_regx:
1776 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1777 break;
1778 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1779 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1780 break;
1781 case DW_OP_bregx:
1782 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1783 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1784 break;
1785 case DW_OP_piece:
1786 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1787 break;
1788 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1789 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1790 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1791 break;
1792 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1793 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1794 size += 1;
1795 break;
1796 case DW_OP_call2:
1797 size += 2;
1798 break;
1799 case DW_OP_call4:
1800 size += 4;
1801 break;
1802 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1803 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
1804 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1805 break;
1806 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1807 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1808 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1809 break;
1810 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1811 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1812 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1813 break;
1814 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1815 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1817 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1818 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1819 break;
1821 case DW_OP_const_type:
1822 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1824 unsigned long o
1825 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1826 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1827 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1829 case dw_val_class_vec:
1830 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1831 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1832 break;
1833 case dw_val_class_const:
1834 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1835 break;
1836 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1837 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1838 break;
1839 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1840 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1841 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1842 break;
1843 default:
1844 gcc_unreachable ();
1846 break;
1848 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1849 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1851 unsigned long o
1852 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1853 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1854 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1856 break;
1857 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1858 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1860 unsigned long o
1861 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1862 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1864 break;
1865 case DW_OP_convert:
1866 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1867 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1868 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1869 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1870 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1871 else
1873 unsigned long o
1874 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1875 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1877 break;
1878 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1879 size += 4;
1880 break;
1881 default:
1882 break;
1885 return size;
1888 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1890 unsigned long
1891 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1893 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1894 unsigned long size;
1896 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1897 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1898 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1900 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1901 break;
1902 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1904 if (! l)
1905 return size;
1907 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1909 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1910 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1913 return size;
1916 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
1918 static int
1919 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1921 if (discr_value->pos)
1922 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1923 else
1924 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1927 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_list attribute. */
1929 static int
1930 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
1932 int size = 0;
1934 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
1935 list != NULL;
1936 list = list->dw_discr_next)
1938 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
1939 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
1940 range label. */
1941 size += 1;
1942 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
1943 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
1944 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
1946 return size;
1949 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1950 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1951 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1953 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1954 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1955 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1956 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1957 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1958 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1960 static void
1961 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1963 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1964 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1966 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1968 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1969 case DW_OP_const2u:
1970 case DW_OP_const2s:
1971 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1972 break;
1973 case DW_OP_const4u:
1974 if (loc->dtprel)
1976 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1977 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1978 val1->v.val_addr);
1979 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1980 break;
1982 /* FALLTHRU */
1983 case DW_OP_const4s:
1984 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1985 break;
1986 case DW_OP_const8u:
1987 if (loc->dtprel)
1989 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1990 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1991 val1->v.val_addr);
1992 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1993 break;
1995 /* FALLTHRU */
1996 case DW_OP_const8s:
1997 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1998 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1999 break;
2000 case DW_OP_skip:
2001 case DW_OP_bra:
2003 int offset;
2005 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2006 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2008 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2010 break;
2011 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2012 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2013 switch (val2->val_class)
2015 case dw_val_class_const:
2016 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2017 break;
2018 case dw_val_class_vec:
2020 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2021 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2022 unsigned int i;
2023 unsigned char *p;
2025 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2027 elt_size /= 2;
2028 len *= 2;
2030 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2031 i < len;
2032 i++, p += elt_size)
2033 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2034 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2036 break;
2037 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2039 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2041 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2043 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2044 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2046 else
2048 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2049 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2051 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2052 first, NULL);
2053 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2054 second, NULL);
2056 break;
2057 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2059 int i;
2060 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2061 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2062 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2063 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2064 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2065 else
2066 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2067 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2068 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2070 break;
2071 case dw_val_class_addr:
2072 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
2073 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
2074 break;
2075 default:
2076 gcc_unreachable ();
2078 break;
2079 #else
2080 case DW_OP_const2u:
2081 case DW_OP_const2s:
2082 case DW_OP_const4u:
2083 case DW_OP_const4s:
2084 case DW_OP_const8u:
2085 case DW_OP_const8s:
2086 case DW_OP_skip:
2087 case DW_OP_bra:
2088 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2089 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2090 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2091 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2092 only doing unwinding. */
2093 gcc_unreachable ();
2094 #endif
2095 case DW_OP_const1u:
2096 case DW_OP_const1s:
2097 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2098 break;
2099 case DW_OP_constu:
2100 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2101 break;
2102 case DW_OP_consts:
2103 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2104 break;
2105 case DW_OP_pick:
2106 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2107 break;
2108 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2109 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2110 break;
2111 case DW_OP_breg0:
2112 case DW_OP_breg1:
2113 case DW_OP_breg2:
2114 case DW_OP_breg3:
2115 case DW_OP_breg4:
2116 case DW_OP_breg5:
2117 case DW_OP_breg6:
2118 case DW_OP_breg7:
2119 case DW_OP_breg8:
2120 case DW_OP_breg9:
2121 case DW_OP_breg10:
2122 case DW_OP_breg11:
2123 case DW_OP_breg12:
2124 case DW_OP_breg13:
2125 case DW_OP_breg14:
2126 case DW_OP_breg15:
2127 case DW_OP_breg16:
2128 case DW_OP_breg17:
2129 case DW_OP_breg18:
2130 case DW_OP_breg19:
2131 case DW_OP_breg20:
2132 case DW_OP_breg21:
2133 case DW_OP_breg22:
2134 case DW_OP_breg23:
2135 case DW_OP_breg24:
2136 case DW_OP_breg25:
2137 case DW_OP_breg26:
2138 case DW_OP_breg27:
2139 case DW_OP_breg28:
2140 case DW_OP_breg29:
2141 case DW_OP_breg30:
2142 case DW_OP_breg31:
2143 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2144 break;
2145 case DW_OP_regx:
2147 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2148 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2149 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2150 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2151 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2152 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2154 break;
2155 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2156 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2157 break;
2158 case DW_OP_bregx:
2160 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2161 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2162 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2163 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2164 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2165 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2166 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2168 break;
2169 case DW_OP_piece:
2170 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2171 break;
2172 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2173 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2174 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2175 break;
2176 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2177 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2178 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2179 break;
2181 case DW_OP_addr:
2182 if (loc->dtprel)
2184 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2186 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2187 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2188 val1->v.val_addr);
2189 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2191 else
2192 gcc_unreachable ();
2194 else
2196 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2197 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2198 #else
2199 gcc_unreachable ();
2200 #endif
2202 break;
2204 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2205 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2206 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2208 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2209 break;
2211 case DW_OP_call2:
2212 case DW_OP_call4:
2214 unsigned long die_offset
2215 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2216 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2217 an operand. */
2218 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2219 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2
2220 ? 0xffff
2221 : 0xffffffff));
2222 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2223 die_offset, NULL);
2225 break;
2227 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2228 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
2230 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2231 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2232 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2233 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2234 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2236 break;
2238 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2239 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2241 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2242 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2243 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2244 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2245 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2246 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2248 break;
2250 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2251 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2252 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2253 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2254 break;
2256 case DW_OP_const_type:
2257 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2259 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2260 gcc_assert (o);
2261 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2262 switch (val2->val_class)
2264 case dw_val_class_const:
2265 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2266 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2267 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2268 break;
2269 case dw_val_class_vec:
2271 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2272 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2273 unsigned int i;
2274 unsigned char *p;
2276 l = len * elt_size;
2277 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2278 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2280 elt_size /= 2;
2281 len *= 2;
2283 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2284 i < len;
2285 i++, p += elt_size)
2286 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2287 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2289 break;
2290 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2292 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2293 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2295 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2296 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2298 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2299 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2301 else
2303 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2304 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2306 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2307 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2309 break;
2310 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2312 int i;
2313 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2314 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2317 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2318 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2319 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2320 else
2321 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2322 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2324 break;
2325 default:
2326 gcc_unreachable ();
2329 break;
2330 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2331 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2333 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2334 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2335 gcc_assert (o);
2336 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2338 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2339 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2340 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2342 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2343 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2345 break;
2346 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2347 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2349 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2350 gcc_assert (o);
2351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2352 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2354 break;
2355 case DW_OP_convert:
2356 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2357 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2358 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2359 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2360 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2361 else
2363 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2364 gcc_assert (o);
2365 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2367 break;
2369 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2371 unsigned long o;
2372 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2373 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2374 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2376 break;
2378 default:
2379 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2380 break;
2384 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2385 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2386 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2387 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2388 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2389 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2391 void
2392 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2394 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2396 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2397 /* Output the opcode. */
2398 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2399 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2401 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2402 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2403 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2404 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2406 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2407 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2409 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2410 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2411 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2412 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2415 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2416 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2418 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2419 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2423 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2424 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2426 static void
2427 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2429 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2430 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2432 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2434 case DW_OP_addr:
2435 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2436 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2437 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2438 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2439 gcc_unreachable ();
2441 case DW_OP_const1u:
2442 case DW_OP_const1s:
2443 case DW_OP_pick:
2444 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2445 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2446 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2447 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2448 break;
2450 case DW_OP_const2u:
2451 case DW_OP_const2s:
2452 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2453 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2454 break;
2456 case DW_OP_const4u:
2457 case DW_OP_const4s:
2458 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2459 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2460 break;
2462 case DW_OP_const8u:
2463 case DW_OP_const8s:
2464 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2465 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2466 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2467 break;
2469 case DW_OP_skip:
2470 case DW_OP_bra:
2472 int offset;
2474 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2475 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2477 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2478 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2480 break;
2482 case DW_OP_regx:
2484 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2485 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2486 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2487 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2488 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2490 break;
2492 case DW_OP_constu:
2493 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2494 case DW_OP_piece:
2495 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2496 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2497 break;
2499 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2500 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2501 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2502 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2503 break;
2505 case DW_OP_consts:
2506 case DW_OP_breg0:
2507 case DW_OP_breg1:
2508 case DW_OP_breg2:
2509 case DW_OP_breg3:
2510 case DW_OP_breg4:
2511 case DW_OP_breg5:
2512 case DW_OP_breg6:
2513 case DW_OP_breg7:
2514 case DW_OP_breg8:
2515 case DW_OP_breg9:
2516 case DW_OP_breg10:
2517 case DW_OP_breg11:
2518 case DW_OP_breg12:
2519 case DW_OP_breg13:
2520 case DW_OP_breg14:
2521 case DW_OP_breg15:
2522 case DW_OP_breg16:
2523 case DW_OP_breg17:
2524 case DW_OP_breg18:
2525 case DW_OP_breg19:
2526 case DW_OP_breg20:
2527 case DW_OP_breg21:
2528 case DW_OP_breg22:
2529 case DW_OP_breg23:
2530 case DW_OP_breg24:
2531 case DW_OP_breg25:
2532 case DW_OP_breg26:
2533 case DW_OP_breg27:
2534 case DW_OP_breg28:
2535 case DW_OP_breg29:
2536 case DW_OP_breg30:
2537 case DW_OP_breg31:
2538 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2539 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2540 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2541 break;
2543 case DW_OP_bregx:
2545 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2546 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2547 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2548 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2549 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2550 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2551 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2553 break;
2555 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2556 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2557 case DW_OP_const_type:
2558 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2559 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2560 case DW_OP_convert:
2561 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2562 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2563 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2564 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2565 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2566 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2567 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2568 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2569 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2570 gcc_unreachable ();
2571 break;
2573 default:
2574 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2575 break;
2579 void
2580 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2582 while (1)
2584 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2585 /* Output the opcode. */
2586 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2588 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2589 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2590 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2591 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2593 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2595 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2596 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2597 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2598 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2600 /* Output the opcode. */
2601 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2602 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2604 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2605 break;
2606 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2608 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2612 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2613 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2614 expression. */
2616 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2617 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2619 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2621 offset += cfa->offset;
2623 if (cfa->indirect)
2625 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2626 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2627 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2628 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2629 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2630 if (offset != 0)
2632 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2633 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2636 else
2637 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2639 return head;
2642 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2643 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2644 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2646 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2647 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2648 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2650 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2651 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2652 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2654 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2655 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2657 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2658 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2659 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2660 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2662 else
2663 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2664 return head;
2667 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2669 /* .debug_str support. */
2671 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2672 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2673 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *);
2674 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2675 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2676 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2677 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2678 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2679 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2680 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2681 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2682 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2683 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2684 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2685 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2686 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool, bool);
2687 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2688 dw_die_ref);
2689 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2690 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2691 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2692 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2693 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2694 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2695 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2696 static void dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
2697 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off);
2698 static bool dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
2699 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off);
2701 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2703 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2705 dwarf2out_init,
2706 dwarf2out_finish,
2707 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2708 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2709 dwarf2out_define,
2710 dwarf2out_undef,
2711 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2712 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2713 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2714 dwarf2out_end_block,
2715 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2716 dwarf2out_source_line,
2717 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2718 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2719 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2720 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2721 #else
2722 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2723 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2724 #endif
2725 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2726 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2727 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2728 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2729 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2730 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2731 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2732 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2733 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2734 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl,
2735 dwarf2out_register_external_die,
2736 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2737 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2738 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2739 something tries to reference them. */
2740 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2741 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2742 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2743 dwarf2out_var_location,
2744 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2745 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2746 dwarf2out_set_name,
2747 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2748 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2751 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2753 dwarf2out_init,
2754 debug_nothing_charstar,
2755 debug_nothing_charstar,
2756 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2757 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2758 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2759 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2760 debug_nothing_int,
2761 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2762 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2763 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2764 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2765 debug_nothing_int_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2766 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2767 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2768 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2769 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2770 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2771 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2772 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2773 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2774 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2775 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2776 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool_bool,/* imported_module_or_decl */
2777 debug_false_tree_charstarstar_uhwistar,/* die_ref_for_decl */
2778 debug_nothing_tree_charstar_uhwi, /* register_external_die */
2779 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2780 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2781 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2782 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2783 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2784 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2785 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2786 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2787 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2788 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2791 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2792 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2793 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2795 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2796 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2797 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2798 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2800 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2801 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2802 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2803 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2804 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2805 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2806 yet. For Dwarf V5 or higher .debug_types doesn't exist any more,
2807 it is DW_UT_type unit type in .debug_info section. */
2809 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2811 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2812 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2814 typedef long int dw_offset;
2816 struct comdat_type_node;
2818 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2819 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2820 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2821 supported. */
2823 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2824 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2825 LI_set_address,
2827 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2828 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2829 special opcodes. */
2830 LI_set_line,
2832 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2833 LI_set_file,
2835 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2836 LI_set_column,
2838 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2839 LI_negate_stmt,
2841 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2842 LI_set_prologue_end,
2843 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2845 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2846 LI_set_discriminator
2849 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2850 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2851 unsigned int val;
2852 } dw_line_info_entry;
2855 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2856 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2857 const char *end_label;
2859 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2860 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2861 unsigned int file_num;
2862 unsigned int line_num;
2863 unsigned int column_num;
2864 int discrim_num;
2865 bool is_stmt;
2866 bool in_use;
2868 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2872 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2873 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2874 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2876 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2877 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2878 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2880 dw_attr_node;
2883 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2884 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2885 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2887 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2888 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2890 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2891 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2893 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2894 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2895 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2896 dw_die_ref die_child;
2897 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2898 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2899 dw_offset die_offset;
2900 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2901 int die_mark;
2902 unsigned int decl_id;
2903 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2904 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2905 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2906 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2907 /* For an external ref to die_symbol if die_offset contains an extra
2908 offset to that symbol. */
2909 BOOL_BITFIELD with_offset : 1;
2910 /* Whether this DIE was removed from the DIE tree, for example via
2911 prune_unused_types. We don't consider those present from the
2912 DIE lookup routines. */
2913 BOOL_BITFIELD removed : 1;
2914 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2916 die_node;
2918 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
2919 static bool early_dwarf;
2920 static bool early_dwarf_finished;
2921 struct set_early_dwarf {
2922 bool saved;
2923 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf)
2925 gcc_assert (! early_dwarf_finished);
2926 early_dwarf = true;
2928 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
2931 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2932 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2933 c = die->die_child; \
2934 if (c) do { \
2935 c = c->die_sib; \
2936 expr; \
2937 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2938 } while (0)
2940 /* The pubname structure */
2942 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2943 dw_die_ref die;
2944 const char *name;
2946 pubname_entry;
2949 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
2950 const char *label;
2951 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2952 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2953 int num;
2954 /* Index for the range list for DW_FORM_rnglistx. */
2955 unsigned int idx : 31;
2956 /* True if this range might be possibly in a different section
2957 from previous entry. */
2958 unsigned int maybe_new_sec : 1;
2961 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2963 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2964 unsigned char code;
2965 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2966 const char *info;
2968 macinfo_entry;
2971 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
2972 const char *begin;
2973 const char *end;
2976 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2977 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
2979 dw_die_ref root_die;
2980 dw_die_ref type_die;
2981 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2982 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2983 comdat_type_node *next;
2986 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
2987 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
2988 missing bits. */
2989 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2990 dw_die_ref die;
2991 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
2992 determine ancestry later. */
2993 tree created_for;
2994 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2996 limbo_die_node;
2998 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
3000 dw_die_ref old_die;
3001 dw_die_ref new_die;
3002 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
3004 skeleton_chain_node;
3006 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3007 implicitly generated for a type.
3009 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
3010 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
3011 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
3012 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3013 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3014 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
3015 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
3017 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3018 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3019 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3020 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3021 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3022 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3023 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3024 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3025 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3027 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3028 language, and compiler version. */
3030 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3031 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3032 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE \
3033 + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 4 : 3))
3035 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
3036 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3037 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3038 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3040 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF skeleton compilation unit header. */
3041 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE \
3042 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 8 : 0))
3044 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3045 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3047 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3048 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3049 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3050 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3051 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3053 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3054 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3055 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3056 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3057 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3058 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3060 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3061 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3062 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3063 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3064 #else
3065 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3066 #endif
3067 #endif
3069 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3070 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3071 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3073 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3074 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
3076 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3077 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3079 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3080 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3081 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3082 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3083 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3085 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
3086 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
3087 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
3088 #endif
3090 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3091 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3092 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3094 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3095 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
3097 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
3098 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
3100 /* A list of CU DIEs that have been separated. */
3101 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *cu_die_list;
3103 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3104 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3106 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
3107 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
3108 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
3110 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
3112 typedef const char *compare_type;
3114 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
3115 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
3118 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3119 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
3121 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
3123 typedef tree compare_type;
3125 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
3126 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
3128 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3129 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3130 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
3132 struct GTY ((for_user)) variable_value_struct {
3133 unsigned int decl_id;
3134 vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *dies;
3137 struct variable_value_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<variable_value_struct>
3139 typedef tree compare_type;
3141 static hashval_t hash (variable_value_struct *);
3142 static bool equal (variable_value_struct *, tree);
3144 /* A hash table of DIEs that contain DW_OP_GNU_variable_value with
3145 dw_val_class_decl_ref class, indexed by FUNCTION_DECLs which is
3146 DECL_CONTEXT of the referenced VAR_DECLs. */
3147 static GTY (()) hash_table<variable_value_hasher> *variable_value_hash;
3149 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
3151 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
3152 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
3155 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
3156 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
3157 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
3159 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
3160 dw_die_ref die;
3161 tree arg;
3162 } die_arg_entry;
3165 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3166 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
3167 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
3168 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
3169 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
3170 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
3171 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
3172 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
3173 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
3174 NULL as second operand. */
3175 rtx GTY (()) loc;
3176 const char * GTY (()) label;
3177 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3180 /* Variable location list. */
3181 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
3182 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3184 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
3185 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
3186 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
3187 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
3188 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
3189 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
3190 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3192 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
3193 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
3194 is after section switch. */
3195 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
3197 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3198 unsigned int decl_id;
3200 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3202 /* Call argument location list. */
3203 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
3204 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
3205 const char * GTY (()) label;
3206 tree GTY (()) block;
3207 bool tail_call_p;
3208 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
3209 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3213 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
3215 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3217 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
3218 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
3221 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3222 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
3224 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
3225 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
3226 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
3228 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
3229 static int call_site_count = -1;
3230 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
3231 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
3233 /* A cached location list. */
3234 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
3235 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
3236 unsigned int decl_id;
3238 /* The cached location list. */
3239 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3241 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3243 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3246 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3248 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3249 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3252 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3253 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3255 /* A vector of references to DIE's that are uniquely identified by their tag,
3256 presence/absence of children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3257 static GTY(()) vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *abbrev_die_table;
3259 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3260 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3261 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3262 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3263 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3265 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3266 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3268 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3269 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3270 assembly for the function. */
3271 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3273 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3274 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3275 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3277 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3278 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3280 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3281 refer to. */
3282 static bool info_section_emitted;
3284 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3285 accessible names. */
3286 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3288 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3289 accessible types. */
3290 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3292 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3293 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3294 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3296 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3297 emitted. */
3298 #define have_macinfo \
3299 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3300 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3301 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3303 /* Vector of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3304 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges, va_gc> *ranges_table;
3306 /* Vector of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3307 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges_by_label, va_gc> *ranges_by_label;
3309 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3310 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3312 /* Unique label counter. */
3313 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3315 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3316 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3318 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3319 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3321 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3322 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3324 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3326 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3327 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3328 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3329 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3330 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3332 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3333 within the current function. */
3334 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3335 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3337 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3339 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3340 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3341 enum dw_scalar_form
3343 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3344 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3345 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3348 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3350 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3351 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3352 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3353 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3354 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3355 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3356 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3357 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3358 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3359 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3360 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3361 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3362 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3363 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3364 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3365 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3366 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3367 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3368 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3369 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3370 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3371 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3372 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3373 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3374 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3375 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3376 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3377 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3378 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3379 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3380 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3381 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3382 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3383 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3384 dw_loc_list_ref);
3385 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3386 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3387 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3388 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3389 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3390 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3391 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3392 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3393 static void add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3394 const char *);
3395 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3396 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3397 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3398 unsigned long, bool);
3399 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3400 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3401 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3402 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3403 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3404 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3405 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3406 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3407 static bool is_cxx (void);
3408 static bool is_cxx (const_tree);
3409 static bool is_fortran (void);
3410 static bool is_ada (void);
3411 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3412 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3413 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3414 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3415 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3416 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3417 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3418 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3419 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3420 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3421 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3422 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3423 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3424 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3425 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3426 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3427 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3428 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3429 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3430 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3431 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3432 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3433 struct checksum_attributes;
3434 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3435 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3436 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3437 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3438 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3439 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3440 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3441 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3442 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3443 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3444 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3445 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3446 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3447 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3448 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3449 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3450 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3451 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3452 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3453 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3454 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3455 dw_die_ref,
3456 dw_die_ref);
3457 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3458 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3460 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3461 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3462 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3463 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3464 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3465 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3466 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3467 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3468 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3469 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3470 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3471 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3472 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3473 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3474 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3475 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3476 static void output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type);
3477 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int, const unsigned char *);
3478 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3479 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3480 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3481 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3482 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3483 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3484 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3485 static void output_aranges (void);
3486 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree, bool = false);
3487 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3488 bool *, bool);
3489 static void output_ranges (void);
3490 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3491 static void output_line_info (bool);
3492 static void output_file_names (void);
3493 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3494 static int is_base_type (tree);
3495 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3496 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3497 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3498 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3499 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3500 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3501 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3502 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3503 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3504 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3505 enum var_init_status);
3506 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3507 enum var_init_status);
3508 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3509 enum var_init_status);
3510 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3511 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3512 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3513 enum var_init_status);
3514 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3515 enum var_init_status);
3516 struct loc_descr_context;
3517 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3518 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3519 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3520 struct loc_descr_context *);
3521 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3522 struct loc_descr_context *);
3523 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3524 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3525 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3526 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3527 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3528 struct vlr_context;
3529 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3530 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3531 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3532 dw_loc_list_ref);
3533 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3534 struct vlr_context *);
3535 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3536 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3537 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3538 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3539 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3540 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3541 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3542 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3543 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3544 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3545 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3546 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3547 struct loc_descr_context *);
3548 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3549 struct loc_descr_context *);
3550 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3551 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3552 static void add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3553 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3554 struct vlr_context *);
3555 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3556 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3557 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3558 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3559 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3560 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree, bool = false);
3561 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3562 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3563 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3564 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3565 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3566 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3567 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3568 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3569 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3570 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3571 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3572 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3573 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3574 #if 0
3575 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3576 #endif
3577 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3578 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3579 #if 0
3580 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3581 #endif
3582 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3583 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3584 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3585 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3586 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3587 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3588 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3589 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3590 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3591 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3592 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3593 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3594 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3595 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3596 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3597 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3598 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3599 enum debug_info_usage);
3600 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3601 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3602 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3603 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3604 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3605 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3606 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3607 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3608 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3609 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3610 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3611 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3612 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3613 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3614 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3615 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3616 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3617 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3618 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3619 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3620 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3621 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3622 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3623 const char *, const char *);
3624 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3625 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3626 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3628 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3629 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3630 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3631 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3632 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3633 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3634 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3635 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3636 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3637 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3638 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3639 const char *, const char *);
3640 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3641 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3642 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3643 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3644 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3645 static void resolve_variable_values (void);
3647 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3649 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3651 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3652 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3653 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3655 enum dtprel_bool
3657 dtprel_false = 0,
3658 dtprel_true = 1
3661 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3662 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3663 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3664 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3666 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3667 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3669 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3670 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3671 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3672 else
3673 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3676 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3677 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3678 relocation. */
3679 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3680 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3682 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3684 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3685 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3686 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3687 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3688 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3689 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3690 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3691 else
3692 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3694 return ref;
3697 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3699 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3700 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3701 #endif
3702 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3703 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3704 #endif
3705 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION
3706 #define DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info"
3707 #endif
3708 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3709 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info.dwo"
3710 #endif
3711 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3712 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3713 #endif
3714 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION
3715 #define DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev"
3716 #endif
3717 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3718 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3719 #endif
3720 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3721 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev.dwo"
3722 #endif
3723 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3724 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3725 #endif
3726 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3727 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3728 #endif
3729 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3730 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3731 #endif
3732 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION
3733 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo"
3734 #endif
3735 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3736 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3737 #endif
3738 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3739 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo.dwo"
3740 #endif
3741 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3742 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3743 #endif
3744 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION
3745 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro"
3746 #endif
3747 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3748 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3749 #endif
3750 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3751 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro.dwo"
3752 #endif
3753 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3754 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3755 #endif
3756 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION
3757 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line"
3758 #endif
3759 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3760 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3761 #endif
3762 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3763 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line.dwo"
3764 #endif
3765 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3766 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3767 #endif
3768 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3769 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3770 #endif
3771 #ifndef DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3772 #define DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists"
3773 #endif
3774 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
3775 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists.dwo"
3776 #endif
3777 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3778 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3779 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3780 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3781 #endif
3782 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3783 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3784 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3785 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3786 #endif
3787 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3788 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3789 #endif
3790 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3791 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3792 #endif
3793 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3794 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3795 #endif
3796 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3797 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3798 #endif
3799 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION
3800 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str"
3801 #endif
3802 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3803 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3804 #endif
3805 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION
3806 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str.dwo"
3807 #endif
3808 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3809 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3810 #endif
3811 #ifndef DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
3812 #define DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION ".debug_rnglists"
3813 #endif
3814 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION
3815 #define DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION ".debug_line_str"
3816 #endif
3817 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION
3818 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line_str"
3819 #endif
3821 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3822 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3823 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3824 #endif
3826 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3827 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3828 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3829 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3830 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3832 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3833 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3835 /* Attribute used to refer to the macro section. */
3836 #define DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_AT_macros \
3837 : dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros)
3839 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3840 the section names themselves. */
3842 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3843 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3844 #endif
3845 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3846 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3847 #endif
3848 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3849 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3850 #endif
3851 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3852 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3853 #endif
3854 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3855 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3856 #endif
3857 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3858 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3859 #endif
3860 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3861 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3862 #endif
3863 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3864 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3865 #endif
3866 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3867 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3868 #endif
3869 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3870 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3871 #endif
3872 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3873 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3874 #endif
3875 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3876 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3877 #endif
3878 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3879 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3880 #endif
3881 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3882 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3884 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3885 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3886 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3887 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3888 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3890 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3891 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3892 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3893 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3894 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3895 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3896 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3897 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3898 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3899 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3900 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3901 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3902 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3903 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3904 static char ranges_base_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3906 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3907 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3908 #endif
3909 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3910 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3911 #endif
3912 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3913 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3914 #endif
3915 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3916 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3917 #endif
3918 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3919 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3920 #endif
3923 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3924 static dw_die_ref
3925 comp_unit_die (void)
3927 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3928 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3929 return single_comp_unit_die;
3932 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3933 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3935 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3937 void
3938 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3940 demangle_name_func = func;
3943 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3945 static inline int
3946 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3948 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3949 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3950 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3953 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3954 removed. */
3956 static inline tree
3957 type_main_variant (tree type)
3959 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3961 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3962 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3963 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3964 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3965 here. */
3966 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3967 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3968 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3970 return type;
3973 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3975 static inline int
3976 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3978 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3980 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3981 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3984 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3986 static void
3987 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3989 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3992 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3994 static unsigned long int
3995 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3997 if (ref->die_offset)
3998 return ref->die_offset;
3999 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
4001 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
4002 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4004 return ref->die_offset;
4007 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
4009 static unsigned long int
4010 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4012 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4013 return ref->die_offset;
4016 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4018 static const char *
4019 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4021 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
4023 if (name != NULL)
4024 return name;
4026 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4029 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4031 static const char *
4032 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4034 const char *name;
4036 switch (attr)
4038 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4039 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
4040 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
4041 #else
4042 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4043 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4044 #endif
4046 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4047 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
4048 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
4049 #else
4050 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4051 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4052 #endif
4055 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
4057 if (name != NULL)
4058 return name;
4060 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4063 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4065 static const char *
4066 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4068 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
4070 if (name != NULL)
4071 return name;
4073 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4076 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4077 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4078 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4079 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4080 given block. */
4082 static tree
4083 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4085 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4086 return NULL_TREE;
4088 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
4089 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4090 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4091 return NULL_TREE;
4093 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4094 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4095 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4097 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4100 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4101 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4102 parameter. */
4104 static tree
4105 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4107 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4109 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4110 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4111 else
4112 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4113 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4115 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4116 context = NULL_TREE;
4118 return context;
4121 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4123 static inline void
4124 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
4126 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4127 if (die == NULL)
4128 return;
4130 if (flag_checking)
4132 /* Check we do not add duplicate attrs. Can't use get_AT here
4133 because that recurses to the specification/abstract origin DIE. */
4134 dw_attr_node *a;
4135 unsigned ix;
4136 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4137 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != attr->dw_attr);
4140 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
4141 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
4144 static inline enum dw_val_class
4145 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
4147 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4150 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
4151 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
4152 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
4153 pruning. */
4155 static inline unsigned int
4156 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
4158 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4159 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
4160 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
4161 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
4162 return NOT_INDEXED;
4165 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4167 static inline void
4168 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4170 dw_attr_node attr;
4172 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4173 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4174 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4175 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4176 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4179 static inline unsigned
4180 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
4182 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4183 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4186 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4188 static inline void
4189 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4191 dw_attr_node attr;
4193 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4194 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4195 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4196 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4197 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4200 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4201 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
4203 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const
4204 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const_implicit));
4205 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4208 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4210 static inline void
4211 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4214 dw_attr_node attr;
4216 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4217 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4218 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4219 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4220 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4223 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4224 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
4226 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
4227 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit));
4228 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4231 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4233 static inline void
4234 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4235 const wide_int& w)
4237 dw_attr_node attr;
4239 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4240 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
4241 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4242 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
4243 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
4244 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4247 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4249 static inline void
4250 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4251 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
4253 dw_attr_node attr;
4255 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4256 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
4257 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4258 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
4259 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
4260 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4263 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4265 static inline void
4266 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4267 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4269 dw_attr_node attr;
4271 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4272 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4273 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4274 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4275 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4276 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4277 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4280 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4282 static inline void
4283 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4284 unsigned char data8[8])
4286 dw_attr_node attr;
4288 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4289 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4290 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4291 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4292 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4295 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4296 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4297 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4298 references. */
4300 static inline void
4301 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4302 bool force_direct)
4304 dw_attr_node attr;
4305 char * lbl_id;
4307 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4308 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4309 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4310 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4311 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4312 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4313 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4314 else
4315 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4316 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4318 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4319 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4320 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4321 else
4322 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4323 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4324 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4325 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4326 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4327 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4328 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4329 else
4330 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4331 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4334 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4336 hashval_t
4337 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4339 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4342 bool
4343 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4345 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4348 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4350 static struct indirect_string_node *
4351 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4352 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4354 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4356 indirect_string_node **slot
4357 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4358 if (*slot == NULL)
4360 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4361 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4362 *slot = node;
4364 else
4365 node = *slot;
4367 node->refcount++;
4368 return node;
4371 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4373 static struct indirect_string_node *
4374 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4376 if (! debug_str_hash)
4377 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4379 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4382 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4384 static inline void
4385 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4387 dw_attr_node attr;
4388 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4390 node = find_AT_string (str);
4392 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4393 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4394 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4395 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4396 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4399 static inline const char *
4400 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4402 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4403 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4406 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4407 the string inline in the die. */
4409 static void
4410 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4412 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4413 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4414 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
4415 || node->form == DW_FORM_line_strp
4416 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4418 gcc_assert (node->label);
4419 return;
4421 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4422 ++dw2_string_counter;
4423 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4425 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4427 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4428 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4430 else
4432 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4433 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4437 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish, called to reset indirect
4438 string decisions done for early LTO dwarf output before fat object
4439 dwarf output. */
4442 reset_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
4444 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
4445 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4447 free (node->label);
4448 node->label = NULL;
4449 node->form = (dwarf_form) 0;
4450 node->index = 0;
4452 return 1;
4455 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4456 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4458 static enum dwarf_form
4459 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4461 unsigned int len;
4463 if (node->form)
4464 return node->form;
4466 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4468 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4469 always better to put it inline. */
4470 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4471 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4473 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4474 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4475 single module. */
4476 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4477 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4478 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4479 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4481 set_indirect_string (node);
4483 return node->form;
4486 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4487 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4489 static enum dwarf_form
4490 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4492 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4493 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4496 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4498 static inline void
4499 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4501 dw_attr_node attr;
4502 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4504 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4505 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4506 if (targ_die == NULL)
4507 return;
4509 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4510 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4511 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4512 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4513 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4514 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4517 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4519 static inline void
4520 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4522 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4523 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4524 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4527 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4528 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4530 static inline void
4531 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4533 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4534 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4535 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4538 static inline dw_die_ref
4539 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4541 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4542 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4545 static inline int
4546 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4548 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4549 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4551 return 0;
4554 static inline void
4555 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4557 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4558 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4561 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4563 static inline void
4564 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4566 dw_attr_node attr;
4568 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4569 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4570 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4571 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4572 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4575 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4577 static inline void
4578 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4580 dw_attr_node attr;
4582 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4583 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4584 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4585 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4586 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4589 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4590 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4592 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4593 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4596 static inline void
4597 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4599 dw_attr_node attr;
4601 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4602 return;
4604 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4605 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4606 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4607 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4608 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4609 have_location_lists = true;
4612 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4613 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4615 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4616 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4619 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4620 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4622 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4623 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4626 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4628 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4629 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4632 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4634 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4636 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4638 hashval_t
4639 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4641 inchash::hash hstate;
4642 switch (a->kind)
4644 case ate_kind_rtx:
4645 hstate.add_int (0);
4646 break;
4647 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4648 hstate.add_int (1);
4649 break;
4650 case ate_kind_label:
4651 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4652 default:
4653 gcc_unreachable ();
4655 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4656 return hstate.end ();
4659 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4661 bool
4662 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4664 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4665 return 0;
4666 switch (a1->kind)
4668 case ate_kind_rtx:
4669 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4670 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4671 case ate_kind_label:
4672 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4673 default:
4674 gcc_unreachable ();
4678 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4680 void
4681 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4683 e->kind = kind;
4684 switch (kind)
4686 case ate_kind_rtx:
4687 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4688 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4689 break;
4690 case ate_kind_label:
4691 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4692 break;
4694 e->refcount = 0;
4695 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4698 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4699 index until output time. */
4701 static addr_table_entry *
4702 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4704 addr_table_entry *node;
4705 addr_table_entry finder;
4707 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4708 if (! addr_index_table)
4709 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4710 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4711 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4713 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4715 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4716 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4717 *slot = node;
4719 else
4720 node = *slot;
4722 node->refcount++;
4723 return node;
4726 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4727 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4728 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4729 bugs. */
4731 static void
4732 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4734 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4735 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4736 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4737 entry->refcount--;
4740 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4741 address_table. */
4743 static void
4744 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4746 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4747 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4749 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4750 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4754 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4755 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4756 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4757 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4758 in the same order for each run. */
4761 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4763 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4765 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4766 if (node->refcount == 0)
4767 return 1;
4769 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4770 node->index = *index;
4771 *index += 1;
4773 return 1;
4776 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4777 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4778 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4779 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4781 static inline void
4782 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4783 bool force_direct)
4785 dw_attr_node attr;
4787 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4788 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4789 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4790 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4791 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4792 else
4793 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4794 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4797 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4799 static inline rtx
4800 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
4802 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4803 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4806 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4808 static inline void
4809 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4810 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4812 dw_attr_node attr;
4814 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4815 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4816 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4817 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4818 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4821 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4823 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4824 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
4826 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file
4827 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file_implicit));
4828 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4831 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4833 static inline void
4834 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4835 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4837 dw_attr_node attr;
4839 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4840 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4841 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4842 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4843 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4844 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4847 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4849 static inline void
4850 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4851 const char *lbl_id)
4853 dw_attr_node attr;
4855 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4856 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4857 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4858 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4859 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4860 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4861 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4862 ate_kind_label);
4863 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4866 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4867 debug_line section. */
4869 static inline void
4870 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4871 const char *label)
4873 dw_attr_node attr;
4875 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4876 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4877 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4878 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4879 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4882 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4883 debug_loclists section. */
4885 static inline void
4886 add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4887 const char *label)
4889 dw_attr_node attr;
4891 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4892 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loclistsptr;
4893 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4894 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4895 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4898 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4899 debug_macinfo section. */
4901 static inline void
4902 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4903 const char *label)
4905 dw_attr_node attr;
4907 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4908 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4909 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4910 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4911 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4914 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4916 static inline void
4917 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4918 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4920 dw_attr_node attr;
4922 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4923 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4924 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4925 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4926 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4929 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4930 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4931 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4932 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4934 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4935 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4937 static void
4938 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4939 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4941 dw_attr_node attr;
4943 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4944 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4945 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4946 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4947 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4948 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4949 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4950 else
4951 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4952 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4953 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4956 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4958 static inline const char *
4959 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
4961 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4962 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4965 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4967 static inline const char *
4968 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
4970 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4971 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
4974 static inline const char *
4975 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
4977 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4978 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
4979 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
4980 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loclistsptr
4981 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
4982 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4985 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4987 static dw_attr_node *
4988 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4990 dw_attr_node *a;
4991 unsigned ix;
4992 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4994 if (! die)
4995 return NULL;
4997 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4998 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4999 return a;
5000 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5001 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5002 spec = AT_ref (a);
5004 if (spec)
5005 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5007 return NULL;
5010 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
5012 static dw_die_ref
5013 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
5015 dw_die_ref t;
5017 if (!die)
5018 return NULL;
5020 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
5021 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
5022 die = t;
5024 return die->die_parent;
5027 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5028 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5029 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5031 static inline const char *
5032 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5034 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5036 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5039 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5040 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5041 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5043 static inline const char *
5044 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5046 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5048 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5051 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5052 NULL if it is not present. */
5054 static inline const char *
5055 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5057 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5059 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5062 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5063 if it is not present. */
5065 static inline int
5066 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5068 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5070 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5073 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5074 if it is not present. */
5076 static inline unsigned
5077 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5079 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5081 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5084 static inline dw_die_ref
5085 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5087 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5089 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5092 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5093 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5095 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5097 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5100 /* Returns the ultimate TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL context of DECL or NULL. */
5102 static const_tree
5103 get_ultimate_context (const_tree decl)
5105 while (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) != TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL)
5107 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5108 decl = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5109 else
5110 decl = get_containing_scope (decl);
5112 return decl;
5115 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5117 static inline bool
5118 is_cxx (void)
5120 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5122 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
5123 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
5126 /* Return TRUE if DECL was created by the C++ frontend. */
5128 static bool
5129 is_cxx (const_tree decl)
5131 if (in_lto_p)
5133 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5134 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5135 return strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context), "GNU C++", 7) == 0;
5137 return is_cxx ();
5140 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5142 static inline bool
5143 is_fortran (void)
5145 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5147 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5148 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5149 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
5150 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
5151 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
5154 static inline bool
5155 is_fortran (const_tree decl)
5157 if (in_lto_p)
5159 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5160 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5161 return (strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5162 "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0
5163 || strcmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5164 "GNU F77") == 0);
5166 return is_fortran ();
5169 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5171 static inline bool
5172 is_ada (void)
5174 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5176 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5179 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
5180 was successful. */
5182 static bool
5183 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5185 dw_attr_node *a;
5186 unsigned ix;
5188 if (! die)
5189 return false;
5191 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5192 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5194 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5195 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5196 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5198 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5199 that are needed. */
5200 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
5201 return true;
5203 return false;
5206 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5207 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5209 static void
5210 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5212 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5213 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5214 if (prev == child)
5216 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5217 prev = NULL;
5219 else
5220 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5221 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5222 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5223 child->die_sib = NULL;
5226 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
5227 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
5229 static void
5230 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
5232 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
5234 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
5235 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
5237 new_child->die_parent = parent;
5238 if (prev == old_child)
5240 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
5241 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
5243 else
5245 prev->die_sib = new_child;
5246 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
5248 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
5249 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
5250 old_child->die_sib = NULL;
5253 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
5255 static void
5256 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5258 dw_die_ref c;
5259 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
5260 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
5261 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
5264 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5265 matches TAG. */
5267 static void
5268 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5270 dw_die_ref c;
5272 c = die->die_child;
5273 if (c) do {
5274 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5275 c = c->die_sib;
5276 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5278 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5279 c->die_parent = NULL;
5280 /* Might have removed every child. */
5281 if (die->die_child == NULL)
5282 return;
5283 c = prev->die_sib;
5285 } while (c != die->die_child);
5288 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5290 static void
5291 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5293 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5294 if (! die || ! child_die)
5295 return;
5296 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5298 child_die->die_parent = die;
5299 if (die->die_child)
5301 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5302 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5304 else
5305 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5306 die->die_child = child_die;
5309 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE. */
5311 static void
5312 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
5313 dw_die_ref after_die)
5315 gcc_assert (die
5316 && child_die
5317 && after_die
5318 && die->die_child
5319 && die != child_die);
5321 child_die->die_parent = die;
5322 child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
5323 after_die->die_sib = child_die;
5324 if (die->die_child == after_die)
5325 die->die_child = child_die;
5328 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
5329 NEW_PARENT. */
5331 static void
5332 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5334 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5335 if (p->die_sib == child)
5337 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5338 break;
5340 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5343 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5344 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5345 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5347 static void
5348 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5350 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5351 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5352 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5354 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5356 if (tmp)
5357 child = tmp;
5360 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5361 || (child->die_parent
5362 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5364 reparent_child (child, parent);
5367 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5368 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5369 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5370 later. */
5372 static inline dw_die_ref
5373 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5375 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5377 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5379 if (parent_die != NULL)
5380 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5381 else
5383 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5385 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5386 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5387 streaming. */
5388 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5389 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5390 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5391 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5392 && tag_value != DW_TAG_skeleton_unit
5393 && !early_dwarf
5394 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5395 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5396 them up. */
5397 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5398 || !decl_function_context (t))
5399 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5400 are local to a function will be fixed in
5401 decls_for_scope. */
5402 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5403 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5404 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5405 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5406 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5407 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5408 && !in_lto_p)
5410 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5411 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5412 gcc_unreachable ();
5415 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5416 limbo_node->die = die;
5417 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5418 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5419 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5422 return die;
5425 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5427 static inline dw_die_ref
5428 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5430 dw_die_ref die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5431 if (die && die->removed)
5433 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = NULL;
5434 return NULL;
5436 return die;
5439 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5440 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5441 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5443 static inline dw_die_ref
5444 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5446 if (type
5447 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5448 && type_die
5449 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5450 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5451 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5452 return type_die;
5455 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5456 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5457 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5458 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5459 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5460 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5462 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5463 a naming typedef is. */
5465 static inline dw_die_ref
5466 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5468 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5469 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5472 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5474 static inline void
5475 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5477 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5480 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5482 inline hashval_t
5483 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5485 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5488 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5490 inline bool
5491 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5493 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5496 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5498 static inline dw_die_ref
5499 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5501 dw_die_ref *die = decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl),
5502 NO_INSERT);
5503 if (!die)
5504 return NULL;
5505 if ((*die)->removed)
5507 decl_die_table->clear_slot (die);
5508 return NULL;
5510 return *die;
5514 /* For DECL which might have early dwarf output query a SYMBOL + OFFSET
5515 style reference. Return true if we found one refering to a DIE for
5516 DECL, otherwise return false. */
5518 static bool
5519 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
5520 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off)
5522 dw_die_ref die;
5524 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5525 return false;
5527 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5528 die = BLOCK_DIE (decl);
5529 else
5530 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
5531 if (!die)
5532 return false;
5534 /* During WPA stage we currently use DIEs to store the
5535 decl <-> label + offset map. That's quite inefficient but it
5536 works for now. */
5537 if (flag_wpa)
5539 dw_die_ref ref = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
5540 if (!ref)
5542 gcc_assert (die == comp_unit_die ());
5543 return false;
5545 *off = ref->die_offset;
5546 *sym = ref->die_id.die_symbol;
5547 return true;
5550 /* Similar to get_ref_die_offset_label, but using the "correct"
5551 label. */
5552 *off = die->die_offset;
5553 while (die->die_parent)
5554 die = die->die_parent;
5555 /* For the containing CU DIE we compute a die_symbol in
5556 compute_comp_unit_symbol. */
5557 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
5558 && die->die_id.die_symbol != NULL);
5559 *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
5560 return true;
5563 /* Add a reference of kind ATTR_KIND to a DIE at SYMBOL + OFFSET to DIE. */
5565 static void
5566 add_AT_external_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5567 const char *symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5569 /* Create a fake DIE that contains the reference. Don't use
5570 new_die because we don't want to end up in the limbo list. */
5571 dw_die_ref ref = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5572 ref->die_tag = die->die_tag;
5573 ref->die_id.die_symbol = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (symbol));
5574 ref->die_offset = offset;
5575 ref->with_offset = 1;
5576 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, ref);
5579 /* Create a DIE for DECL if required and add a reference to a DIE
5580 at SYMBOL + OFFSET which contains attributes dumped early. */
5582 static void
5583 dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
5584 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off)
5586 if (debug_info_level == DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
5587 return;
5589 if (flag_wpa && !decl_die_table)
5590 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (1000);
5592 dw_die_ref die
5593 = TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK ? BLOCK_DIE (decl) : lookup_decl_die (decl);
5594 gcc_assert (!die);
5596 tree ctx;
5597 dw_die_ref parent = NULL;
5598 /* Need to lookup a DIE for the decls context - the containing
5599 function or translation unit. */
5600 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5602 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5603 /* ??? We do not output DIEs for all scopes thus skip as
5604 many DIEs as needed. */
5605 while (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK
5606 && !BLOCK_DIE (ctx))
5607 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (ctx);
5609 else
5610 ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5611 while (ctx && TYPE_P (ctx))
5612 ctx = TYPE_CONTEXT (ctx);
5613 if (ctx)
5615 if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK)
5616 parent = BLOCK_DIE (ctx);
5617 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
5618 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5619 && !flag_wpa)
5620 /* Otherwise all late annotations go to the main CU which
5621 imports the original CUs. */
5622 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5623 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == FUNCTION_DECL
5624 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL
5625 && TREE_CODE (decl) != BLOCK)
5626 /* Leave function local entities parent determination to when
5627 we process scope vars. */
5629 else
5630 parent = lookup_decl_die (ctx);
5632 else
5633 /* In some cases the FEs fail to set DECL_CONTEXT properly.
5634 Handle this case gracefully by globalizing stuff. */
5635 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5636 /* Create a DIE "stub". */
5637 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
5639 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
5640 if (! flag_wpa)
5642 die = comp_unit_die ();
5643 dw_die_ref import = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_unit, die, NULL_TREE);
5644 add_AT_external_die_ref (import, DW_AT_import, sym, off);
5645 /* We re-target all CU decls to the LTRANS CU DIE, so no need
5646 to create a DIE for the original CUs. */
5647 return;
5649 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5650 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, decl);
5651 break;
5652 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
5653 if (is_fortran (decl))
5654 die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, parent, decl);
5655 else
5656 die = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, parent, decl);
5657 break;
5658 case FUNCTION_DECL:
5659 die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, parent, decl);
5660 break;
5661 case VAR_DECL:
5662 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5663 break;
5664 case RESULT_DECL:
5665 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
5666 break;
5667 case PARM_DECL:
5668 die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, parent, decl);
5669 break;
5670 case CONST_DECL:
5671 die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, parent, decl);
5672 break;
5673 case LABEL_DECL:
5674 die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, parent, decl);
5675 break;
5676 case BLOCK:
5677 die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, parent, decl);
5678 break;
5679 default:
5680 gcc_unreachable ();
5682 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5683 BLOCK_DIE (decl) = die;
5684 else
5685 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
5687 /* Add a reference to the DIE providing early debug at $sym + off. */
5688 add_AT_external_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, sym, off);
5691 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5693 inline hashval_t
5694 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5696 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5699 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5700 UID of decl *Y. */
5702 inline bool
5703 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5705 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5708 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5710 static inline var_loc_list *
5711 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5713 if (!decl_loc_table)
5714 return NULL;
5715 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5718 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5720 inline hashval_t
5721 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5723 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5726 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5727 UID of decl *Y. */
5729 inline bool
5730 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5732 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5735 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5737 static void
5738 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5740 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5742 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5743 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5746 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5748 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5749 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5751 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5752 if (ret)
5753 return ret;
5754 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5755 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5756 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5759 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5761 static rtx *
5762 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5764 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5765 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5766 else
5767 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5770 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5771 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5773 static rtx_expr_list *
5774 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5776 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5777 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5778 else
5779 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5780 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5781 loc_note), next);
5784 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5785 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5787 static rtx
5788 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5789 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5791 if (bitsize != -1)
5793 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5794 if (bitpos != 0)
5795 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5797 return loc_note;
5800 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5801 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5802 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5803 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5804 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5805 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5806 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5807 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5808 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5810 static void
5811 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5812 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5813 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5815 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5816 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5818 if (copy)
5820 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5821 while (src != inner)
5823 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5824 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5825 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5826 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5829 /* Add padding if needed. */
5830 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5832 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5833 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5834 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5836 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5838 gcc_assert (!copy);
5839 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5840 just update the location for it and return. */
5841 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5842 return;
5844 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5845 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5846 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5847 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5848 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5849 if (!copy)
5850 src = dest;
5851 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5853 rtx piece = *src;
5854 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5855 if (copy)
5856 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5857 else
5859 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5860 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5863 /* Add padding if needed. */
5864 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5866 if (!copy)
5867 dest = src;
5868 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5869 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5871 if (!copy)
5872 return;
5873 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5874 while (*src)
5876 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5877 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5878 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5879 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5883 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5885 static struct var_loc_node *
5886 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5888 unsigned int decl_id;
5889 var_loc_list *temp;
5890 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5891 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5893 if (VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5895 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5896 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5897 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5898 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5900 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
5901 bool reverse;
5902 tree innerdecl
5903 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize,
5904 &reverse);
5905 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
5906 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5907 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5908 || bitsize <= 0
5909 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
5910 || bitsize != maxsize)
5911 return NULL;
5912 decl = innerdecl;
5916 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5917 var_loc_list **slot
5918 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5919 if (*slot == NULL)
5921 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5922 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5923 *slot = temp;
5925 else
5926 temp = *slot;
5928 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5929 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5930 if (temp->last
5931 && temp->first == temp->last
5932 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5933 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5934 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5935 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5936 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5937 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5938 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5939 && prev_real_insn (as_a<rtx_insn *> (temp->first->loc)) == NULL_RTX
5940 && (bitsize != -1
5941 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5942 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5943 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5944 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5946 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5947 temp->first->next = loc;
5948 temp->last = loc;
5949 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5951 else if (temp->last)
5953 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5954 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5955 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5956 if (last->next)
5958 last = last->next;
5959 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5961 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5963 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5966 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5967 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5968 break;
5969 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5970 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5972 while (*piece_loc);
5974 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5975 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5976 last element. */
5977 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
5979 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
5980 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
5981 if (piece_loc != NULL)
5983 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
5984 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5985 return NULL;
5987 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
5988 if (temp->last != last)
5990 temp->last->next = NULL;
5991 unused = last;
5992 last = temp->last;
5993 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
5995 else
5997 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
5998 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
5999 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
6000 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
6001 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6002 return temp->last;
6005 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
6006 last_loc_note = last->loc;
6007 else if (piece_loc != NULL
6008 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
6009 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
6010 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
6011 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
6012 else
6013 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
6014 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
6015 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
6016 we have nothing to do. */
6017 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
6018 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
6019 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
6020 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6021 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
6022 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6023 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6024 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
6025 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
6027 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
6028 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
6029 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
6030 if (unused)
6032 loc = unused;
6033 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
6035 else
6036 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6037 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
6038 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6039 else
6040 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
6041 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6042 last->next = loc;
6043 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
6044 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
6045 if (last != temp->last)
6046 temp->last = last;
6048 else if (unused)
6049 ggc_free (unused);
6051 else
6053 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6054 temp->first = loc;
6055 temp->last = loc;
6056 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6058 return loc;
6061 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
6062 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
6063 the DIE internal representation. */
6064 static int print_indent;
6066 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
6068 static inline void
6069 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
6071 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
6074 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
6076 static inline void
6077 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
6079 int i;
6081 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
6082 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
6085 static inline void
6086 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
6088 if (discr_value->pos)
6089 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
6090 else
6091 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
6094 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
6096 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
6097 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
6099 static void
6100 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6102 switch (val->val_class)
6104 case dw_val_class_addr:
6105 fprintf (outfile, "address");
6106 break;
6107 case dw_val_class_offset:
6108 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
6109 break;
6110 case dw_val_class_loc:
6111 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
6112 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
6113 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
6114 else if (recurse)
6116 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
6117 print_indent += 4;
6118 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
6119 print_indent -= 4;
6121 else
6122 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
6123 break;
6124 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6125 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
6126 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
6127 break;
6128 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6129 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
6130 break;
6131 case dw_val_class_const:
6132 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6133 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
6134 break;
6135 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6136 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6137 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
6138 break;
6139 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6140 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
6141 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
6142 val->v.val_double.high,
6143 val->v.val_double.low);
6144 break;
6145 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6147 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
6148 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
6149 gcc_assert (i > 0);
6150 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
6151 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
6152 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6153 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
6154 while (--i >= 0)
6155 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
6156 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
6157 fprintf (outfile, ")");
6158 break;
6160 case dw_val_class_vec:
6161 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
6162 break;
6163 case dw_val_class_flag:
6164 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
6165 break;
6166 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6167 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
6169 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
6171 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6173 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
6174 print_signature (outfile,
6175 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6177 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
6179 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
6180 if (die->with_offset)
6181 fprintf (outfile, " + %ld", die->die_offset);
6183 else
6184 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
6185 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
6187 else
6188 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
6189 break;
6190 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6191 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
6192 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
6193 break;
6194 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6195 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6196 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6197 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6198 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6199 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
6200 break;
6201 case dw_val_class_str:
6202 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
6203 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
6204 else
6205 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
6206 break;
6207 case dw_val_class_file:
6208 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6209 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
6210 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
6211 break;
6212 case dw_val_class_data8:
6214 int i;
6216 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
6217 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
6218 break;
6220 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
6221 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
6222 break;
6223 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
6224 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
6225 node != NULL;
6226 node = node->dw_discr_next)
6228 if (node->dw_discr_range)
6230 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
6231 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6232 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
6234 else
6235 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6237 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
6238 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
6240 default:
6241 break;
6245 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
6247 static void
6248 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6250 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
6254 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
6255 routine is a debugging aid only. */
6257 static void
6258 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
6260 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
6262 if (loc == NULL)
6264 print_spaces (outfile);
6265 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
6266 return;
6269 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
6271 print_spaces (outfile);
6272 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
6273 (void *) l,
6274 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
6275 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6277 fprintf (outfile, " ");
6278 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
6280 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6282 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
6283 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
6285 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6289 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
6290 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6292 static void
6293 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
6295 dw_attr_node *a;
6296 dw_die_ref c;
6297 unsigned ix;
6299 print_spaces (outfile);
6300 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
6301 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
6302 (void*) die);
6303 print_spaces (outfile);
6304 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
6305 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
6306 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
6308 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6310 print_spaces (outfile);
6311 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
6312 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6313 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6316 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6318 print_spaces (outfile);
6319 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
6321 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
6322 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6325 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6327 print_indent += 4;
6328 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
6329 print_indent -= 4;
6331 if (print_indent == 0)
6332 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6335 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
6337 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6338 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
6340 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
6343 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6345 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6346 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6348 print_die (die, stderr);
6351 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6352 debug (die_struct &ref)
6354 print_die (&ref, stderr);
6357 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6358 debug (die_struct *ptr)
6360 if (ptr)
6361 debug (*ptr);
6362 else
6363 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
6367 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6368 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6370 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6371 debug_dwarf (void)
6373 print_indent = 0;
6374 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
6377 /* Verify the DIE tree structure. */
6379 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6380 verify_die (dw_die_ref die)
6382 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6383 if (die->die_parent == NULL
6384 && die->die_sib == NULL)
6385 return;
6386 /* Verify the die_sib list is cyclic. */
6387 dw_die_ref x = die;
6390 x->die_mark = 1;
6391 x = x->die_sib;
6393 while (x && !x->die_mark);
6394 gcc_assert (x == die);
6395 x = die;
6398 /* Verify all dies have the same parent. */
6399 gcc_assert (x->die_parent == die->die_parent);
6400 if (x->die_child)
6402 /* Verify the child has the proper parent and recurse. */
6403 gcc_assert (x->die_child->die_parent == x);
6404 verify_die (x->die_child);
6406 x->die_mark = 0;
6407 x = x->die_sib;
6409 while (x && x->die_mark);
6412 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
6414 static void
6415 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
6417 unsigned ix;
6418 dw_attr_node *a;
6419 bool inline_found = false;
6420 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
6421 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_column = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
6422 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6424 switch (a->dw_attr)
6426 case DW_AT_inline:
6427 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
6428 inline_found = true;
6429 break;
6430 case DW_AT_location:
6431 ++n_location;
6432 break;
6433 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6434 ++n_low_pc;
6435 break;
6436 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6437 ++n_high_pc;
6438 break;
6439 case DW_AT_artificial:
6440 ++n_artificial;
6441 break;
6442 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6443 ++n_decl_column;
6444 break;
6445 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6446 ++n_decl_line;
6447 break;
6448 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6449 ++n_decl_file;
6450 break;
6451 default:
6452 break;
6455 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
6456 || n_decl_column > 1 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
6458 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
6459 debug_dwarf_die (die);
6460 gcc_unreachable ();
6462 if (inline_found)
6464 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
6465 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
6466 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
6467 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
6468 expansions. */
6469 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6470 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
6471 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
6472 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
6473 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
6474 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_call_all_calls
6475 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
6479 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6480 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6481 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6483 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6485 static inline void
6486 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6488 int tem;
6489 inchash::hash hstate;
6490 hashval_t hash;
6492 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
6493 CHECKSUM (tem);
6494 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6495 hash = hstate.end();
6496 CHECKSUM (hash);
6499 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6501 static void
6502 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6504 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6505 rtx r;
6507 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6509 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6510 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6511 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6512 return;
6514 switch (AT_class (at))
6516 case dw_val_class_const:
6517 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6518 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6519 break;
6520 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6521 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6522 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6523 break;
6524 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6525 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6526 break;
6527 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6528 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6529 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6530 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6531 break;
6532 case dw_val_class_vec:
6533 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6534 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6535 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6536 break;
6537 case dw_val_class_flag:
6538 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6539 break;
6540 case dw_val_class_str:
6541 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6542 break;
6544 case dw_val_class_addr:
6545 r = AT_addr (at);
6546 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6547 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6548 break;
6550 case dw_val_class_offset:
6551 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6552 break;
6554 case dw_val_class_loc:
6555 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6556 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6557 break;
6559 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6560 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6561 break;
6563 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6564 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6565 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6566 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6567 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6568 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6569 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6570 break;
6572 case dw_val_class_file:
6573 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6574 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6575 break;
6577 case dw_val_class_data8:
6578 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6579 break;
6581 default:
6582 break;
6586 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6588 static void
6589 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6591 dw_die_ref c;
6592 dw_attr_node *a;
6593 unsigned ix;
6595 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6596 if (die->die_mark)
6598 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6599 return;
6601 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6603 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6605 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6606 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6608 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6611 #undef CHECKSUM
6612 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6613 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6615 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6616 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6617 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6618 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6619 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6620 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6621 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6622 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6624 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6626 static void
6627 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6629 unsigned char byte;
6630 bool more;
6632 while (1)
6634 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6635 value >>= 7;
6636 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6637 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6638 if (more)
6639 byte |= 0x80;
6640 CHECKSUM (byte);
6641 if (!more)
6642 break;
6646 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
6648 static void
6649 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6651 while (1)
6653 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6654 value >>= 7;
6655 if (value != 0)
6656 /* More bytes to follow. */
6657 byte |= 0x80;
6658 CHECKSUM (byte);
6659 if (value == 0)
6660 break;
6664 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
6665 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
6667 static void
6668 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6670 const char *name;
6671 dw_die_ref spec;
6672 int tag = die->die_tag;
6674 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6675 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6676 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6677 return;
6679 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6681 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6682 if (spec != NULL)
6683 die = spec;
6685 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
6686 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
6688 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
6689 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6690 if (name != NULL)
6691 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6694 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6696 static inline void
6697 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6699 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
6700 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
6701 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
6703 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6704 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
6705 return;
6708 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
6709 while (loc != NULL)
6711 inchash::hash hstate;
6712 hashval_t hash;
6714 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
6715 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6716 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6717 hash = hstate.end ();
6718 CHECKSUM (hash);
6719 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
6723 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6725 static void
6726 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
6727 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6729 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6730 rtx r;
6732 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6734 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
6736 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
6737 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
6738 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
6739 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
6740 is complete or not. */
6741 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
6742 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6743 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6744 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6745 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
6746 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
6747 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
6749 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
6751 if (name_attr != NULL)
6753 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6755 if (decl == NULL)
6756 decl = target_die;
6757 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
6758 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6759 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6760 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6761 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
6762 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6763 return;
6767 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
6768 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
6769 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
6770 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
6772 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
6773 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6774 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
6776 else
6778 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6780 if (decl == NULL)
6781 decl = target_die;
6782 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6783 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
6784 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6785 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6786 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6787 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
6789 return;
6792 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
6793 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6795 switch (AT_class (at))
6797 case dw_val_class_const:
6798 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6799 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6800 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6801 break;
6803 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6804 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6805 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6806 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6807 break;
6809 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6810 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6811 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6812 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6813 break;
6815 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6816 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6817 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6818 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6819 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6820 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6821 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6822 break;
6824 case dw_val_class_vec:
6825 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6826 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6827 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6828 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6829 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6830 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6831 break;
6833 case dw_val_class_flag:
6834 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6835 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6836 break;
6838 case dw_val_class_str:
6839 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6840 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6841 break;
6843 case dw_val_class_addr:
6844 r = AT_addr (at);
6845 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6846 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6847 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6848 break;
6850 case dw_val_class_offset:
6851 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6852 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6853 break;
6855 case dw_val_class_loc:
6856 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6857 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6858 break;
6860 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6861 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6862 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6863 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6864 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6865 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6866 break;
6868 case dw_val_class_file:
6869 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6870 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6871 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6872 break;
6874 case dw_val_class_data8:
6875 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6876 break;
6878 default:
6879 break;
6883 struct checksum_attributes
6885 dw_attr_node *at_name;
6886 dw_attr_node *at_type;
6887 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
6888 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
6889 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
6890 dw_attr_node *at_alignment;
6891 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
6892 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
6893 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
6894 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
6895 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
6896 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
6897 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
6898 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
6899 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
6900 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
6901 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
6902 dw_attr_node *at_count;
6903 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
6904 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
6905 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
6906 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
6907 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
6908 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
6909 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
6910 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
6911 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
6912 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
6913 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
6914 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
6915 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
6916 dw_attr_node *at_location;
6917 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
6918 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
6919 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
6920 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
6921 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
6922 dw_attr_node *at_small;
6923 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
6924 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
6925 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_bit_size;
6926 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_byte_size;
6927 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
6928 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
6929 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
6930 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
6931 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
6932 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
6933 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
6934 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
6937 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6939 static void
6940 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6942 dw_attr_node *a;
6943 unsigned ix;
6945 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6947 switch (a->dw_attr)
6949 case DW_AT_name:
6950 attrs->at_name = a;
6951 break;
6952 case DW_AT_type:
6953 attrs->at_type = a;
6954 break;
6955 case DW_AT_friend:
6956 attrs->at_friend = a;
6957 break;
6958 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6959 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6960 break;
6961 case DW_AT_address_class:
6962 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6963 break;
6964 case DW_AT_alignment:
6965 attrs->at_alignment = a;
6966 break;
6967 case DW_AT_allocated:
6968 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6969 break;
6970 case DW_AT_artificial:
6971 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6972 break;
6973 case DW_AT_associated:
6974 attrs->at_associated = a;
6975 break;
6976 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6977 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6978 break;
6979 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6980 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
6981 break;
6982 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6983 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
6984 break;
6985 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6986 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
6987 break;
6988 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6989 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
6990 break;
6991 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6992 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
6993 break;
6994 case DW_AT_const_value:
6995 attrs->at_const_value = a;
6996 break;
6997 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6998 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
6999 break;
7000 case DW_AT_count:
7001 attrs->at_count = a;
7002 break;
7003 case DW_AT_data_location:
7004 attrs->at_data_location = a;
7005 break;
7006 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7007 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
7008 break;
7009 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
7010 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
7011 break;
7012 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
7013 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
7014 break;
7015 case DW_AT_default_value:
7016 attrs->at_default_value = a;
7017 break;
7018 case DW_AT_digit_count:
7019 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
7020 break;
7021 case DW_AT_discr:
7022 attrs->at_discr = a;
7023 break;
7024 case DW_AT_discr_list:
7025 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
7026 break;
7027 case DW_AT_discr_value:
7028 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
7029 break;
7030 case DW_AT_encoding:
7031 attrs->at_encoding = a;
7032 break;
7033 case DW_AT_endianity:
7034 attrs->at_endianity = a;
7035 break;
7036 case DW_AT_explicit:
7037 attrs->at_explicit = a;
7038 break;
7039 case DW_AT_is_optional:
7040 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
7041 break;
7042 case DW_AT_location:
7043 attrs->at_location = a;
7044 break;
7045 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7046 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
7047 break;
7048 case DW_AT_mutable:
7049 attrs->at_mutable = a;
7050 break;
7051 case DW_AT_ordering:
7052 attrs->at_ordering = a;
7053 break;
7054 case DW_AT_picture_string:
7055 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
7056 break;
7057 case DW_AT_prototyped:
7058 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
7059 break;
7060 case DW_AT_small:
7061 attrs->at_small = a;
7062 break;
7063 case DW_AT_segment:
7064 attrs->at_segment = a;
7065 break;
7066 case DW_AT_string_length:
7067 attrs->at_string_length = a;
7068 break;
7069 case DW_AT_string_length_bit_size:
7070 attrs->at_string_length_bit_size = a;
7071 break;
7072 case DW_AT_string_length_byte_size:
7073 attrs->at_string_length_byte_size = a;
7074 break;
7075 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
7076 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
7077 break;
7078 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7079 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
7080 break;
7081 case DW_AT_use_location:
7082 attrs->at_use_location = a;
7083 break;
7084 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7085 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
7086 break;
7087 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7088 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
7089 break;
7090 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7091 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
7092 break;
7093 case DW_AT_visibility:
7094 attrs->at_visibility = a;
7095 break;
7096 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7097 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
7098 break;
7099 default:
7100 break;
7105 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
7107 static void
7108 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7110 dw_die_ref c;
7111 dw_die_ref decl;
7112 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
7114 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
7115 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
7117 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
7119 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7120 if (decl != NULL)
7121 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
7122 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
7124 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
7125 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
7126 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
7127 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
7128 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
7129 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
7130 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
7131 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
7132 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
7133 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
7134 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
7135 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
7136 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
7137 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
7138 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
7139 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
7140 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
7141 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
7142 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
7143 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
7144 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
7145 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
7146 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
7147 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
7148 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
7149 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
7150 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
7151 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
7152 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
7153 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
7154 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
7155 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
7156 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
7157 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
7158 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
7159 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
7160 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
7161 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_bit_size);
7162 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_byte_size);
7163 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
7164 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
7165 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
7166 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
7167 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
7168 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
7169 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
7170 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
7171 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
7172 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
7173 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_alignment);
7175 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
7176 c = die->die_child;
7177 if (c) do {
7178 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
7180 c = c->die_sib;
7181 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
7182 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7184 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
7186 else if (name_attr != NULL
7187 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
7189 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
7190 functions. */
7191 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
7192 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
7193 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7195 else
7197 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
7198 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
7199 if (c->die_mark == 0)
7200 c->die_mark = -1;
7201 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
7203 } while (c != die->die_child);
7205 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
7208 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
7209 static void
7210 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
7212 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7213 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7216 #undef CHECKSUM
7217 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
7218 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
7219 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
7220 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
7222 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
7223 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
7224 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
7225 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
7226 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
7227 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
7228 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
7230 static void
7231 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
7233 int mark;
7234 const char *name;
7235 unsigned char checksum[16];
7236 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7237 dw_die_ref decl;
7238 dw_die_ref parent;
7240 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7241 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7242 parent = get_die_parent (die);
7244 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
7245 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
7246 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
7248 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
7250 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7252 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7253 if (parent != NULL)
7254 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7256 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
7257 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
7258 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7260 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
7263 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
7265 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7266 mark = 1;
7267 die->die_mark = mark;
7269 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7270 if (parent != NULL)
7271 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7273 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
7274 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
7275 unmark_all_dies (die);
7276 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7278 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
7279 type node together. */
7280 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
7281 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
7282 die->comdat_type_p = true;
7283 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7284 type_node->type_die = die;
7286 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
7287 as well. */
7288 if (decl != NULL)
7290 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7291 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7295 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
7296 static inline int
7297 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
7299 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
7300 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
7301 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
7304 /* Do the values look the same? */
7305 static int
7306 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
7308 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
7309 rtx r1, r2;
7311 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
7312 return 0;
7314 switch (v1->val_class)
7316 case dw_val_class_const:
7317 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7318 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
7319 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7320 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7321 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
7322 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7323 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
7324 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
7325 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7326 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
7327 case dw_val_class_vec:
7328 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
7329 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
7330 return 0;
7331 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
7332 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
7333 return 0;
7334 return 1;
7335 case dw_val_class_flag:
7336 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
7337 case dw_val_class_str:
7338 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
7340 case dw_val_class_addr:
7341 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
7342 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
7343 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
7344 return 0;
7345 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
7347 case dw_val_class_offset:
7348 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
7350 case dw_val_class_loc:
7351 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
7352 loc1 && loc2;
7353 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
7354 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
7355 return 0;
7356 return !loc1 && !loc2;
7358 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7359 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
7361 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7362 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7363 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7364 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7365 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7366 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7367 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7368 return 1;
7370 case dw_val_class_file:
7371 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7372 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
7374 case dw_val_class_data8:
7375 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
7377 default:
7378 return 1;
7382 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
7384 static int
7385 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
7387 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
7388 return 0;
7390 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
7391 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
7392 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
7393 return 1;
7395 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
7398 /* Do the dies look the same? */
7400 static int
7401 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
7403 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
7404 dw_attr_node *a1;
7405 unsigned ix;
7407 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
7408 if (die1->die_mark)
7409 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
7410 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7412 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
7413 return 0;
7415 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
7416 return 0;
7418 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
7419 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
7420 return 0;
7422 c1 = die1->die_child;
7423 c2 = die2->die_child;
7424 if (! c1)
7426 if (c2)
7427 return 0;
7429 else
7430 for (;;)
7432 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
7433 return 0;
7434 c1 = c1->die_sib;
7435 c2 = c2->die_sib;
7436 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
7438 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
7439 break;
7440 else
7441 return 0;
7445 return 1;
7448 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
7449 children, and set die_symbol. */
7451 static void
7452 compute_comp_unit_symbol (dw_die_ref unit_die)
7454 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
7455 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
7456 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
7457 char *p;
7458 int i, mark;
7459 unsigned char checksum[16];
7460 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7462 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
7463 the name filename of the unit. */
7465 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7466 mark = 0;
7467 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
7468 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
7469 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7471 /* When we this for comp_unit_die () we have a DW_AT_name that might
7472 not start with a letter but with anything valid for filenames and
7473 clean_symbol_name doesn't fix that up. Prepend 'g' if the first
7474 character is not a letter. */
7475 sprintf (name, "%s%s.", ISALPHA (*base) ? "" : "g", base);
7476 clean_symbol_name (name);
7478 p = name + strlen (name);
7479 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
7481 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
7482 p += 2;
7485 unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
7488 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
7490 static int
7491 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
7493 switch (die->die_tag)
7495 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7496 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7497 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7498 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7499 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7500 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7501 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7502 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7503 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7504 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7505 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7506 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7507 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7508 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7509 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7510 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7511 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7512 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7513 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7514 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7515 return 1;
7516 default:
7517 return 0;
7521 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
7522 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
7523 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
7524 compilations (functions). */
7526 static int
7527 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
7529 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
7530 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
7531 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
7532 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
7534 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
7535 return 0;
7537 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7538 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7539 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7540 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
7541 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
7543 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
7545 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
7548 return is_type_die (c);
7551 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
7553 static inline bool
7554 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7556 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7557 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7560 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
7562 static inline bool
7563 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7565 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7566 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7567 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit
7568 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7571 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7573 static inline bool
7574 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7576 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7579 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7581 static inline bool
7582 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7584 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7585 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7588 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7590 static inline bool
7591 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7593 switch (die->die_tag)
7595 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7596 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7597 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7598 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7599 return true;
7600 default:
7601 return false;
7605 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7607 static inline bool
7608 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7610 dw_die_ref c;
7612 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7613 return false;
7614 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7615 return false;
7618 static char *
7619 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7621 char buf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7623 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7624 return xstrdup (buf);
7627 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7629 static int
7630 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7632 dw_attr_node *a;
7633 unsigned ix;
7635 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7636 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7637 return 1;
7639 return 0;
7642 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7644 static int
7645 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7647 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7649 if (decl == NULL)
7650 decl = die;
7651 return local_scope_p (decl);
7654 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7655 subprogram. */
7657 static int
7658 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7660 dw_die_ref c;
7662 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7663 return 1;
7664 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7665 return 0;
7668 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7669 COMDAT .debug_types section or .debug_info section with DW_UT_*type
7670 unit type. */
7672 static int
7673 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7675 switch (die->die_tag)
7677 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7678 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7679 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7680 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7681 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7682 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7683 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7684 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7685 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7686 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7687 return 0;
7688 return 1;
7689 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7690 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7691 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7692 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7693 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7694 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7695 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7696 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7697 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7698 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7699 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7700 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7701 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7702 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7703 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7704 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7705 default:
7706 return 0;
7710 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7712 static dw_die_ref
7713 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7715 dw_die_ref clone;
7716 dw_attr_node *a;
7717 unsigned ix;
7719 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7720 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7722 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7723 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7725 return clone;
7728 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7730 static dw_die_ref
7731 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7733 dw_die_ref c;
7734 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7736 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7738 return clone;
7741 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7743 static dw_die_ref
7744 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7746 dw_die_ref clone;
7747 dw_die_ref decl;
7748 dw_attr_node *a;
7749 unsigned ix;
7751 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7752 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7753 return clone_die (die);
7755 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7756 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7757 if (decl != NULL)
7759 clone = clone_die (decl);
7760 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7761 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7762 return clone;
7765 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7766 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7768 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7770 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7771 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7772 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7774 switch (a->dw_attr)
7776 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7777 case DW_AT_artificial:
7778 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7779 case DW_AT_external:
7780 case DW_AT_name:
7781 case DW_AT_type:
7782 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7783 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7784 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7785 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7786 break;
7787 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7788 case DW_AT_alignment:
7789 default:
7790 break;
7794 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7795 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7797 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7798 return clone;
7802 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7804 struct decl_table_entry
7806 dw_die_ref orig;
7807 dw_die_ref copy;
7810 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7812 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7814 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
7816 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7817 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7818 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7821 inline hashval_t
7822 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7824 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7827 inline bool
7828 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7829 const die_struct *entry2)
7831 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7834 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7836 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7837 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7838 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7839 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7841 static dw_die_ref
7842 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7843 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7845 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7846 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7847 dw_die_ref copy;
7848 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7849 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7851 if (decl_table)
7853 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7854 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7855 INSERT);
7856 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7858 entry = *slot;
7859 return entry->copy;
7862 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7863 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7864 entry->orig = die;
7865 entry->copy = NULL;
7866 *slot = entry;
7869 if (parent != NULL)
7871 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7872 if (spec != NULL)
7873 parent = spec;
7874 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7875 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7878 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7879 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7881 if (decl_table)
7883 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7884 entry->copy = copy;
7887 return copy;
7889 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7890 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7891 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7892 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7893 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7895 static dw_die_ref
7896 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7898 dw_die_ref decl;
7899 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7900 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7902 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7903 if (decl == NULL)
7904 decl = die;
7905 else
7907 unsigned ix;
7908 dw_die_ref c;
7909 dw_attr_node *a;
7911 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7912 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7913 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7915 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7916 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7917 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7918 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7920 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7922 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7924 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7925 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7926 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7927 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7930 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7933 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7934 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7936 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7937 if (new_decl != NULL)
7939 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7940 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7944 return orig_parent;
7947 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7948 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7950 static void
7951 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7953 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7954 return;
7956 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7958 if (node->parent != NULL)
7960 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7961 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7965 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7966 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7967 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7969 static void
7970 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7972 skeleton_chain_node node;
7973 dw_die_ref c;
7974 dw_die_ref first;
7975 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7976 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7978 node.parent = parent;
7980 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7981 if (c)
7982 next = c->die_sib;
7983 if (c) do {
7984 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7985 prev = c;
7986 c = next;
7987 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7988 node.old_die = c;
7989 node.new_die = NULL;
7990 if (is_declaration_die (c))
7992 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7994 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
7995 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
7996 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
7997 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7998 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7999 c = prev;
8001 else if (c->comdat_type_p)
8003 /* This is the skeleton of earlier break_out_comdat_types
8004 type. Clone the existing DIE, but keep the children
8005 under the original (which is in the main CU). */
8006 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8008 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8009 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8010 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8011 c = clone;
8012 continue;
8014 else
8016 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
8017 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
8018 all the original's children, where the original came from
8019 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
8020 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8021 move_all_children (c, clone);
8023 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
8024 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
8025 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
8026 the original. */
8027 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
8029 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8030 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8031 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8032 node.old_die = clone;
8033 node.new_die = c;
8034 c = clone;
8037 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8038 } while (next != NULL);
8041 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
8043 static dw_die_ref
8044 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
8046 skeleton_chain_node node;
8048 node.old_die = die;
8049 node.new_die = NULL;
8050 node.parent = NULL;
8052 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
8053 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
8054 at least a declaration in its place. */
8055 if (die->die_parent != NULL
8056 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
8057 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
8058 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
8060 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8061 return node.new_die;
8064 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
8065 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
8066 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
8067 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
8068 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
8069 skeleton tree. */
8071 static dw_die_ref
8072 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
8073 dw_die_ref prev)
8075 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
8077 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
8078 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
8079 that DIE. */
8080 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
8082 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
8083 if (skeleton == NULL)
8084 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8085 else
8087 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
8088 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
8090 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
8091 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
8092 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
8093 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
8094 references to it. */
8095 if (orig_parent != NULL)
8097 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8098 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
8100 else
8101 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
8104 return skeleton;
8107 static void
8108 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8109 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8110 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
8112 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
8113 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
8114 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
8116 static dw_die_ref
8117 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
8118 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8119 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8121 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
8123 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
8124 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
8126 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
8127 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
8128 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
8130 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
8131 bool existed;
8132 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
8133 if (existed)
8134 return die_copy;
8136 die_copy = clone_die (die);
8137 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
8138 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8139 return die_copy;
8142 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
8143 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
8145 static void
8146 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8147 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8148 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8150 dw_attr_node *a;
8151 unsigned i;
8153 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
8155 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8157 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
8158 continue;
8160 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8162 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
8164 case DW_OP_call2:
8165 case DW_OP_call4:
8166 case DW_OP_call_ref:
8167 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
8168 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
8169 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
8170 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
8171 type_node,
8172 copied_dwarf_procs);
8174 default:
8175 break;
8181 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
8182 rewrite references to point to the copies.
8184 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
8185 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
8186 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
8187 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
8189 static void
8190 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
8191 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8192 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8194 dw_die_ref c;
8196 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8197 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
8198 type_node,
8199 copied_dwarf_procs));
8202 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types or .debug_info
8203 DW_UT_*type sections for each type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT
8204 section. */
8206 static void
8207 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
8209 dw_die_ref c;
8210 dw_die_ref first;
8211 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8212 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8213 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
8215 first = c = die->die_child;
8216 if (c)
8217 next = c->die_sib;
8218 if (c) do {
8219 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8220 prev = c;
8221 c = next;
8222 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8223 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
8225 dw_die_ref replacement;
8226 comdat_type_node *type_node;
8228 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
8229 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8231 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
8232 add it to the list of comdat types. */
8233 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
8234 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
8235 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
8236 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
8237 type_node->root_die = unit;
8238 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
8239 comdat_type_list = type_node;
8241 /* Generate the type signature. */
8242 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
8244 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
8245 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
8246 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
8247 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
8248 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
8250 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
8251 add_child_die (unit, c);
8253 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
8254 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
8255 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
8256 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
8257 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
8258 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8260 if (replacement != NULL)
8261 c = replacement;
8263 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
8264 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
8265 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
8266 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
8268 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
8269 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8271 } while (next != NULL);
8274 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
8275 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
8277 static dw_die_ref
8278 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8280 dw_die_ref c;
8281 dw_die_ref clone;
8282 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8283 decl_table_entry **slot;
8285 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8286 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
8287 else
8288 clone = clone_die (die);
8290 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
8291 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
8293 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
8294 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
8295 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
8296 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8298 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8299 entry->orig = die;
8300 entry->copy = clone;
8301 *slot = entry;
8303 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
8304 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
8305 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8307 return clone;
8310 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
8311 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
8312 type_unit). */
8314 static void
8315 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8317 dw_die_ref c;
8318 dw_attr_node *a;
8319 unsigned ix;
8321 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8323 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8325 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8326 decl_table_entry **slot;
8327 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8329 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
8330 continue;
8332 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8333 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8334 INSERT);
8336 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8338 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
8339 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
8340 entry = *slot;
8341 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
8343 else
8345 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
8346 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
8348 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
8349 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
8350 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
8351 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
8352 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8353 entry->orig = targ;
8354 entry->copy = copy;
8355 *slot = entry;
8357 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
8358 children. */
8359 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
8361 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
8362 targ, c,
8363 add_child_die (copy,
8364 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8367 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
8368 type unit. */
8369 mark_dies (copy);
8371 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
8372 into the new type unit. */
8373 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
8374 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
8375 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
8376 decl_table);
8378 add_child_die (parent, copy);
8379 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
8381 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
8382 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8383 get visited otherwise. */
8384 if (parent != unit)
8386 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8387 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
8388 parent->die_mark = 1;
8389 while (parent->die_parent
8390 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8392 parent = parent->die_parent;
8393 parent->die_mark = 1;
8395 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8401 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8404 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8405 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8406 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8407 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8408 don't have an external reference. */
8410 static void
8411 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8413 mark_dies (unit);
8414 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8415 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8416 unmark_dies (unit);
8419 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8420 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8421 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8423 static void
8424 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8426 dw_die_ref c;
8428 if (! die->die_child)
8429 return;
8431 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8432 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8434 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8437 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8439 static void
8440 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8442 dw_die_ref c;
8443 dw_attr_node *a;
8444 unsigned ix;
8446 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8447 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8448 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8450 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8453 /* During assign_location_list_indexes and output_loclists_offset the
8454 current index, after it the number of assigned indexes (i.e. how
8455 large the .debug_loclists* offset table should be). */
8456 static unsigned int loc_list_idx;
8458 /* Output all location list offsets for the DIE and its children. */
8460 static void
8461 output_loclists_offsets (dw_die_ref die)
8463 dw_die_ref c;
8464 dw_attr_node *a;
8465 unsigned ix;
8467 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8468 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8470 dw_loc_list_ref l = AT_loc_list (a);
8471 if (l->offset_emitted)
8472 continue;
8473 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l->ll_symbol,
8474 loc_section_label, NULL);
8475 gcc_assert (l->hash == loc_list_idx);
8476 loc_list_idx++;
8477 l->offset_emitted = true;
8480 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_loclists_offsets (c));
8483 /* Recursively set indexes of location lists. */
8485 static void
8486 assign_location_list_indexes (dw_die_ref die)
8488 dw_die_ref c;
8489 dw_attr_node *a;
8490 unsigned ix;
8492 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8493 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8495 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
8496 if (!list->num_assigned)
8498 list->num_assigned = true;
8499 list->hash = loc_list_idx++;
8503 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_location_list_indexes (c));
8506 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8507 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8508 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8509 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8510 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8511 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8513 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8514 references. */
8516 struct external_ref
8518 dw_die_ref type;
8519 dw_die_ref stub;
8520 unsigned n_refs;
8523 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8525 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8527 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8528 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8531 inline hashval_t
8532 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8534 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8535 hashval_t h = 0;
8537 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8538 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8539 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8540 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8541 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8542 else
8544 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8545 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8546 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8547 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8549 return h;
8552 inline bool
8553 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8555 return r1->type == r2->type;
8558 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8560 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8562 static struct external_ref *
8563 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8565 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8566 external_ref **slot;
8568 ref.type = die;
8569 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8570 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8571 return *slot;
8573 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8574 ref_p->type = die;
8575 *slot = ref_p;
8576 return ref_p;
8579 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8581 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8582 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8584 static void
8585 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8587 dw_die_ref c;
8588 dw_attr_node *a;
8589 unsigned ix;
8590 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8592 if (is_type_die (die)
8593 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8595 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8596 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8597 ref_p->stub = die;
8600 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8601 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8602 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8603 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8604 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8605 && is_type_die (c))
8607 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8608 ref_p->n_refs++;
8611 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8614 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8615 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8616 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8619 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8621 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8623 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8625 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8626 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8627 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8628 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8629 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8630 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8632 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8634 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8635 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8636 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8638 else
8640 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8641 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8642 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8645 stub->die_mark++;
8646 ref_p->stub = stub;
8648 return 1;
8651 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
8652 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
8653 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
8654 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
8656 static external_ref_hash_type *
8657 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
8659 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
8660 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
8661 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
8662 return map;
8665 /* The following 3 variables are temporaries that are computed only during the
8666 build_abbrev_table call and used and released during the following
8667 optimize_abbrev_table call. */
8669 /* First abbrev_id that can be optimized based on usage. */
8670 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_start;
8672 /* Maximum abbrev_id of a base type plus one (we can't optimize DIEs with
8673 abbrev_id smaller than this, because they must be already sized
8674 during build_abbrev_table). */
8675 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_base_type_end;
8677 /* Vector of usage counts during build_abbrev_table. Indexed by
8678 abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start. */
8679 static vec<unsigned int> abbrev_usage_count;
8681 /* Vector of all DIEs added with die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start. */
8682 static vec<dw_die_ref> sorted_abbrev_dies;
8684 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
8685 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
8686 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
8687 die are visited recursively. */
8689 static void
8690 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
8692 unsigned int abbrev_id = 0;
8693 dw_die_ref c;
8694 dw_attr_node *a;
8695 unsigned ix;
8696 dw_die_ref abbrev;
8698 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
8699 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
8700 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
8701 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8702 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8703 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
8705 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8706 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8708 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
8709 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
8710 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
8711 else
8712 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
8713 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
8716 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
8718 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
8719 unsigned ix;
8720 bool ok = true;
8722 if (abbrev_id == 0)
8723 continue;
8724 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
8725 continue;
8726 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
8727 continue;
8729 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
8730 continue;
8732 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
8734 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
8735 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
8736 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
8738 ok = false;
8739 break;
8742 if (ok)
8743 break;
8746 if (abbrev_id >= vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table))
8748 vec_safe_push (abbrev_die_table, die);
8749 if (abbrev_opt_start)
8750 abbrev_usage_count.safe_push (0);
8752 if (abbrev_opt_start && abbrev_id >= abbrev_opt_start)
8754 abbrev_usage_count[abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start]++;
8755 sorted_abbrev_dies.safe_push (die);
8758 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8759 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
8762 /* Callback function for sorted_abbrev_dies vector sorting. We sort
8763 by die_abbrev's usage count, from the most commonly used
8764 abbreviation to the least. */
8766 static int
8767 die_abbrev_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
8769 dw_die_ref die1 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p1;
8770 dw_die_ref die2 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p2;
8772 gcc_checking_assert (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8773 gcc_checking_assert (die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
8775 if (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end
8776 && die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8778 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8779 > abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8780 return -1;
8781 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
8782 < abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
8783 return 1;
8786 /* Stabilize the sort. */
8787 if (die1->die_abbrev < die2->die_abbrev)
8788 return -1;
8789 if (die1->die_abbrev > die2->die_abbrev)
8790 return 1;
8792 return 0;
8795 /* Convert dw_val_class_const and dw_val_class_unsigned_const class attributes
8796 of DIEs in between sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id] and abbrev_dies[end_id - 1]
8797 into dw_val_class_const_implicit or
8798 dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit. */
8800 static void
8801 optimize_implicit_const (unsigned int first_id, unsigned int end,
8802 vec<bool> &implicit_consts)
8804 /* It never makes sense if there is just one DIE using the abbreviation. */
8805 if (end < first_id + 2)
8806 return;
8808 dw_attr_node *a;
8809 unsigned ix, i;
8810 dw_die_ref die = sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id];
8811 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8812 if (implicit_consts[ix])
8814 enum dw_val_class new_class = dw_val_class_none;
8815 switch (AT_class (a))
8817 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8818 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) AT_unsigned (a) < 0)
8819 continue;
8821 /* The .debug_abbrev section will grow by
8822 size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)) and we avoid the constants
8823 in all the DIEs using that abbreviation. */
8824 if (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)) * (end - first_id)
8825 <= (unsigned) size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)))
8826 continue;
8828 new_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit;
8829 break;
8831 case dw_val_class_const:
8832 new_class = dw_val_class_const_implicit;
8833 break;
8835 case dw_val_class_file:
8836 new_class = dw_val_class_file_implicit;
8837 break;
8839 default:
8840 continue;
8842 for (i = first_id; i < end; i++)
8843 (*sorted_abbrev_dies[i]->die_attr)[ix].dw_attr_val.val_class
8844 = new_class;
8848 /* Attempt to optimize abbreviation table from abbrev_opt_start
8849 abbreviation above. */
8851 static void
8852 optimize_abbrev_table (void)
8854 if (abbrev_opt_start
8855 && vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > abbrev_opt_start
8856 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > 127))
8858 auto_vec<bool, 32> implicit_consts;
8859 sorted_abbrev_dies.qsort (die_abbrev_cmp);
8861 unsigned int abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_start - 1;
8862 unsigned int first_id = ~0U;
8863 unsigned int last_abbrev_id = 0;
8864 unsigned int i;
8865 dw_die_ref die;
8866 if (abbrev_opt_base_type_end > abbrev_opt_start)
8867 abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_base_type_end - 1;
8868 /* Reassign abbreviation ids from abbrev_opt_start above, so that
8869 most commonly used abbreviations come first. */
8870 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (sorted_abbrev_dies, i, die)
8872 dw_attr_node *a;
8873 unsigned ix;
8875 /* If calc_base_type_die_sizes has been called, the CU and
8876 base types after it can't be optimized, because we've already
8877 calculated their DIE offsets. We've sorted them first. */
8878 if (die->die_abbrev < abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
8879 continue;
8880 if (die->die_abbrev != last_abbrev_id)
8882 last_abbrev_id = die->die_abbrev;
8883 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8884 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8885 abbrev_id++;
8886 (*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id] = die;
8887 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8889 first_id = i;
8890 implicit_consts.truncate (0);
8892 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8893 switch (AT_class (a))
8895 case dw_val_class_const:
8896 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8897 case dw_val_class_file:
8898 implicit_consts.safe_push (true);
8899 break;
8900 default:
8901 implicit_consts.safe_push (false);
8902 break;
8906 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
8908 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8909 if (!implicit_consts[ix])
8910 continue;
8911 else
8913 dw_attr_node *other_a
8914 = &(*(*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id]->die_attr)[ix];
8915 if (!dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_attr_val,
8916 &other_a->dw_attr_val))
8917 implicit_consts[ix] = false;
8920 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8922 gcc_assert (abbrev_id == vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) - 1);
8923 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
8924 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
8927 abbrev_opt_start = 0;
8928 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = 0;
8929 abbrev_usage_count.release ();
8930 sorted_abbrev_dies.release ();
8933 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
8935 static int
8936 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
8938 int log;
8940 if (value == 0)
8941 log = 0;
8942 else
8943 log = floor_log2 (value);
8945 log = log / 8;
8946 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
8948 return log;
8951 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
8952 .debug_info section. */
8954 static unsigned long
8955 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
8957 unsigned long size = 0;
8958 dw_attr_node *a;
8959 unsigned ix;
8960 enum dwarf_form form;
8962 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8963 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8965 switch (AT_class (a))
8967 case dw_val_class_addr:
8968 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8970 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8971 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8973 else
8974 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8975 break;
8976 case dw_val_class_offset:
8977 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8978 break;
8979 case dw_val_class_loc:
8981 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8983 /* Block length. */
8984 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8985 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
8986 else
8987 size += constant_size (lsize);
8988 size += lsize;
8990 break;
8991 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8992 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && dwarf_version >= 5)
8994 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
8995 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash);
8997 else
8998 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8999 break;
9000 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9001 if (value_format (a) == DW_FORM_rnglistx)
9003 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9004 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9005 size += size_of_uleb128 (r->idx);
9007 else
9008 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9009 break;
9010 case dw_val_class_const:
9011 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9012 break;
9013 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9015 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9016 if (dwarf_version == 3
9017 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9018 && csize >= 4)
9019 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
9020 else
9021 size += csize;
9023 break;
9024 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9025 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9026 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9027 /* These occupy no size in the DIE, just an extra sleb128 in
9028 .debug_abbrev. */
9029 break;
9030 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9031 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9032 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9033 size++; /* block */
9034 break;
9035 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9036 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9037 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
9038 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9039 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9040 size++; /* block */
9041 break;
9042 case dw_val_class_vec:
9043 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9044 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9045 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9046 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9047 break;
9048 case dw_val_class_flag:
9049 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9050 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9051 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9052 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9053 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9054 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9055 the same abbrev entry. */
9056 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9057 else
9058 size += 1;
9059 break;
9060 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9061 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9063 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
9064 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9065 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9066 it's always sized as an offset. */
9067 if (use_debug_types)
9068 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9069 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9070 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9071 else
9072 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9074 else
9075 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9076 break;
9077 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9078 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9079 break;
9080 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9081 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9083 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9084 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9086 else
9087 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9088 break;
9089 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9090 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9091 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9092 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9093 break;
9094 case dw_val_class_str:
9095 form = AT_string_form (a);
9096 if (form == DW_FORM_strp || form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
9097 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9098 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9099 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9100 else
9101 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9102 break;
9103 case dw_val_class_file:
9104 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9105 break;
9106 case dw_val_class_data8:
9107 size += 8;
9108 break;
9109 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9110 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9111 break;
9112 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9113 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9114 break;
9115 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9116 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
9117 break;
9118 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9120 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
9122 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
9123 data. */
9124 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
9126 break;
9127 default:
9128 gcc_unreachable ();
9132 return size;
9135 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9136 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9137 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9138 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9140 static void
9141 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9143 dw_die_ref c;
9145 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
9146 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
9147 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9148 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9150 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
9152 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9153 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
9154 next_die_offset += 1;
9157 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
9158 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
9159 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
9160 values for the base types. */
9162 static void
9163 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
9165 unsigned long die_offset = (dwarf_split_debug_info
9166 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
9167 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
9168 unsigned int i;
9169 dw_die_ref base_type;
9170 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9171 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
9172 #endif
9174 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
9175 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
9177 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9178 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
9179 && prev->die_sib == base_type
9180 && base_type->die_child == NULL
9181 && base_type->die_abbrev);
9182 prev = base_type;
9183 #endif
9184 if (abbrev_opt_start
9185 && base_type->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9186 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = base_type->die_abbrev + 1;
9187 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
9188 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
9192 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
9193 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
9194 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
9195 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
9197 static void
9198 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9200 dw_die_ref c;
9202 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
9204 die->die_mark = 1;
9205 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
9208 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
9210 static void
9211 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9213 dw_die_ref c;
9215 if (! use_debug_types)
9216 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
9218 die->die_mark = 0;
9219 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
9222 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
9224 static void
9225 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9227 dw_die_ref c;
9228 dw_attr_node *a;
9229 unsigned ix;
9231 if (!die->die_mark)
9232 return;
9233 die->die_mark = 0;
9235 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
9237 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9238 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9239 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
9242 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
9243 from a pruned a type. */
9245 static bool
9246 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
9248 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
9249 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
9250 enough information to be useful. */
9251 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
9252 return false;
9254 if (table == pubname_table)
9256 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
9257 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
9258 Don't output them if that is the case. */
9259 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
9260 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
9261 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
9262 return false;
9264 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
9265 return true;
9268 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
9269 pruned. */
9270 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
9271 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
9274 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
9275 generated for the compilation unit. */
9277 static unsigned long
9278 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9280 unsigned long size;
9281 unsigned i;
9282 pubname_entry *p;
9283 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
9285 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
9286 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
9287 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
9288 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
9290 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9291 return size;
9294 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
9296 static unsigned long
9297 size_of_aranges (void)
9299 unsigned long size;
9301 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
9303 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
9304 if (text_section_used)
9305 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9306 if (cold_text_section_used)
9307 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9308 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9310 unsigned fde_idx;
9311 dw_fde_ref fde;
9313 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9315 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9316 continue;
9317 if (!fde->in_std_section)
9318 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9319 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9320 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9324 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
9325 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9326 return size;
9329 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
9331 static enum dwarf_form
9332 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9334 switch (AT_class (a))
9336 case dw_val_class_addr:
9337 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
9338 switch (a->dw_attr)
9340 case DW_AT_low_pc:
9341 case DW_AT_high_pc:
9342 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
9343 case DW_AT_trampoline:
9344 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9345 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9346 default:
9347 break;
9349 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9351 case 1:
9352 return DW_FORM_data1;
9353 case 2:
9354 return DW_FORM_data2;
9355 case 4:
9356 return DW_FORM_data4;
9357 case 8:
9358 return DW_FORM_data8;
9359 default:
9360 gcc_unreachable ();
9362 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9363 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9364 && dwarf_version >= 5
9365 && AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned)
9366 return DW_FORM_loclistx;
9367 /* FALLTHRU */
9368 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9369 /* For range lists in DWARF 5, use DW_FORM_rnglistx from .debug_info.dwo
9370 but in .debug_info use DW_FORM_sec_offset, which is shorter if we
9371 care about sizes of .debug* sections in shared libraries and
9372 executables and don't take into account relocations that affect just
9373 relocatable objects - for DW_FORM_rnglistx we'd have to emit offset
9374 table in the .debug_rnglists section. */
9375 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9376 && dwarf_version >= 5
9377 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_range_list
9378 && rnglist_idx
9379 && a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9380 return DW_FORM_rnglistx;
9381 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9382 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
9383 /* FALLTHRU */
9384 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9385 case dw_val_class_offset:
9386 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
9388 case 4:
9389 return DW_FORM_data4;
9390 case 8:
9391 return DW_FORM_data8;
9392 default:
9393 gcc_unreachable ();
9395 case dw_val_class_loc:
9396 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9397 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
9398 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
9400 case 1:
9401 return DW_FORM_block1;
9402 case 2:
9403 return DW_FORM_block2;
9404 case 4:
9405 return DW_FORM_block4;
9406 default:
9407 gcc_unreachable ();
9409 case dw_val_class_const:
9410 return DW_FORM_sdata;
9411 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9412 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
9414 case 1:
9415 return DW_FORM_data1;
9416 case 2:
9417 return DW_FORM_data2;
9418 case 4:
9419 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
9420 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
9421 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
9422 a large constant. */
9423 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9424 return DW_FORM_udata;
9425 return DW_FORM_data4;
9426 case 8:
9427 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9428 return DW_FORM_udata;
9429 return DW_FORM_data8;
9430 default:
9431 gcc_unreachable ();
9433 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9434 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9435 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9436 return DW_FORM_implicit_const;
9437 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9438 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9440 case 8:
9441 return DW_FORM_data2;
9442 case 16:
9443 return DW_FORM_data4;
9444 case 32:
9445 return DW_FORM_data8;
9446 case 64:
9447 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9448 return DW_FORM_data16;
9449 /* FALLTHRU */
9450 default:
9451 return DW_FORM_block1;
9453 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9454 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9456 case 8:
9457 return DW_FORM_data1;
9458 case 16:
9459 return DW_FORM_data2;
9460 case 32:
9461 return DW_FORM_data4;
9462 case 64:
9463 return DW_FORM_data8;
9464 case 128:
9465 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9466 return DW_FORM_data16;
9467 /* FALLTHRU */
9468 default:
9469 return DW_FORM_block1;
9471 case dw_val_class_vec:
9472 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9473 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
9475 case 1:
9476 return DW_FORM_block1;
9477 case 2:
9478 return DW_FORM_block2;
9479 case 4:
9480 return DW_FORM_block4;
9481 default:
9482 gcc_unreachable ();
9484 case dw_val_class_flag:
9485 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9487 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9488 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9489 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9490 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9491 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9492 the same abbrev entry. */
9493 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9494 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
9496 return DW_FORM_flag;
9497 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9498 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9499 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
9500 else
9501 return DW_FORM_ref;
9502 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9503 return DW_FORM_data;
9504 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9505 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9506 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
9507 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9508 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9509 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9510 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
9511 case dw_val_class_str:
9512 return AT_string_form (a);
9513 case dw_val_class_file:
9514 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
9516 case 1:
9517 return DW_FORM_data1;
9518 case 2:
9519 return DW_FORM_data2;
9520 case 4:
9521 return DW_FORM_data4;
9522 default:
9523 gcc_unreachable ();
9526 case dw_val_class_data8:
9527 return DW_FORM_data8;
9529 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9530 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9532 case 1:
9533 return DW_FORM_data1;
9534 case 2:
9535 return DW_FORM_data2;
9536 case 4:
9537 return DW_FORM_data4;
9538 case 8:
9539 return DW_FORM_data8;
9540 default:
9541 gcc_unreachable ();
9544 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9545 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
9546 ? DW_FORM_udata
9547 : DW_FORM_sdata);
9548 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9549 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
9551 case 1:
9552 return DW_FORM_block1;
9553 case 2:
9554 return DW_FORM_block2;
9555 case 4:
9556 return DW_FORM_block4;
9557 default:
9558 gcc_unreachable ();
9561 default:
9562 gcc_unreachable ();
9566 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
9568 static void
9569 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9571 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
9573 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
9576 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
9578 static void
9579 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
9581 unsigned ix;
9582 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
9584 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
9585 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
9586 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
9588 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
9589 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
9590 else
9591 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
9593 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
9595 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
9596 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
9597 output_value_format (a_attr);
9598 if (value_format (a_attr) == DW_FORM_implicit_const)
9600 if (AT_class (a_attr) == dw_val_class_file_implicit)
9602 int f = maybe_emit_file (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9603 const char *filename = a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename;
9604 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (f, "(%s)", filename);
9606 else
9607 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int, NULL);
9611 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9612 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9616 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
9617 table. */
9619 static void
9620 output_abbrev_section (void)
9622 unsigned int abbrev_id;
9623 dw_die_ref abbrev;
9625 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
9626 if (abbrev_id != 0)
9627 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev);
9629 /* Terminate the table. */
9630 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9633 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
9634 expression. */
9636 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
9637 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
9638 const char *section)
9640 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
9642 retlist->begin = begin;
9643 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
9644 retlist->end = end;
9645 retlist->expr = expr;
9646 retlist->section = section;
9648 return retlist;
9651 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
9652 hasn't got one yet. */
9654 static inline void
9655 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
9657 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
9658 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
9661 /* Output the location list given to us. */
9663 static void
9664 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
9666 if (list_head->emitted)
9667 return;
9668 list_head->emitted = true;
9670 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
9672 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
9673 const char *last_section = NULL;
9674 const char *base_label = NULL;
9676 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
9677 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
9679 unsigned long size;
9680 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
9681 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
9682 continue;
9683 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
9684 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
9685 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
9686 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
9687 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
9688 if (dwarf_version < 5 && size > 0xffff)
9689 continue;
9690 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9692 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9694 /* For -gsplit-dwarf, emit DW_LLE_starx_length, which has
9695 uleb128 index into .debug_addr and uleb128 length. */
9696 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_startx_length,
9697 "DW_LLE_startx_length (%s)",
9698 list_head->ll_symbol);
9699 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9700 "Location list range start index "
9701 "(%s)", curr->begin);
9702 /* FIXME: This will ICE ifndef HAVE_AS_LEB128.
9703 For that case we probably need to emit DW_LLE_startx_endx,
9704 but we'd need 2 .debug_addr entries rather than just one. */
9705 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9706 "Location list length (%s)",
9707 list_head->ll_symbol);
9709 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections && HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9711 /* If all code is in .text section, the base address is
9712 already provided by the CU attributes. Use
9713 DW_LLE_offset_pair where both addresses are uleb128 encoded
9714 offsets against that base. */
9715 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9716 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9717 list_head->ll_symbol);
9718 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, curr->section,
9719 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9720 list_head->ll_symbol);
9721 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->section,
9722 "Location list end address (%s)",
9723 list_head->ll_symbol);
9725 else if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
9727 /* Otherwise, find out how many consecutive entries could share
9728 the same base entry. If just one, emit DW_LLE_start_length,
9729 otherwise emit DW_LLE_base_address for the base address
9730 followed by a series of DW_LLE_offset_pair. */
9731 if (last_section == NULL || curr->section != last_section)
9733 dw_loc_list_ref curr2;
9734 for (curr2 = curr->dw_loc_next; curr2 != NULL;
9735 curr2 = curr2->dw_loc_next)
9737 if (strcmp (curr2->begin, curr2->end) == 0
9738 && !curr2->force)
9739 continue;
9740 break;
9742 if (curr2 == NULL || curr->section != curr2->section)
9743 last_section = NULL;
9744 else
9746 last_section = curr->section;
9747 base_label = curr->begin;
9748 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_base_address,
9749 "DW_LLE_base_address (%s)",
9750 list_head->ll_symbol);
9751 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, base_label,
9752 "Base address (%s)",
9753 list_head->ll_symbol);
9756 /* Only one entry with the same base address. Use
9757 DW_LLE_start_length with absolute address and uleb128
9758 length. */
9759 if (last_section == NULL)
9761 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_length,
9762 "DW_LLE_start_length (%s)",
9763 list_head->ll_symbol);
9764 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9765 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9766 list_head->ll_symbol);
9767 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
9768 "Location list length "
9769 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9771 /* Otherwise emit DW_LLE_offset_pair, relative to above emitted
9772 DW_LLE_base_address. */
9773 else
9775 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
9776 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
9777 list_head->ll_symbol);
9778 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, base_label,
9779 "Location list begin address "
9780 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9781 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, base_label,
9782 "Location list end address "
9783 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9786 /* The assembler does not support .uleb128 directive. Emit
9787 DW_LLE_start_end with a pair of absolute addresses. */
9788 else
9790 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_end,
9791 "DW_LLE_start_end (%s)",
9792 list_head->ll_symbol);
9793 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9794 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9795 list_head->ll_symbol);
9796 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9797 "Location list end address (%s)",
9798 list_head->ll_symbol);
9801 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9803 /* For -gsplit-dwarf -gdwarf-{2,3,4} emit index into .debug_addr
9804 and 4 byte length. */
9805 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
9806 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
9807 list_head->ll_symbol);
9808 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9809 "Location list range start index (%s)",
9810 curr->begin);
9811 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
9812 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
9813 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
9814 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
9815 "Location list range length (%s)",
9816 list_head->ll_symbol);
9818 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9820 /* Pair of relative addresses against start of text section. */
9821 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
9822 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9823 list_head->ll_symbol);
9824 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
9825 "Location list end address (%s)",
9826 list_head->ll_symbol);
9828 else
9830 /* Pair of absolute addresses. */
9831 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9832 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9833 list_head->ll_symbol);
9834 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9835 "Location list end address (%s)",
9836 list_head->ll_symbol);
9839 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9840 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9841 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Location expression size");
9842 else
9844 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
9845 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "Location expression size");
9848 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
9851 /* And finally list termination. */
9852 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9853 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_end_of_list,
9854 "DW_LLE_end_of_list (%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
9855 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9856 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
9857 "Location list terminator (%s)",
9858 list_head->ll_symbol);
9859 else
9861 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9862 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
9863 list_head->ll_symbol);
9864 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9865 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
9866 list_head->ll_symbol);
9870 /* Output a range_list offset into the .debug_ranges or .debug_rnglists
9871 section. Emit a relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise,
9872 emit an indirect reference. */
9874 static void
9875 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9877 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9879 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9881 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9883 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9884 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
9885 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9887 else
9889 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
9890 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
9891 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9892 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
9893 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9894 *p = '\0';
9897 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9899 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9900 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9901 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r->idx, "%s", name);
9903 else
9904 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9905 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9906 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
9909 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
9911 static void
9912 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9914 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
9916 gcc_assert (sym);
9917 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9918 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
9919 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9920 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9922 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9923 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash, "%s (%s)",
9924 dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr),
9925 sym);
9927 else
9928 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
9929 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9932 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
9934 static void
9935 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
9937 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9939 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9941 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
9942 return;
9944 switch (AT_class (a))
9946 case dw_val_class_addr:
9947 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
9948 break;
9949 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9950 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9951 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
9952 break;
9953 default:
9954 gcc_unreachable ();
9958 /* Output a type signature. */
9960 static inline void
9961 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
9963 int i;
9965 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9966 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9969 /* Output a discriminant value. */
9971 static inline void
9972 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
9974 if (discr_value->pos)
9975 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
9976 else
9977 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
9980 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
9981 the definitions of each child DIE. */
9983 static void
9984 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
9986 dw_attr_node *a;
9987 dw_die_ref c;
9988 unsigned long size;
9989 unsigned ix;
9991 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
9992 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
9993 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
9995 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9997 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9999 switch (AT_class (a))
10001 case dw_val_class_addr:
10002 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10003 break;
10005 case dw_val_class_offset:
10006 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10007 "%s", name);
10008 break;
10010 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10011 output_range_list_offset (a);
10012 break;
10014 case dw_val_class_loc:
10015 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10017 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10018 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10019 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10020 else
10021 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10023 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
10024 break;
10026 case dw_val_class_const:
10027 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10028 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10029 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10030 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10031 break;
10033 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10035 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10036 if (dwarf_version == 3
10037 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
10038 && csize >= 4)
10039 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10040 else
10041 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10043 break;
10045 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
10046 if (flag_debug_asm)
10047 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10048 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ")\n",
10049 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_int (a));
10050 break;
10052 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
10053 if (flag_debug_asm)
10054 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10055 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX ")\n",
10056 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_unsigned (a));
10057 break;
10059 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10061 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10063 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10064 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10065 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
10066 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10067 NULL);
10069 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10071 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10072 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10074 else
10076 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10077 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10080 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10081 first, "%s", name);
10082 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10083 second, NULL);
10085 break;
10087 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
10089 int i;
10090 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
10091 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10092 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10093 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
10094 * l, NULL);
10096 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10097 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10099 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10100 "%s", name);
10101 name = "";
10103 else
10104 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
10106 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10107 "%s", name);
10108 name = "";
10111 break;
10113 case dw_val_class_vec:
10115 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10116 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10117 unsigned int i;
10118 unsigned char *p;
10120 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10121 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10122 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10124 elt_size /= 2;
10125 len *= 2;
10127 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10128 i < len;
10129 i++, p += elt_size)
10130 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10131 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10132 break;
10135 case dw_val_class_flag:
10136 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10138 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10139 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10140 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10141 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10142 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10143 the same abbrev entry. */
10144 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10145 if (flag_debug_asm)
10146 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10147 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10148 break;
10150 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10151 break;
10153 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10154 output_loc_list_offset (a);
10155 break;
10157 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10158 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10160 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
10162 comdat_type_node *type_node
10163 = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10165 gcc_assert (type_node);
10166 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10168 else
10170 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10171 int size;
10173 gcc_assert (sym);
10174 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10175 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10176 offset. */
10177 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10178 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10179 else
10180 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10181 /* ??? We cannot unconditionally output die_offset if
10182 non-zero - others might create references to those
10183 DIEs via symbols.
10184 And we do not clear its DIE offset after outputting it
10185 (and the label refers to the actual DIEs, not the
10186 DWARF CU unit header which is when using label + offset
10187 would be the correct thing to do).
10188 ??? This is the reason for the with_offset flag. */
10189 if (AT_ref (a)->with_offset)
10190 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10191 debug_info_section, "%s", name);
10192 else
10193 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10194 name);
10197 else
10199 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10200 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10201 "%s", name);
10203 break;
10205 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10207 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10209 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10210 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10211 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10212 "%s", name);
10214 break;
10216 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10217 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
10218 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10219 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10220 "%s", name);
10221 #else
10222 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10223 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10224 "%s", name);
10225 #endif
10226 break;
10228 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10229 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10230 break;
10232 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10233 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10234 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10235 break;
10237 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10238 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10239 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10240 break;
10242 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
10243 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10244 debug_loc_section, "%s", name);
10245 break;
10247 case dw_val_class_str:
10248 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
10249 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10250 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10251 debug_str_section,
10252 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10253 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
10254 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10255 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10256 debug_line_str_section,
10257 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10258 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10259 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
10260 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10261 else
10262 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10263 break;
10265 case dw_val_class_file:
10267 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10269 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10270 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10271 break;
10274 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
10275 if (flag_debug_asm)
10276 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s (%d, %s)\n",
10277 ASM_COMMENT_START, name,
10278 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file),
10279 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10280 break;
10282 case dw_val_class_data8:
10284 int i;
10286 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10287 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10288 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10289 break;
10292 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10293 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10294 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
10295 break;
10297 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
10298 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
10299 break;
10301 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
10303 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
10304 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
10306 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
10307 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
10308 "%s: block size", name);
10310 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
10312 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
10313 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
10314 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10315 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
10316 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
10317 else
10318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
10319 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
10321 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
10322 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10323 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
10325 break;
10328 default:
10329 gcc_unreachable ();
10333 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10335 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10336 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10337 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
10338 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10341 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10342 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10344 static void
10345 output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type ut)
10347 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10349 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10350 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10351 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10352 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10353 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10354 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10357 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10358 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10360 const char *name;
10361 switch (ut)
10363 case DW_UT_compile: name = "DW_UT_compile"; break;
10364 case DW_UT_type: name = "DW_UT_type"; break;
10365 case DW_UT_split_compile: name = "DW_UT_split_compile"; break;
10366 case DW_UT_split_type: name = "DW_UT_split_type"; break;
10367 default: gcc_unreachable ();
10369 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ut, "%s", name);
10370 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10372 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10373 debug_abbrev_section,
10374 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10375 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10376 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10379 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10381 static void
10382 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty,
10383 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10385 const char *secname, *oldsym;
10386 char *tmp;
10388 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
10389 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
10390 return;
10392 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
10393 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
10394 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
10395 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
10396 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10397 mark_dies (die);
10399 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
10401 /* For now, optimize only the main CU, in order to optimize the rest
10402 we'd need to see all of them earlier. Leave the rest for post-linking
10403 tools like DWZ. */
10404 if (die == comp_unit_die ())
10405 abbrev_opt_start = vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table);
10407 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
10409 optimize_abbrev_table ();
10411 delete extern_map;
10413 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10414 next_die_offset = (dwo_id
10415 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10416 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
10417 calc_die_sizes (die);
10419 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10420 if (oldsym && die->comdat_type_p)
10422 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
10424 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
10425 secname = tmp;
10426 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
10427 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10429 else
10431 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
10432 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
10433 info_section_emitted = true;
10436 /* For LTO cross unit DIE refs we want a symbol on the start of the
10437 debuginfo section, not on the CU DIE. */
10438 if ((flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload) && oldsym)
10440 /* ??? No way to get visibility assembled without a decl. */
10441 tree decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, VAR_DECL,
10442 get_identifier (oldsym), char_type_node);
10443 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = true;
10444 TREE_STATIC (decl) = true;
10445 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = true;
10446 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
10447 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = true;
10448 targetm.asm_out.assemble_visibility (decl, VISIBILITY_HIDDEN);
10449 #ifdef ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
10450 /* We prefer a .weak because that handles duplicates from duplicate
10451 archive members in a graceful way. */
10452 ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10453 #else
10454 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10455 #endif
10456 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
10459 /* Output debugging information. */
10460 output_compilation_unit_header (dwo_id
10461 ? DW_UT_split_compile : DW_UT_compile);
10462 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10464 if (dwo_id != NULL)
10465 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10466 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10468 output_die (die);
10470 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
10471 output_pubnames. */
10472 if (oldsym)
10474 unmark_dies (die);
10475 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
10479 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
10480 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
10481 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
10483 static inline bool
10484 want_pubnames (void)
10486 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10487 return false;
10488 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
10489 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
10490 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
10493 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
10495 static void
10496 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
10498 if (want_pubnames ())
10499 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
10502 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
10504 static inline void
10505 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
10506 const char *str)
10508 dw_attr_node attr;
10509 struct indirect_string_node *node;
10511 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
10512 skeleton_debug_str_hash
10513 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
10515 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
10516 find_string_form (node);
10517 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
10518 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
10520 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
10521 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
10522 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
10523 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
10524 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
10527 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
10528 debug_types. */
10530 static void
10531 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
10533 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
10534 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
10536 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_dwo_name), dwo_file_name);
10537 if (comp_dir != NULL)
10538 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
10539 add_AT_pubnames (die);
10540 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
10543 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
10545 static void
10546 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit,
10547 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
10549 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
10550 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
10551 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
10553 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
10554 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
10556 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
10557 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
10558 header. */
10559 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10560 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10561 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit "
10562 "DWARF extension");
10564 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10565 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
10566 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
10567 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
10568 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10569 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10570 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10572 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_UT_skeleton, "DW_UT_skeleton");
10573 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10575 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
10576 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section,
10577 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10578 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10579 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10580 else
10581 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10582 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
10584 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
10585 output_die (comp_unit);
10587 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
10588 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
10589 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
10591 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
10593 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
10596 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
10598 static void
10599 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
10601 const char *secname;
10602 char *tmp;
10603 int i;
10604 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10605 tree comdat_key;
10606 #endif
10608 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10609 mark_dies (node->root_die);
10611 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
10613 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
10615 delete extern_map;
10616 extern_map = NULL;
10618 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10619 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10620 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
10622 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10623 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10625 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10626 secname = ".debug_info";
10627 else
10628 secname = ".debug_info.dwo";
10630 else if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10631 secname = ".debug_types";
10632 else
10633 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
10635 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10636 sprintf (tmp, dwarf_version >= 5 ? "wi." : "wt.");
10637 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10638 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10639 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
10640 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
10641 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
10642 comdat_key);
10643 #else
10644 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10645 sprintf (tmp, (dwarf_version >= 5
10646 ? ".gnu.linkonce.wi." : ".gnu.linkonce.wt."));
10647 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10648 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10649 secname = tmp;
10650 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10651 #endif
10653 /* Output debugging information. */
10654 output_compilation_unit_header (dwarf_split_debug_info
10655 ? DW_UT_split_type : DW_UT_type);
10656 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
10657 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
10658 "Offset to Type DIE");
10659 output_die (node->root_die);
10661 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
10664 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
10666 static const char *
10667 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
10669 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
10670 return NULL;
10671 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
10674 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
10676 static void
10677 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
10679 pubname_entry e;
10681 e.die = die;
10682 e.name = xstrdup (str);
10683 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10686 static void
10687 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10689 if (!want_pubnames ())
10690 return;
10692 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
10693 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
10694 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
10695 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
10696 faster than searching the index. */
10697 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
10698 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10700 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10702 if (name)
10703 add_pubname_string (name, die);
10707 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
10709 static void
10710 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
10712 pubname_entry e;
10714 gcc_assert (scope_name);
10715 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
10716 e.die = die;
10717 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
10720 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
10722 static void
10723 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10725 pubname_entry e;
10727 if (!want_pubnames ())
10728 return;
10730 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10731 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
10732 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
10734 tree scope = NULL;
10735 const char *scope_name = "";
10736 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
10737 const char *name;
10739 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
10740 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
10742 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
10743 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
10744 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
10745 else
10746 scope_name = "";
10749 if (TYPE_P (decl))
10750 name = type_tag (decl);
10751 else
10752 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
10754 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
10755 it to the table. */
10756 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
10758 e.die = die;
10759 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
10760 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
10763 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
10764 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
10765 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
10766 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
10767 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
10768 enums don't have names. */
10769 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
10771 dw_die_ref c;
10773 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
10778 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
10780 static void
10781 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
10783 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
10784 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
10786 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
10788 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
10790 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
10791 byte. */
10792 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
10793 switch (die->die_tag)
10795 case DW_TAG_typedef:
10796 case DW_TAG_base_type:
10797 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
10798 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10799 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10800 break;
10801 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
10802 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10803 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10804 if (!is_cxx ())
10805 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10806 break;
10807 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
10808 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10809 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
10810 if (!is_ada ())
10811 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10812 break;
10813 case DW_TAG_constant:
10814 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10815 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10816 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10817 break;
10818 case DW_TAG_variable:
10819 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
10820 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
10821 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
10822 break;
10823 case DW_TAG_namespace:
10824 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
10825 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10826 break;
10827 case DW_TAG_class_type:
10828 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
10829 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
10830 case DW_TAG_union_type:
10831 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
10832 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
10833 if (!is_cxx ())
10834 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
10835 break;
10836 default:
10837 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
10838 break;
10840 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
10841 "GDB-index flags");
10844 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
10848 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
10849 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
10851 static void
10852 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
10854 unsigned i;
10855 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
10856 pubname_entry *pub;
10858 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10860 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10861 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10862 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10863 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10864 "Pub Info Length");
10867 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
10868 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10870 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10871 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10872 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10873 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10874 else
10875 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10876 debug_info_section,
10877 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10878 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
10879 "Compilation Unit Length");
10881 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
10883 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
10885 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
10887 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10888 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
10889 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
10891 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
10892 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
10893 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
10894 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
10895 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
10897 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
10899 if (type_node != NULL)
10900 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
10901 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
10902 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
10905 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
10909 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10912 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
10914 static void
10915 output_pubtables (void)
10917 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
10918 return;
10920 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
10921 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
10922 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
10923 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
10924 simply won't look for the section. */
10925 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
10926 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
10930 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10931 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10932 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10934 static void
10935 output_aranges (void)
10937 unsigned i;
10938 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10940 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10942 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10943 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10944 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10945 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10946 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10949 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
10950 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10951 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10952 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10953 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10954 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10955 else
10956 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10957 debug_info_section,
10958 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10959 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10960 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10962 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10963 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10965 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10966 pointer size. */
10967 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10968 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10969 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10970 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10973 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10974 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10975 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10976 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10977 confused with the terminator. */
10978 if (text_section_used)
10980 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10981 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10982 text_section_label, "Length");
10984 if (cold_text_section_used)
10986 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10987 "Address");
10988 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10989 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10992 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
10994 unsigned fde_idx;
10995 dw_fde_ref fde;
10997 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
10999 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
11000 continue;
11001 if (!fde->in_std_section)
11003 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
11004 "Address");
11005 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
11006 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
11008 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11010 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
11011 "Address");
11012 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
11013 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
11018 /* Output the terminator words. */
11019 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11020 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11023 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return its index into
11024 ranges_table vector. */
11026 static unsigned int
11027 add_ranges_num (int num, bool maybe_new_sec)
11029 dw_ranges r = { NULL, num, 0, maybe_new_sec };
11030 vec_safe_push (ranges_table, r);
11031 return vec_safe_length (ranges_table) - 1;
11034 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11035 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. MAYBE_NEW_SEC is true if
11036 this entry might be in a different section from previous range. */
11038 static unsigned int
11039 add_ranges (const_tree block, bool maybe_new_sec)
11041 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0, maybe_new_sec);
11044 /* Note that (*rnglist_table)[offset] is either a head of a rnglist
11045 chain, or middle entry of a chain that will be directly referred to. */
11047 static void
11048 note_rnglist_head (unsigned int offset)
11050 if (dwarf_version < 5 || (*ranges_table)[offset].label)
11051 return;
11052 (*ranges_table)[offset].label = gen_internal_sym ("LLRL");
11055 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
11056 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
11057 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
11058 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
11060 static void
11061 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11062 bool *added, bool force_direct)
11064 unsigned int in_use = vec_safe_length (ranges_by_label);
11065 unsigned int offset;
11066 dw_ranges_by_label rbl = { begin, end };
11067 vec_safe_push (ranges_by_label, rbl);
11068 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1, true);
11069 if (!*added)
11071 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
11072 *added = true;
11073 note_rnglist_head (offset);
11077 /* Emit .debug_ranges section. */
11079 static void
11080 output_ranges (void)
11082 unsigned i;
11083 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11084 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11085 dw_ranges *r;
11087 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11088 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11089 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11091 int block_num = r->num;
11093 if (block_num > 0)
11095 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11096 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11098 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11099 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11101 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11102 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11103 base of the text section. */
11104 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11106 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11107 text_section_label,
11108 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11109 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11110 text_section_label, NULL);
11113 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11114 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11115 about whether the target supports cross-section
11116 arithmetic. */
11117 else
11119 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11120 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11121 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11124 fmt = NULL;
11127 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11128 else if (block_num < 0)
11130 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11132 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11134 gcc_unreachable ();
11135 #if 0
11136 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11137 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11138 the #if 0 above. */
11139 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11140 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11141 text_section_label,
11142 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11143 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11144 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11145 text_section_label, NULL);
11146 #endif
11148 else
11150 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11151 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11152 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11153 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11154 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11155 NULL);
11158 else
11160 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11161 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11162 fmt = start_fmt;
11167 /* Non-zero if .debug_line_str should be used for .debug_line section
11168 strings or strings that are likely shareable with those. */
11169 #define DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR \
11170 (!DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET \
11171 && (DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) != 0 \
11172 /* FIXME: there is no .debug_line_str.dwo section, \
11173 for -gsplit-dwarf we should use DW_FORM_strx instead. */ \
11174 && !dwarf_split_debug_info)
11176 /* Assign .debug_rnglists indexes. */
11178 static void
11179 index_rnglists (void)
11181 unsigned i;
11182 dw_ranges *r;
11184 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11185 if (r->label)
11186 r->idx = rnglist_idx++;
11189 /* Emit .debug_rnglists section. */
11191 static void
11192 output_rnglists (void)
11194 unsigned i;
11195 dw_ranges *r;
11196 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11197 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11198 char basebuf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11200 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11201 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11202 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
11203 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 3);
11204 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11205 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11206 "Initial length escape value indicating "
11207 "64-bit DWARF extension");
11208 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11209 "Length of Range Lists");
11210 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11211 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11212 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11213 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11214 /* Emit the offset table only for -gsplit-dwarf. If we don't care
11215 about relocation sizes and primarily care about the size of .debug*
11216 sections in linked shared libraries and executables, then
11217 the offset table plus corresponding DW_FORM_rnglistx uleb128 indexes
11218 into it are usually larger than just DW_FORM_sec_offset offsets
11219 into the .debug_rnglists section. */
11220 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? rnglist_idx : 0,
11221 "Offset Entry Count");
11222 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11224 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_base_label);
11225 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11226 if (r->label)
11227 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
11228 ranges_base_label, NULL);
11231 const char *lab = "";
11232 unsigned int len = vec_safe_length (ranges_table);
11233 const char *base = NULL;
11234 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11236 int block_num = r->num;
11238 if (r->label)
11240 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, r->label);
11241 lab = r->label;
11243 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128 && (r->label || r->maybe_new_sec))
11244 base = NULL;
11245 if (block_num > 0)
11247 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11248 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11250 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11251 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11253 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11255 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11256 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11257 base of the text section. */
11258 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11260 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11261 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11262 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, text_section_label,
11263 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11264 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, text_section_label,
11265 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11266 continue;
11268 if (base == NULL)
11270 dw_ranges *r2 = NULL;
11271 if (i < len - 1)
11272 r2 = &(*ranges_table)[i + 1];
11273 if (r2
11274 && r2->num != 0
11275 && r2->label == NULL
11276 && !r2->maybe_new_sec)
11278 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_base_address,
11279 "DW_RLE_base_address (%s)", lab);
11280 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11281 "Base address (%s)", lab);
11282 strcpy (basebuf, blabel);
11283 base = basebuf;
11286 if (base)
11288 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11289 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11290 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, base,
11291 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11292 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, base,
11293 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11294 continue;
11296 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11297 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11298 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11299 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11300 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11301 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11303 else
11305 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11306 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11307 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11308 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11309 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11310 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11314 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11315 else if (block_num < 0)
11317 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11318 const char *blabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin;
11319 const char *elabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end;
11321 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11322 gcc_unreachable ();
11323 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11325 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11326 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11327 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11328 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11329 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11330 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11332 else
11334 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11335 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11336 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11337 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11338 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11339 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11342 else
11343 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_end_of_list,
11344 "DW_RLE_end_of_list (%s)", lab);
11346 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11349 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11350 struct file_info
11352 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11353 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11354 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11355 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11356 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11359 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11360 files. */
11361 struct dir_info
11363 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11364 int length; /* Path length. */
11365 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11366 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11367 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11370 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11371 the directories in the path. */
11373 static int
11374 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11376 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11377 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11378 const unsigned char *cp1;
11379 const unsigned char *cp2;
11381 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11382 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11383 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11384 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11385 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11386 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11387 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11389 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11390 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11392 while (1)
11394 ++cp1;
11395 ++cp2;
11396 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11397 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11398 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11399 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11400 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11402 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11403 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11404 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11408 struct file_name_acquire_data
11410 struct file_info *files;
11411 int used_files;
11412 int max_files;
11415 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11418 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
11420 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
11421 struct file_info *fi;
11422 const char *f;
11424 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11426 if (! d->emitted_number)
11427 return 1;
11429 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11431 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11433 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11434 f = d->filename;
11435 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11436 f += 2;
11438 /* Create a new array entry. */
11439 fi->path = f;
11440 fi->length = strlen (f);
11441 fi->file_idx = d;
11443 /* Search for the file name part. */
11444 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11445 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11447 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11449 if (g != NULL)
11451 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11452 f = g;
11455 #endif
11457 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11458 return 1;
11461 /* Helper function for output_file_names. Emit a FORM encoded
11462 string STR, with assembly comment start ENTRY_KIND and
11463 index IDX */
11465 static void
11466 output_line_string (enum dwarf_form form, const char *str,
11467 const char *entry_kind, unsigned int idx)
11469 switch (form)
11471 case DW_FORM_string:
11472 dw2_asm_output_nstring (str, -1, "%s: %#x", entry_kind, idx);
11473 break;
11474 case DW_FORM_line_strp:
11475 if (!debug_line_str_hash)
11476 debug_line_str_hash
11477 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
11479 struct indirect_string_node *node;
11480 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_line_str_hash);
11481 set_indirect_string (node);
11482 node->form = form;
11483 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
11484 debug_line_str_section, "%s: %#x: \"%s\"",
11485 entry_kind, 0, node->str);
11486 break;
11487 default:
11488 gcc_unreachable ();
11492 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11493 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11494 slowdowns with many input files. */
11496 static void
11497 output_file_names (void)
11499 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11500 int numfiles;
11501 struct file_info *files;
11502 struct dir_info *dirs;
11503 int *saved;
11504 int *savehere;
11505 int *backmap;
11506 int ndirs;
11507 int idx_offset;
11508 int i;
11510 if (!last_emitted_file)
11512 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11514 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Directory entry format count");
11515 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Directories count");
11516 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "File name entry format count");
11517 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "File names count");
11519 else
11521 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11522 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11524 return;
11527 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11529 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11530 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11531 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11533 fnad.files = files;
11534 fnad.used_files = 0;
11535 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11536 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
11537 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11539 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11541 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11542 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11543 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11544 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11545 dirs[0].count = 1;
11546 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11547 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11548 ndirs = 1;
11550 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11551 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11552 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11553 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11555 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11556 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11557 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11559 else
11561 int j;
11563 /* This is a new directory. */
11564 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11565 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11566 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11567 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11568 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11570 /* Search for a prefix. */
11571 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11572 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11573 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11574 && dirs[j].length > 1
11575 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11576 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11577 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11578 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11580 ++ndirs;
11583 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11584 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11585 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11586 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11587 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11588 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11589 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11590 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11592 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11593 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11595 int j;
11596 int total;
11598 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11599 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11600 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11601 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11603 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11605 savehere[j] = 0;
11606 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11608 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11609 dirs[j] path. */
11610 int k;
11612 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11613 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11614 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11616 if (k == (int) i)
11618 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11619 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11620 dirs[i]. */
11621 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11622 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11627 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11628 directory. */
11629 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11631 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11632 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11633 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11635 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11636 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11638 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11639 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11644 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11645 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11646 enum dwarf_form str_form = DW_FORM_string;
11647 enum dwarf_form idx_form = DW_FORM_udata;
11648 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11650 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
11651 if (comp_dir == NULL)
11652 comp_dir = "";
11653 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Directory entry format count");
11654 if (DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
11655 str_form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
11656 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11657 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11658 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11659 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ndirs + idx_offset, "Directories count");
11660 if (str_form == DW_FORM_string)
11662 dw2_asm_output_nstring (comp_dir, -1, "Directory Entry: %#x", 0);
11663 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11664 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11665 dirs[i].length
11666 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11667 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11669 else
11671 output_line_string (str_form, comp_dir, "Directory Entry", 0);
11672 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11674 const char *str
11675 = ggc_alloc_string (dirs[i].path,
11676 dirs[i].length
11677 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR);
11678 output_line_string (str_form, str, "Directory Entry",
11679 (unsigned) i + idx_offset);
11683 else
11685 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11686 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11687 dirs[i].length
11688 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11689 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
11691 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11694 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11695 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11696 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11697 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11698 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11699 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11701 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11703 const char *filename0 = get_AT_string (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_name);
11704 if (filename0 == NULL)
11705 filename0 = "";
11706 /* DW_LNCT_directory_index can use DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data1 and
11707 DW_FORM_data2. Choose one based on the number of directories
11708 and how much space would they occupy in each encoding.
11709 If we have at most 256 directories, all indexes fit into
11710 a single byte, so DW_FORM_data1 is most compact (if there
11711 are at most 128 directories, DW_FORM_udata would be as
11712 compact as that, but not shorter and slower to decode). */
11713 if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 256)
11714 idx_form = DW_FORM_data1;
11715 /* If there are more than 65536 directories, we have to use
11716 DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data2 can't refer to them.
11717 Otherwise, compute what space would occupy if all the indexes
11718 used DW_FORM_udata - sum - and compare that to how large would
11719 be DW_FORM_data2 encoding, and pick the more efficient one. */
11720 else if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 65536)
11722 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT sum = 1;
11723 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11725 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11726 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11727 sum += size_of_uleb128 (dir_idx);
11729 if (sum >= HOST_WIDE_INT_UC (2) * (numfiles + 1))
11730 idx_form = DW_FORM_data2;
11732 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11733 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 4, "File name entry format count");
11734 #else
11735 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "File name entry format count");
11736 #endif
11737 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
11738 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
11739 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
11740 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_directory_index,
11741 "DW_LNCT_directory_index");
11742 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (idx_form, "%s",
11743 get_DW_FORM_name (idx_form));
11744 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11745 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_timestamp, "DW_LNCT_timestamp");
11746 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11747 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_size, "DW_LNCT_size");
11748 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
11749 #endif
11750 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (numfiles + 1, "File names count");
11752 output_line_string (str_form, filename0, "File Entry", 0);
11754 /* Include directory index. */
11755 if (idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11756 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11757 0, NULL);
11758 else
11759 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11761 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11762 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11763 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11764 #endif
11767 /* Now write all the file names. */
11768 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11770 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11771 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11773 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11774 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11776 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11777 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11779 int ver;
11780 long long cdt;
11781 long siz;
11782 int maxfilelen = (strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11783 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11784 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1);
11785 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11787 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11788 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11789 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11791 output_line_string (str_form, filebuf, "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11793 /* Include directory index. */
11794 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11795 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11796 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11797 else
11798 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11800 /* Modification time. */
11801 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11802 &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11803 ? cdt : 0, NULL);
11805 /* File length in bytes. */
11806 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
11807 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11808 ? siz : 0, NULL);
11809 #else
11810 output_line_string (str_form,
11811 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length,
11812 "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
11814 /* Include directory index. */
11815 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
11816 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
11817 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11818 else
11819 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11821 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11822 continue;
11824 /* Modification time. */
11825 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11827 /* File length in bytes. */
11828 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11829 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
11832 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11833 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11837 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
11839 static void
11840 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
11842 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11843 unsigned int current_line = 1;
11844 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
11845 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
11846 size_t i;
11848 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
11850 switch (ent->opcode)
11852 case LI_set_address:
11853 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
11854 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
11855 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
11856 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
11857 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
11858 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
11859 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
11861 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
11862 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
11863 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
11864 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11865 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11866 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11867 break;
11869 case LI_set_line:
11870 if (ent->val == current_line)
11872 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
11873 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
11874 "copy line %u", current_line);
11876 else
11878 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
11879 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11881 current_line = ent->val;
11882 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11884 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
11885 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
11886 This takes 1 byte. */
11887 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11888 "line %u", current_line);
11890 else
11892 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
11893 depending on the value being encoded. */
11894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11895 "advance to line %u", current_line);
11896 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11897 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
11900 break;
11902 case LI_set_file:
11903 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
11904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11905 break;
11907 case LI_set_column:
11908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
11909 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
11910 break;
11912 case LI_negate_stmt:
11913 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
11914 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
11915 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
11916 break;
11918 case LI_set_prologue_end:
11919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
11920 "set prologue end");
11921 break;
11923 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
11924 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
11925 "set epilogue begin");
11926 break;
11928 case LI_set_discriminator:
11929 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
11930 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
11931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
11932 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
11933 break;
11937 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
11938 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
11939 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11940 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11941 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
11943 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
11944 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11945 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11948 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11949 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11951 static void
11952 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
11954 static unsigned int generation;
11955 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11956 char p1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], p2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11957 bool saw_one = false;
11958 int opc;
11960 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, generation);
11961 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, generation);
11962 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, generation);
11963 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, generation++);
11965 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11967 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11968 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11969 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11970 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11971 "Length of Source Line Info");
11974 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11976 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
11977 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11979 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11980 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11982 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
11983 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
11985 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
11986 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
11987 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
11988 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
11989 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
11990 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
11991 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
11992 and don't let the target override. */
11993 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
11995 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11996 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
11997 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
11998 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
11999 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12000 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12001 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12002 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12003 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12004 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12005 "Special Opcode Base");
12007 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12009 int n_op_args;
12010 switch (opc)
12012 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12013 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12014 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12015 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12016 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12017 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12018 n_op_args = 1;
12019 break;
12020 default:
12021 n_op_args = 0;
12022 break;
12025 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12026 opc, n_op_args);
12029 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12030 output_file_names ();
12031 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12032 if (prologue_only)
12034 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12035 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12036 return;
12039 if (separate_line_info)
12041 dw_line_info_table *table;
12042 size_t i;
12044 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
12045 if (table->in_use)
12047 output_one_line_info_table (table);
12048 saw_one = true;
12051 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12053 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12054 saw_one = true;
12057 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12058 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12059 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12060 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12061 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
12062 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12063 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12065 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12066 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12069 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE. */
12071 static inline bool
12072 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
12074 return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
12077 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12078 a DIE that describes the given type. REVERSE is true if the type is
12079 to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
12081 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12082 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12084 static dw_die_ref
12085 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
12087 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12088 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12089 bool fpt_used = false;
12090 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
12091 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
12093 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
12094 return 0;
12096 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12097 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12098 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12099 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12101 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12103 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12104 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12105 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12106 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12107 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12108 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12110 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12111 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12112 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12114 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12115 break;
12118 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12119 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
12121 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
12122 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
12124 fpt_used = true;
12125 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12126 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
12127 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
12128 break;
12131 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12133 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12134 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12135 else
12136 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12138 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12139 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12140 else
12141 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12143 if (!dwarf_strict
12144 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12145 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12146 break;
12148 case REAL_TYPE:
12149 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12151 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12152 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12153 else
12154 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12156 else
12157 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12158 break;
12160 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12161 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12162 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12163 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12164 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12165 else
12166 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12167 break;
12169 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12170 a user defined type for it. */
12171 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12172 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12173 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12174 else
12175 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12176 break;
12178 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12179 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12180 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12181 break;
12183 default:
12184 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12185 gcc_unreachable ();
12188 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12190 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12191 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12192 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12194 if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
12195 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
12196 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
12198 add_alignment_attribute (base_type_result, type);
12200 if (fpt_used)
12202 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
12204 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
12205 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
12206 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
12207 break;
12209 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
12210 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
12211 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
12212 break;
12214 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
12215 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
12216 yet. */
12217 if (!dwarf_strict)
12219 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
12220 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
12221 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
12223 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
12224 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
12225 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
12226 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
12228 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
12230 break;
12232 default:
12233 gcc_unreachable ();
12237 if (type_bias)
12238 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
12239 dw_scalar_form_constant
12240 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12241 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12242 NULL);
12244 add_pubtype (type, base_type_result);
12246 return base_type_result;
12249 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
12250 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
12252 static inline bool
12253 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
12255 if (is_cxx ())
12257 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12258 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
12259 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
12260 return true;
12262 return false;
12265 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12266 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12268 static inline int
12269 is_base_type (tree type)
12271 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12273 case ERROR_MARK:
12274 case VOID_TYPE:
12275 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12276 case REAL_TYPE:
12277 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12278 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12279 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12280 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
12281 return 1;
12283 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12284 case RECORD_TYPE:
12285 case UNION_TYPE:
12286 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12287 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12288 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12289 case METHOD_TYPE:
12290 case POINTER_TYPE:
12291 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12292 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12293 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12294 case LANG_TYPE:
12295 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12296 return 0;
12298 default:
12299 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
12300 return 0;
12301 gcc_unreachable ();
12304 return 0;
12307 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12308 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12309 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12310 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12311 ERROR_MARK node. */
12313 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12314 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12316 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12317 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12318 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12319 return 0;
12320 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
12321 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12322 else
12323 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12326 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
12328 static inline offset_int
12329 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12331 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12332 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12333 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12334 return 0;
12335 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12336 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12337 else
12338 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12341 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12342 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12344 static dw_die_ref
12345 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
12346 dw_die_ref context_die)
12348 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12349 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12351 if (context_die == NULL)
12352 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12354 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12356 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12358 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12359 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12360 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12363 add_alignment_attribute (subrange_die, type);
12365 if (low)
12366 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
12367 if (high)
12368 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
12369 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
12370 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
12371 dw_scalar_form_constant
12372 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12373 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12374 NULL);
12376 return subrange_die;
12379 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
12380 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
12381 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
12383 static int
12384 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
12386 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
12387 /* The C++ front-end correctly marks reference-typed
12388 variables as readonly, but from a language (and debug
12389 info) standpoint they are not const-qualified. */
12390 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != REFERENCE_TYPE
12391 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
12392 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
12393 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
12396 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
12397 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
12398 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
12400 static int
12401 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
12403 tree t;
12404 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
12406 type_quals &= qual_mask;
12407 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
12409 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
12410 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12412 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
12414 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
12415 && check_base_type (t, type))
12417 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
12419 if (rank > best_rank)
12421 best_rank = rank;
12422 best_qual = q;
12427 return best_qual;
12430 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
12431 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
12433 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
12434 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
12435 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
12436 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
12438 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
12439 = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
12441 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
12442 return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL. Set MASK to the
12443 qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE. */
12445 static dw_die_ref
12446 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
12448 unsigned int i;
12449 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12450 if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
12451 break;
12452 if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
12453 return NULL;
12454 if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
12455 return NULL;
12456 dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
12457 if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
12458 return NULL;
12459 *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12460 if (depth)
12462 dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
12463 if (ret)
12464 return ret;
12466 return type;
12469 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12470 entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
12471 given type. REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
12472 reverse storage order wrt the target order. */
12474 static dw_die_ref
12475 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
12476 dw_die_ref context_die)
12478 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12479 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12480 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12481 tree item_type = NULL;
12482 tree qualified_type;
12483 tree name, low, high;
12484 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
12485 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
12486 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
12487 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC);
12489 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12490 return NULL;
12492 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
12494 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
12496 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
12497 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
12500 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
12502 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
12503 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
12504 to handle it. */
12505 if (dwarf_version < 3)
12506 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
12508 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
12509 if (dwarf_version < 5)
12510 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
12512 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12513 this type. */
12514 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
12516 if (qualified_type == sizetype)
12518 /* Try not to expose the internal sizetype type's name. */
12519 if (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12520 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12522 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12524 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
12525 && (TYPE_PRECISION (t)
12526 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type))
12527 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
12528 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type)));
12529 qualified_type = t;
12531 else if (qualified_type == sizetype
12532 && TREE_CODE (sizetype) == TREE_CODE (size_type_node)
12533 && TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) == TYPE_PRECISION (size_type_node)
12534 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype) == TYPE_UNSIGNED (size_type_node))
12535 qualified_type = size_type_node;
12539 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12540 if (qualified_type)
12542 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12544 /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type. */
12545 if (mod_type_die
12546 && (!need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse)
12547 || !is_base_type (type)
12548 || get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity)))
12549 return mod_type_die;
12552 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12554 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12555 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12556 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12558 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12560 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12562 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
12564 /* Typedef variants that have an abstract origin don't get their own
12565 type DIE (see gen_typedef_die), so fall back on the ultimate
12566 abstract origin instead. */
12567 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
12568 return modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (origin), cv_quals, reverse,
12569 context_die);
12571 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12572 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12573 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12575 else
12577 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
12578 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
12579 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
12580 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12581 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
12582 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
12583 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
12584 reverse, context_die);
12585 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12589 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12591 if (cv_quals)
12593 int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
12594 unsigned i;
12595 dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
12597 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
12598 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
12599 qualifiers. */
12600 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
12601 cv_qual_mask);
12602 if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
12604 bool needed = false;
12605 /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
12606 is canonical. Thus, start from unqualified type if
12607 an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
12608 one is present there. */
12609 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12610 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12611 needed = true;
12612 else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
12614 sub_quals = 0;
12615 break;
12618 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
12619 if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
12621 /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
12622 tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
12623 as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
12624 only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
12625 in between them. Determine the range of such qualified
12626 DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
12627 last qualified DIE for it). */
12628 unsigned int count = 0;
12629 first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
12630 dwarf_qual_info_size);
12631 if (first == NULL)
12632 first = mod_type_die;
12633 gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
12634 for (count = 0, last = first;
12635 count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
12636 count++, last = last->die_sib)
12638 int quals = 0;
12639 if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
12640 break;
12641 if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
12642 != first)
12643 break;
12647 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
12648 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
12650 dw_die_ref d;
12651 if (first && first != last)
12653 for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
12655 int quals = 0;
12656 qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
12657 if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
12658 break;
12659 if (d == last)
12661 d = NULL;
12662 break;
12665 if (d)
12667 mod_type_die = d;
12668 continue;
12671 if (first)
12673 d = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
12674 d->die_tag = dwarf_qual_info[i].t;
12675 add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
12676 last = d;
12678 else
12679 d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
12680 if (mod_type_die)
12681 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
12682 mod_type_die = d;
12683 first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
12686 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12688 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
12689 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12691 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
12692 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
12693 else
12694 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
12696 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
12698 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12699 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12700 add_alignment_attribute (mod_type_die, type);
12701 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12703 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
12704 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
12706 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
12707 if (action >= 0)
12709 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
12710 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
12712 else
12714 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
12715 dw_loc_descr_ref d
12716 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12717 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
12721 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12722 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12723 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12725 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
12726 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12727 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12728 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
12729 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12731 else if (is_base_type (type))
12732 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
12733 else
12735 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12737 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12738 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12739 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12740 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12741 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12742 ..._TYPE node. */
12743 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
12744 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
12746 /* For function/method types, can't just use type_main_variant here,
12747 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
12748 but try to canonicalize. */
12749 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
12750 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
12751 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
12752 && check_base_type (t, main)
12753 && check_lang_type (t, type))
12754 return lookup_type_die (t);
12755 return lookup_type_die (type);
12757 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
12758 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
12759 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12760 else
12761 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12762 not the main variant. */
12763 return lookup_type_die (type);
12766 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12767 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12768 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12769 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12770 if the base type already has the same name. */
12771 if (name
12772 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12773 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12774 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
12775 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12776 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12777 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12779 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12780 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12781 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12782 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12783 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12784 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12786 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
12787 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
12789 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12790 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
12791 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
12794 if (qualified_type)
12795 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12797 if (item_type)
12798 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12799 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12800 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12801 types are possible in Ada. */
12802 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12803 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
12804 reverse,
12805 context_die);
12807 if (sub_die != NULL)
12808 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12810 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
12811 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
12812 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12814 return mod_type_die;
12817 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12818 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12819 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12821 static void
12822 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12824 tree parms, args;
12825 int parms_num, i;
12826 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12827 int non_default;
12829 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12830 return;
12832 if (TYPE_P (t))
12833 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12834 else if (DECL_P (t))
12835 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12837 gcc_assert (die);
12839 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12840 if (!parms)
12841 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12842 or function. End of story. */
12843 return;
12845 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12846 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12847 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
12848 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
12849 else
12850 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
12851 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12853 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12854 dw_die_ref parm_die;
12856 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12857 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12858 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12859 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12861 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12863 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12864 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12865 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12866 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12867 an argument pack. */
12868 if (arg_pack_elems)
12869 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12870 arg_pack_elems,
12871 die);
12872 else
12873 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12874 true /* emit name */, die);
12875 if (i >= non_default)
12876 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
12881 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12882 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12883 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12884 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12885 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12886 name of the PARM.
12887 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12888 as a child node. */
12890 static dw_die_ref
12891 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12892 bool emit_name_p,
12893 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12895 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12896 const char *name = NULL;
12898 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12899 return NULL;
12901 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12902 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12903 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12904 and arguments. */
12905 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12906 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12907 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12908 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12909 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12910 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12911 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12912 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12913 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12914 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12915 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12916 name of the template template argument. */
12917 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12918 parent_die, parm);
12919 else
12920 gcc_unreachable ();
12922 if (tmpl_die)
12924 tree tmpl_type;
12926 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12927 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12928 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12929 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12930 the die. */
12931 if (emit_name_p)
12933 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12934 gcc_assert (name);
12935 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12938 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12940 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12941 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12942 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12943 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12944 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12945 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12946 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
12947 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
12948 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
12949 false, parent_die);
12951 else
12953 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12954 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12955 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12957 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12958 to the name of the argument. */
12959 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12960 if (name)
12961 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12964 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12965 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
12966 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
12967 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
12968 of ARG.
12969 We must be careful here:
12970 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
12971 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
12972 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
12973 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
12974 emitted after cgraph computations.
12975 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
12976 after cgraph is ready. */
12977 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
12980 return tmpl_die;
12983 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
12984 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
12985 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
12987 static dw_die_ref
12988 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
12989 tree parm_pack_args,
12990 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12992 dw_die_ref die;
12993 int j;
12995 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
12997 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
12998 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
12999 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13000 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13001 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13002 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13003 die);
13004 return die;
13007 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13008 an enumerated type. */
13010 static inline int
13011 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13013 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13016 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13018 static unsigned int
13019 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13021 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13023 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13025 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13026 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13028 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13029 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13030 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13032 #endif
13034 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13035 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
13036 return regno;
13039 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13040 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13041 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13043 static void
13044 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13046 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13048 if (*list_head != NULL)
13050 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13051 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13054 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13055 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13059 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13060 zero if there is none. */
13062 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13063 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13065 rtx regs;
13067 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13068 return 0;
13070 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13071 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13072 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13073 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13074 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13075 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13076 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13078 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13080 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13082 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13083 initialized);
13084 if (result)
13085 add_loc_descr (&result,
13086 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13088 return result;
13091 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13093 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
13094 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13095 else
13097 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13098 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13099 return 0;
13100 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
13104 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13105 a given hard register number. */
13107 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13108 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13110 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13112 if (regno <= 31)
13113 reg_loc_descr
13114 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13115 else
13116 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13118 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13119 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13121 return reg_loc_descr;
13124 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13125 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13127 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13128 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13129 enum var_init_status initialized)
13131 int size, i;
13132 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13134 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13135 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13137 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
13138 int nregs;
13140 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13141 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13143 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13144 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13145 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13147 #endif
13149 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13150 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
13152 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13154 loc_result = NULL;
13155 while (nregs--)
13157 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13159 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13160 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13161 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13162 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13163 ++reg;
13165 return loc_result;
13168 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13170 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13172 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13173 loc_result = NULL;
13175 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13177 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13179 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13180 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13181 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13182 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13185 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13186 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13187 return loc_result;
13190 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13192 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
13193 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
13194 and DW_OP_shl. */
13196 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13197 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13199 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
13200 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13201 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13202 return ret;
13205 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
13207 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13208 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13210 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13212 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13213 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13214 if (i >= 0)
13216 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
13217 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13218 if (i <= 31)
13219 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13220 else if (i <= 0xff)
13221 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13222 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13223 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13224 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13225 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13226 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
13227 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13228 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13229 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
13230 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13231 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13232 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13233 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13234 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13236 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13237 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13238 <= 4)
13240 /* As i >= 2**31, the double cast above will yield a negative number.
13241 Since wrapping is defined in DWARF expressions we can output big
13242 positive integers as small negative ones, regardless of the size
13243 of host wide ints.
13245 Here, since the evaluator will handle 32-bit values and since i >=
13246 2**31, we know it's going to be interpreted as a negative literal:
13247 store it this way if we can do better than 5 bytes this way. */
13248 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13250 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13251 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13253 /* Past this point, i >= 0x100000000 and thus DW_OP_constu will take at
13254 least 6 bytes: see if we can do better before falling back to it. */
13255 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13256 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13257 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes. */
13258 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13259 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13260 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
13261 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13262 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
13263 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes. */
13264 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
13265 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13266 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13267 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
13268 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
13269 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
13270 else
13271 op = DW_OP_constu;
13273 else
13275 if (i >= -0x80)
13276 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13277 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13278 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13279 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13281 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
13283 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13284 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13285 return ret;
13287 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13289 else
13291 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
13292 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
13294 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13295 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13296 return ret;
13298 op = DW_OP_consts;
13302 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13305 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
13307 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13308 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13310 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13311 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
13312 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
13314 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
13315 if (i <= max_int)
13316 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13318 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
13319 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
13320 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
13322 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
13323 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
13324 wrapping, we know that:
13325 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13326 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
13327 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
13328 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
13329 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
13330 DW_OP_const4s. */
13331 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13332 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
13333 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
13335 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
13337 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
13338 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
13339 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
13340 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
13342 /* So we finally have:
13343 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
13344 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
13345 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
13348 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
13349 return new_loc_descr
13350 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13351 ? DW_OP_const4u
13352 : DW_OP_const8u,
13353 i, 0);
13356 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
13357 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
13358 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
13359 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
13361 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13362 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
13364 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
13365 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
13367 switch (kind)
13369 case LT_EXPR:
13370 op = DW_OP_lt;
13371 break;
13372 case LE_EXPR:
13373 op = DW_OP_le;
13374 break;
13375 case GT_EXPR:
13376 op = DW_OP_gt;
13377 break;
13378 case GE_EXPR:
13379 op = DW_OP_ge;
13380 break;
13381 default:
13382 gcc_unreachable ();
13385 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13386 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13388 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
13389 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
13390 three cases:
13392 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
13393 return: a OP(signed) b;
13395 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
13396 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
13397 are flipped.
13399 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
13400 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
13401 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13402 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
13403 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
13404 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
13405 zero. */
13406 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
13407 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
13408 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
13410 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
13411 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
13412 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13413 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
13415 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
13416 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
13417 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
13418 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
13419 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13420 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13421 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13423 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
13424 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
13425 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13426 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13427 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13429 return ret;
13432 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
13433 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
13435 static dw_loc_list_ref
13436 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
13437 enum tree_code kind)
13439 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
13440 return NULL;
13442 add_loc_list (&left, right);
13443 if (left == NULL)
13444 return NULL;
13446 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
13447 return left;
13450 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
13451 without actually allocating it. */
13453 static unsigned long
13454 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13456 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
13457 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
13458 + 1;
13461 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
13462 actually allocating it. */
13464 static unsigned long
13465 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13467 unsigned long s;
13469 if (i >= 0)
13471 int clz, ctz;
13472 if (i <= 31)
13473 return 1;
13474 else if (i <= 0xff)
13475 return 2;
13476 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13477 return 3;
13478 clz = clz_hwi (i);
13479 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13480 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13481 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13482 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13483 - clz - 5);
13484 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13485 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13486 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13487 - clz - 8);
13488 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13489 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13490 <= 4)
13491 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13492 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13493 return 5;
13494 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13495 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13496 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13497 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13498 - clz - 8);
13499 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13500 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13501 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13502 - clz - 16);
13503 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13504 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13505 && s > 6)
13506 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13507 - clz - 32);
13508 else
13509 return 1 + s;
13511 else
13513 if (i >= -0x80)
13514 return 2;
13515 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13516 return 3;
13517 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13519 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13521 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13522 if (s < 5)
13523 return s;
13525 return 5;
13527 else
13529 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13530 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
13532 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
13533 if (s < r)
13534 return s;
13536 return r;
13541 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13542 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13544 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13545 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13547 int litsize;
13548 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13550 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13551 return NULL;
13553 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
13554 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13555 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13556 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13557 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13558 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13559 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13561 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13562 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13563 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13564 return loc_result;
13567 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13568 size, 0);
13569 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13570 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13571 return loc_result;
13574 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13576 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13577 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
13578 enum var_init_status initialized)
13580 unsigned int regno;
13581 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13582 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
13584 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13585 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13586 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13587 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13588 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13590 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
13591 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
13592 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
13594 if (elim != reg)
13596 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
13598 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
13599 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
13601 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13602 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13603 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13604 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13605 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13606 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13608 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13609 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13610 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13611 access stack variables. */
13612 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13613 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13615 int base_reg
13616 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13617 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13618 : REGNO (elim));
13619 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13622 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
13623 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13624 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13628 regno = REGNO (reg);
13629 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13630 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13632 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13633 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13634 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13636 #endif
13637 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
13639 if (!optimize && fde
13640 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
13642 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13643 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13644 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13645 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13646 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13647 else in other part of the routine. */
13648 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13651 if (regno <= 31)
13652 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
13653 offset, 0);
13654 else
13655 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
13657 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13658 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13660 return result;
13663 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13665 static inline int
13666 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13668 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13669 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13670 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13671 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13674 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13675 failed. */
13677 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13678 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13680 tree base;
13681 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13683 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
13684 return NULL;
13686 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13687 if (base == NULL
13688 || !VAR_P (base)
13689 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13690 return NULL;
13692 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
13693 if (loc_result == NULL)
13694 return NULL;
13696 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
13697 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
13699 return loc_result;
13702 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13703 expression. */
13705 static void
13706 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13708 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13710 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13711 if (expr)
13712 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13713 if (rtl)
13715 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13716 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13718 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13722 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
13724 static bool
13725 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
13727 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
13729 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
13730 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13731 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
13732 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
13733 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
13734 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
13735 if (flag_checking
13736 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
13737 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
13738 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
13739 inform (current_function_decl
13740 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13741 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13742 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
13743 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
13744 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
13745 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
13746 XINT (rtl, 1));
13747 #else
13748 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13749 XINT (rtl, 1));
13750 #endif
13751 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13752 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13753 return false;
13756 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
13758 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13759 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
13760 return false;
13763 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
13764 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
13765 We should really identify / validate expressions
13766 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
13767 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
13768 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
13770 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == NOT)
13771 return false;
13772 return true;
13775 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13777 bool marked;
13778 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13779 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13780 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13781 if (!marked)
13783 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13784 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13785 return false;
13789 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13790 return false;
13792 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13793 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13794 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13795 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13796 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13797 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13799 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13801 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13803 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13804 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13805 return false;
13809 return true;
13812 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13813 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13814 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13816 static bool
13817 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13819 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13820 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
13822 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13824 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
13825 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
13826 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
13827 return false;
13828 return true;
13831 return true;
13834 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
13835 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
13837 static dw_die_ref
13838 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
13840 dw_die_ref type_die;
13841 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
13843 if (type == NULL)
13844 return NULL;
13845 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13847 case INTEGER_TYPE:
13848 case REAL_TYPE:
13849 break;
13850 default:
13851 return NULL;
13853 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13854 if (!type_die)
13855 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
13856 comp_unit_die ());
13857 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
13858 return NULL;
13859 return type_die;
13862 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
13863 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
13864 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
13865 possible. */
13867 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13868 convert_descriptor_to_mode (scalar_int_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
13870 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
13871 dw_die_ref type_die;
13872 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13874 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13876 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0));
13877 return op;
13879 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
13880 if (type_die == NULL)
13881 return NULL;
13882 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13883 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13884 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13885 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13886 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
13887 return op;
13890 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
13892 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13893 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
13894 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13896 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
13897 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13898 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13899 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13901 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13902 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13904 return ret;
13907 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
13908 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
13909 and in which OP_MODE is bigger than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
13911 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13912 scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (enum dwarf_location_atom op,
13913 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
13914 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13916 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
13917 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13919 if (type_die == NULL)
13920 return NULL;
13921 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13922 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13923 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13924 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13925 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13926 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
13927 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13928 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13929 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13930 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
13931 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13934 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
13935 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
13936 and in which OP_MODE is smaller than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
13938 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13939 scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
13940 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
13941 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13943 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
13944 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
13945 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
13946 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
13948 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13949 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13951 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13953 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
13954 whether they are zero extended or not. */
13955 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13956 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13957 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13958 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13959 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13960 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13961 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13962 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13963 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13964 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
13965 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13967 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
13968 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
13969 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
13970 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
13972 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
13973 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
13974 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13975 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13976 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
13977 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
13978 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
13979 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13980 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13982 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
13983 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13984 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13985 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
13986 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13989 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13990 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13991 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13992 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13993 else
13995 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13996 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13998 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14001 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14003 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14004 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14005 machine_mode mem_mode)
14007 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14008 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14010 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14011 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14012 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14013 return NULL;
14015 scalar_int_mode int_op_mode;
14016 if (dwarf_strict
14017 && dwarf_version < 5
14018 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode)
14019 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14020 return NULL;
14022 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14023 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14024 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14025 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14027 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14028 return NULL;
14030 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode))
14032 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14033 return scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (op, rtl, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14035 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14036 return scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (op, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14038 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14041 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14043 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14044 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14045 machine_mode mem_mode)
14047 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14049 machine_mode test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14050 if (test_op_mode == VOIDmode)
14051 test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14053 scalar_int_mode op_mode;
14054 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (test_op_mode, &op_mode))
14055 return NULL;
14057 if (dwarf_strict
14058 && dwarf_version < 5
14059 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14060 return NULL;
14062 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14063 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14064 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14065 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14067 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14068 return NULL;
14070 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14072 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14073 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14074 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14076 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14078 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14079 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14080 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14081 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14082 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14084 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14085 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14087 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14088 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14089 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14090 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14091 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14093 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14094 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14097 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14099 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14100 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14101 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14102 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14103 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14104 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14105 else
14106 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14107 bias, 0));
14109 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14112 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
14114 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14115 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14116 machine_mode mem_mode)
14118 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14119 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14120 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14122 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
14123 if (dwarf_strict
14124 && dwarf_version < 5
14125 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14126 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14127 return NULL;
14129 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14130 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14131 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14132 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14134 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14135 return NULL;
14137 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14138 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14139 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14140 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14142 /* Checked by the caller. */
14143 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
14144 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14146 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (int_mode);
14147 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14148 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14149 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14150 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14152 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14154 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14155 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14156 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14157 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14160 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14161 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14163 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14164 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14165 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14166 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14167 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14169 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14170 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14172 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 0);
14173 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14174 if (type_die == NULL)
14175 return NULL;
14176 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14177 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14178 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14179 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14180 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14181 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14182 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14183 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14184 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14185 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14188 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14189 op = DW_OP_lt;
14190 else
14191 op = DW_OP_gt;
14192 ret = op0;
14193 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14194 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14195 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14196 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14197 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14198 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14199 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14200 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14201 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14202 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
14203 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14204 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14205 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, ret);
14206 return ret;
14209 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
14210 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
14211 convert back to unsigned. */
14213 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14214 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
14215 scalar_int_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
14217 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
14219 if (type_die == NULL)
14220 return NULL;
14221 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14222 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14223 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14224 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14225 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14226 return NULL;
14227 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14228 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14229 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14230 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14231 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14232 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14233 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14234 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14235 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14236 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14237 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
14238 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14239 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
14242 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
14243 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14244 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
14245 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
14246 for the mode):
14247 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14248 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14249 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
14250 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14251 L3: DW_OP_drop
14252 L4: DW_OP_nop
14254 CTZ is similar:
14255 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14256 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14257 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14258 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14259 L3: DW_OP_drop
14260 L4: DW_OP_nop
14262 FFS is similar:
14263 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
14264 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
14265 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14266 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14267 L3: DW_OP_drop
14268 L4: DW_OP_nop */
14270 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14271 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14272 machine_mode mem_mode)
14274 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14275 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
14276 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14277 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14278 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
14279 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
14280 rtx msb;
14282 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14283 return NULL;
14285 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14286 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14287 if (op0 == NULL)
14288 return NULL;
14289 ret = op0;
14290 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
14292 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14293 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14295 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
14296 valv = 0;
14297 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14298 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14299 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14300 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14301 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14302 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14303 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
14304 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14305 if (tmp == NULL)
14306 return NULL;
14307 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14308 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14309 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
14310 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
14311 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
14312 mode, mem_mode,
14313 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14314 if (l1label == NULL)
14315 return NULL;
14316 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14317 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14318 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14319 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14320 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
14321 msb = const1_rtx;
14322 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14323 msb = GEN_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
14324 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
14325 else
14326 msb = immed_wide_int_const
14327 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
14328 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
14329 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
14330 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14331 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14332 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
14333 else
14334 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
14335 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14336 if (tmp == NULL)
14337 return NULL;
14338 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14339 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14340 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14341 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
14342 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14343 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14344 if (tmp == NULL)
14345 return NULL;
14346 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14347 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
14348 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14349 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14350 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
14351 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14352 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14353 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14354 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14355 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
14356 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14357 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
14358 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14359 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14360 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14361 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14362 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14363 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
14364 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14365 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
14366 return ret;
14369 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14370 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
14371 const0 DW_OP_swap
14372 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14373 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14374 L2: DW_OP_drop
14376 PARITY is similar:
14377 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14378 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14379 L2: DW_OP_drop */
14381 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14382 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14383 machine_mode mem_mode)
14385 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14386 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14387 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14389 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14390 return NULL;
14392 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14393 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14394 if (op0 == NULL)
14395 return NULL;
14396 ret = op0;
14397 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14398 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14399 if (tmp == NULL)
14400 return NULL;
14401 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14402 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14403 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14404 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14405 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14406 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14407 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14408 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14409 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14410 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14411 if (tmp == NULL)
14412 return NULL;
14413 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14414 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14415 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
14416 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14417 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14418 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14419 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14420 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14421 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14422 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14423 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14424 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14425 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14426 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14427 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14428 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14429 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14430 return ret;
14433 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
14434 constS const0
14435 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
14436 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
14437 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
14438 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
14439 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
14441 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14442 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14443 machine_mode mem_mode)
14445 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14446 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14447 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14449 if (BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
14450 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
14451 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
14452 return NULL;
14454 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14455 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14456 if (op0 == NULL)
14457 return NULL;
14459 ret = op0;
14460 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14461 mode, mem_mode,
14462 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14463 if (tmp == NULL)
14464 return NULL;
14465 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14466 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14467 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14468 if (tmp == NULL)
14469 return NULL;
14470 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14471 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
14472 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14473 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14474 mode, mem_mode,
14475 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14476 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14477 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
14478 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14479 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14480 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
14481 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14482 if (tmp == NULL)
14483 return NULL;
14484 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14485 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14486 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
14487 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14488 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14489 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14490 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14491 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14492 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14493 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14494 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
14495 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14496 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14497 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
14498 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14499 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14500 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14501 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14502 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14503 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14504 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14505 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14506 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14507 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14508 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14509 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14510 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14511 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14512 return ret;
14515 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
14516 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14517 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
14518 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
14520 ROTATERT is similar:
14521 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
14522 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14523 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
14525 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14526 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
14527 machine_mode mem_mode)
14529 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14530 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
14531 int i;
14533 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
14534 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
14535 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
14536 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14537 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14538 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
14539 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14540 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14541 return NULL;
14542 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14543 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14545 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14546 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
14547 mode, mem_mode,
14548 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14549 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14550 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14551 ? DW_OP_const4u
14552 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14553 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
14554 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
14555 else
14556 mask[i] = NULL;
14557 if (mask[i] == NULL)
14558 return NULL;
14559 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14561 ret = op0;
14562 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14563 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14564 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14565 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
14567 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14568 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14569 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14571 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14572 if (mask[0] != NULL)
14573 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
14574 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14575 if (mask[1] != NULL)
14577 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14578 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
14579 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14581 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
14583 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14584 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14585 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14587 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14588 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14589 return ret;
14592 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
14593 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
14595 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14596 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
14598 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14599 dw_die_ref ref;
14601 if (dwarf_strict)
14602 return NULL;
14603 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
14604 /* With LTO during LTRANS we get the late DIE that refers to the early
14605 DIE, thus we add another indirection here. This seems to confuse
14606 gdb enough to make gcc.dg/guality/pr68860-1.c FAIL with LTO. */
14607 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
14608 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
14609 if (ref)
14611 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14612 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14613 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14615 else
14617 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14618 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
14620 return ret;
14623 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
14624 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
14625 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
14626 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
14628 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
14629 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
14630 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
14631 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
14633 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
14635 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
14636 autoincrement addressing modes.
14638 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
14640 dw_loc_descr_ref
14641 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14642 machine_mode mem_mode,
14643 enum var_init_status initialized)
14645 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
14646 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14647 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14648 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
14650 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14651 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14653 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
14654 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
14655 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
14656 zeroth element of the array. */
14658 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14660 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
14661 return NULL;
14663 scalar_int_mode int_mode, inner_mode, op1_mode;
14664 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14666 case POST_INC:
14667 case POST_DEC:
14668 case POST_MODIFY:
14669 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14671 case SUBREG:
14672 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14673 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14674 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14675 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14676 contains the given subreg. */
14677 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14678 break;
14679 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
14680 /* FALLTHRU */
14681 case TRUNCATE:
14682 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
14683 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14684 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14685 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14686 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14687 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14688 || (int_mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
14689 #endif
14691 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14693 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14694 inner_mode,
14695 mem_mode, initialized);
14696 break;
14698 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14699 break;
14700 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14701 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
14702 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
14703 : GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14705 dw_die_ref type_die;
14706 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14708 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
14709 GET_MODE (inner),
14710 mem_mode, initialized);
14711 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14712 break;
14713 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14714 if (type_die == NULL)
14716 mem_loc_result = NULL;
14717 break;
14719 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
14720 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
14721 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14722 else
14723 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_reinterpret), 0, 0);
14724 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14725 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14726 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14727 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14728 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14729 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14731 /* Convert it to untyped afterwards. */
14732 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14733 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14736 break;
14738 case REG:
14739 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14740 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14741 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
14742 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
14743 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14744 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14745 #endif
14748 dw_die_ref type_die;
14749 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
14751 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14752 break;
14753 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14754 break;
14755 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14756 if (type_die == NULL)
14757 break;
14759 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
14760 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
14761 break;
14762 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_regval_type),
14763 dbx_regnum, 0);
14764 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14765 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14766 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14767 break;
14769 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
14770 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
14771 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
14772 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
14773 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
14774 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
14775 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
14776 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
14777 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
14778 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
14779 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
14780 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
14781 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
14782 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14783 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14784 else if (stack_realign_drap
14785 && crtl->drap_reg
14786 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
14787 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14789 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
14790 out, use DRAP instead. */
14791 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
14792 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14794 break;
14796 case SIGN_EXTEND:
14797 case ZERO_EXTEND:
14798 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14799 || !is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode))
14800 break;
14801 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
14802 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14803 if (op0 == 0)
14804 break;
14805 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
14806 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14807 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14808 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
14809 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
14810 masking. */
14811 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= 4)
14813 mem_loc_result = op0;
14814 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14815 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (inner_mode)));
14816 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14818 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14820 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
14821 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14822 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
14823 op = DW_OP_shra;
14824 else
14825 op = DW_OP_shr;
14826 mem_loc_result = op0;
14827 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14828 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14829 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14830 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14832 else if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
14834 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
14835 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14837 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (inner_mode,
14838 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
14839 if (type_die1 == NULL)
14840 break;
14841 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
14842 if (type_die2 == NULL)
14843 break;
14844 mem_loc_result = op0;
14845 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14846 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14847 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
14848 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14849 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14850 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14851 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14852 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
14853 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14854 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14856 break;
14858 case MEM:
14860 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14861 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14863 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
14864 initialized);
14865 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14866 return mem_loc_result;
14869 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14870 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
14871 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14872 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14873 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14874 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
14876 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14877 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14879 dw_die_ref type_die;
14880 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
14882 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14883 return NULL;
14884 type_die
14885 = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
14886 if (type_die == NULL)
14887 return NULL;
14888 deref = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_deref_type),
14889 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14890 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14891 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14892 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14893 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
14895 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14896 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
14897 else
14898 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14899 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
14900 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0));
14902 break;
14904 case LO_SUM:
14905 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14907 case LABEL_REF:
14908 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
14909 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
14910 pool. */
14911 case CONST:
14912 case SYMBOL_REF:
14913 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14914 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14915 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14916 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14917 #endif
14919 break;
14920 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
14921 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
14923 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14925 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
14926 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14927 break;
14929 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
14931 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
14932 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
14933 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr ((dwarf_version >= 5
14934 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
14935 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address),
14936 0, 0);
14937 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
14939 break;
14942 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14944 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
14945 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode,
14946 mem_mode, initialized);
14947 break;
14950 symref:
14951 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
14952 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
14953 break;
14955 case CONCAT:
14956 case CONCATN:
14957 case VAR_LOCATION:
14958 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14959 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14960 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
14961 return 0;
14963 case ENTRY_VALUE:
14964 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
14965 return NULL;
14966 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
14968 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14969 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14970 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
14971 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14972 else
14974 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
14975 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
14976 return NULL;
14977 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
14978 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14981 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
14982 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
14984 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
14985 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14986 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
14987 return NULL;
14989 else
14990 gcc_unreachable ();
14991 if (op0 == NULL)
14992 return NULL;
14993 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_entry_value), 0, 0);
14994 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14995 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
14996 break;
14998 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
14999 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
15000 break;
15002 case PRE_MODIFY:
15003 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
15004 PLUS code below. */
15005 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15006 goto plus;
15008 case PRE_INC:
15009 case PRE_DEC:
15010 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
15011 below. */
15012 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15013 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
15014 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
15015 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
15016 mode));
15018 /* fall through */
15020 case PLUS:
15021 plus:
15022 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
15023 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15024 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15025 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
15026 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx))
15027 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15028 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
15029 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15030 else
15032 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15033 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15034 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
15035 break;
15037 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15038 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
15039 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15040 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15041 else
15043 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15044 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15045 if (op1 == 0)
15046 return NULL;
15047 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15048 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15049 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15052 break;
15054 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
15055 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
15056 case MINUS:
15057 op = DW_OP_minus;
15058 goto do_binop;
15060 case MULT:
15061 op = DW_OP_mul;
15062 goto do_binop;
15064 case DIV:
15065 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15066 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15067 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15069 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15070 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15071 int_mode, mem_mode);
15072 break;
15074 op = DW_OP_div;
15075 goto do_binop;
15077 case UMOD:
15078 op = DW_OP_mod;
15079 goto do_binop;
15081 case ASHIFT:
15082 op = DW_OP_shl;
15083 goto do_shift;
15085 case ASHIFTRT:
15086 op = DW_OP_shra;
15087 goto do_shift;
15089 case LSHIFTRT:
15090 op = DW_OP_shr;
15091 goto do_shift;
15093 do_shift:
15094 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15095 break;
15096 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode, mem_mode,
15097 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15099 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15100 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (rtlop1), &op1_mode)
15101 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op1_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode))
15102 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (int_mode, rtlop1);
15103 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, int_mode, mem_mode,
15104 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15107 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15108 break;
15110 mem_loc_result = op0;
15111 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15112 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15113 break;
15115 case AND:
15116 op = DW_OP_and;
15117 goto do_binop;
15119 case IOR:
15120 op = DW_OP_or;
15121 goto do_binop;
15123 case XOR:
15124 op = DW_OP_xor;
15125 goto do_binop;
15127 do_binop:
15128 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15129 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15130 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15131 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15133 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15134 break;
15136 mem_loc_result = op0;
15137 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15138 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15139 break;
15141 case MOD:
15142 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15143 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15144 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15146 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
15147 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15148 int_mode, mem_mode);
15149 break;
15152 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15153 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15154 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15155 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15157 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15158 break;
15160 mem_loc_result = op0;
15161 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15162 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15163 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15164 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15165 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15166 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15167 break;
15169 case UDIV:
15170 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15171 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15173 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15175 op = DW_OP_div;
15176 goto do_binop;
15178 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15179 base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1),
15180 int_mode, mem_mode);
15182 break;
15184 case NOT:
15185 op = DW_OP_not;
15186 goto do_unop;
15188 case ABS:
15189 op = DW_OP_abs;
15190 goto do_unop;
15192 case NEG:
15193 op = DW_OP_neg;
15194 goto do_unop;
15196 do_unop:
15197 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15198 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15200 if (op0 == 0)
15201 break;
15203 mem_loc_result = op0;
15204 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15205 break;
15207 case CONST_INT:
15208 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15209 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15210 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15211 || (int_mode == Pmode
15212 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
15213 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
15214 #endif
15217 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15218 break;
15220 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15221 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15222 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15224 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15225 scalar_int_mode amode;
15226 if (type_die == NULL)
15227 return NULL;
15228 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
15229 && (int_mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0)
15230 .exists (&amode))
15231 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
15232 /* const DW_OP_convert <XXX> vs.
15233 DW_OP_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
15234 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
15235 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode))
15237 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15238 op0 = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15239 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15240 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15241 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15242 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15243 return mem_loc_result;
15245 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0,
15246 INTVAL (rtl));
15247 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15248 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15249 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15250 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15251 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15252 else
15254 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15255 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15256 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15257 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
15260 break;
15262 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15263 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15265 dw_die_ref type_die;
15267 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
15268 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
15269 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
15270 the value is always a floating point constant.
15272 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15273 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
15274 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15275 if (mode == VOIDmode
15276 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
15277 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15278 break;
15279 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15280 if (type_die == NULL)
15281 return NULL;
15282 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15283 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15284 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15285 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15286 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15287 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15289 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15290 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15291 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15292 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15294 else
15295 #endif
15297 scalar_float_mode float_mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (mode);
15298 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (float_mode);
15299 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15301 insert_float (rtl, array);
15302 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15303 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15304 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15305 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15308 break;
15310 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15311 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15313 dw_die_ref type_die;
15315 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15316 if (type_die == NULL)
15317 return NULL;
15318 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
15319 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15320 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15321 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15322 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15323 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
15324 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
15325 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, mode);
15327 break;
15329 case EQ:
15330 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
15331 break;
15333 case GE:
15334 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15335 break;
15337 case GT:
15338 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15339 break;
15341 case LE:
15342 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15343 break;
15345 case LT:
15346 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15347 break;
15349 case NE:
15350 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
15351 break;
15353 case GEU:
15354 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15355 break;
15357 case GTU:
15358 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15359 break;
15361 case LEU:
15362 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15363 break;
15365 case LTU:
15366 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15367 break;
15369 case UMIN:
15370 case UMAX:
15371 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
15372 break;
15373 /* FALLTHRU */
15374 case SMIN:
15375 case SMAX:
15376 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15377 break;
15379 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
15380 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
15381 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15382 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15383 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15384 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode)
15385 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15386 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15387 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15388 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15389 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode)))
15391 int shift, size;
15392 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
15393 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15394 if (op0 == 0)
15395 break;
15396 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
15397 op = DW_OP_shra;
15398 else
15399 op = DW_OP_shr;
15400 mem_loc_result = op0;
15401 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
15402 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
15403 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15404 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - shift - size;
15405 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15407 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15408 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15409 - shift - size));
15410 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15412 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15414 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15415 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
15416 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15419 break;
15421 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
15423 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
15424 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15425 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
15426 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15427 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15428 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15429 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15430 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
15431 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15432 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
15433 break;
15435 mem_loc_result = op1;
15436 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
15437 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15438 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15439 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
15440 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15441 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15442 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
15443 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15444 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
15446 break;
15448 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
15449 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
15450 case FLOAT:
15451 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
15452 case FIX:
15453 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
15454 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15456 dw_die_ref type_die;
15457 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15459 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15460 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15461 if (op0 == NULL)
15462 break;
15463 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &int_mode)
15464 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
15465 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15467 type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode,
15468 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
15469 if (type_die == NULL)
15470 break;
15471 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15472 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15473 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15474 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15475 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15477 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
15478 if (type_die == NULL)
15479 break;
15480 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15481 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15482 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15483 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15484 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15485 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15486 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
15487 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15489 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, op0);
15490 if (op0 == NULL)
15491 break;
15493 mem_loc_result = op0;
15495 break;
15497 case CLZ:
15498 case CTZ:
15499 case FFS:
15500 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15501 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15502 break;
15504 case POPCOUNT:
15505 case PARITY:
15506 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15507 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15508 break;
15510 case BSWAP:
15511 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15512 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15513 break;
15515 case ROTATE:
15516 case ROTATERT:
15517 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15518 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
15519 break;
15521 case COMPARE:
15522 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
15523 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
15524 natively. */
15525 case SS_MULT:
15526 case US_MULT:
15527 case SS_DIV:
15528 case US_DIV:
15529 case SS_PLUS:
15530 case US_PLUS:
15531 case SS_MINUS:
15532 case US_MINUS:
15533 case SS_NEG:
15534 case US_NEG:
15535 case SS_ABS:
15536 case SS_ASHIFT:
15537 case US_ASHIFT:
15538 case SS_TRUNCATE:
15539 case US_TRUNCATE:
15540 case UNORDERED:
15541 case ORDERED:
15542 case UNEQ:
15543 case UNGE:
15544 case UNGT:
15545 case UNLE:
15546 case UNLT:
15547 case LTGT:
15548 case FRACT_CONVERT:
15549 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
15550 case SAT_FRACT:
15551 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
15552 case SQRT:
15553 case ASM_OPERANDS:
15554 case VEC_MERGE:
15555 case VEC_SELECT:
15556 case VEC_CONCAT:
15557 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
15558 case UNSPEC:
15559 case HIGH:
15560 case FMA:
15561 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
15562 case CONST_VECTOR:
15563 case CONST_FIXED:
15564 case CLRSB:
15565 case CLOBBER:
15566 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
15567 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
15568 TLS UNSPECs. */
15569 break;
15571 case CONST_STRING:
15572 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
15573 goto symref;
15575 /* RTL sequences inside PARALLEL record a series of DWARF operations for
15576 the expression. An UNSPEC rtx represents a raw DWARF operation,
15577 new_loc_descr is called for it to build the operation directly.
15578 Otherwise mem_loc_descriptor is called recursively. */
15579 case PARALLEL:
15581 int index = 0;
15582 dw_loc_descr_ref exp_result = NULL;
15584 for (; index < XVECLEN (rtl, 0); index++)
15586 rtx elem = XVECEXP (rtl, 0, index);
15587 if (GET_CODE (elem) == UNSPEC)
15589 /* Each DWARF operation UNSPEC contain two operands, if
15590 one operand is not used for the operation, const0_rtx is
15591 passed. */
15592 gcc_assert (XVECLEN (elem, 0) == 2);
15594 HOST_WIDE_INT dw_op = XINT (elem, 1);
15595 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 0));
15596 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 1));
15597 exp_result
15598 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) dw_op, oprnd1,
15599 oprnd2);
15601 else
15602 exp_result
15603 = mem_loc_descriptor (elem, mode, mem_mode,
15604 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15606 if (!mem_loc_result)
15607 mem_loc_result = exp_result;
15608 else
15609 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, exp_result);
15612 break;
15615 default:
15616 if (flag_checking)
15618 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
15619 gcc_unreachable ();
15621 break;
15624 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15625 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15627 return mem_loc_result;
15630 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
15631 This is typically a complex variable. */
15633 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15634 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
15636 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15637 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
15638 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15639 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
15640 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15642 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
15643 return 0;
15645 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
15646 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
15648 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
15649 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
15651 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15652 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15654 return cc_loc_result;
15657 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
15658 locations. */
15660 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15661 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
15663 unsigned int i;
15664 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15665 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
15667 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
15669 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
15670 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
15672 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15673 if (ref == NULL)
15674 return NULL;
15676 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
15677 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
15680 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15681 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15683 return cc_loc_result;
15686 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_implicit_pointer
15687 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
15689 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15690 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15692 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15693 dw_die_ref ref;
15695 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15696 return NULL;
15697 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
15698 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
15699 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
15700 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
15701 ret = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
15702 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15703 if (ref)
15705 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15706 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15707 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15709 else
15711 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15712 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
15714 return ret;
15717 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
15718 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
15719 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
15720 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
15721 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
15723 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
15724 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
15725 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
15727 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
15729 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15730 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
15731 enum var_init_status initialized)
15733 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
15734 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
15736 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15738 case SUBREG:
15739 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15740 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15741 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
15742 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15743 contains the given subreg. */
15744 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15745 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
15746 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
15747 else
15748 goto do_default;
15749 break;
15751 case REG:
15752 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15753 break;
15755 case MEM:
15756 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
15757 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
15758 if (loc_result == NULL)
15759 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15760 if (loc_result == NULL)
15762 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15763 if (new_rtl != rtl)
15764 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
15766 break;
15768 case CONCAT:
15769 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
15770 initialized);
15771 break;
15773 case CONCATN:
15774 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15775 break;
15777 case VAR_LOCATION:
15778 /* Single part. */
15779 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
15781 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
15782 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
15783 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
15784 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
15785 break;
15788 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15789 /* FALLTHRU */
15791 case PARALLEL:
15793 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
15794 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
15795 machine_mode mode;
15796 int i;
15798 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
15799 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
15800 VOIDmode, initialized);
15801 if (loc_result == NULL)
15802 return NULL;
15803 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
15804 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15805 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
15807 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15809 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
15810 VOIDmode, initialized);
15811 if (temp == NULL)
15812 return NULL;
15813 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
15814 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
15815 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15818 break;
15820 case CONST_INT:
15821 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
15823 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15824 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode),
15825 INTVAL (rtl));
15827 break;
15829 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15830 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15831 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15833 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15835 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15837 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
15838 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15839 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
15840 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15841 scalar_mode smode = as_a <scalar_mode> (mode);
15842 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15843 GET_MODE_SIZE (smode), 0);
15844 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
15845 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (smode))
15847 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
15848 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15849 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15851 else
15852 #endif
15854 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (smode);
15855 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15857 insert_float (rtl, array);
15858 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15859 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15860 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15861 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15864 break;
15866 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15867 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15868 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15870 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15872 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
15873 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15874 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0);
15875 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
15876 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
15877 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, int_mode);
15879 break;
15881 case CONST_VECTOR:
15882 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15883 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15885 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15887 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15888 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15889 unsigned char *array
15890 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
15891 unsigned int i;
15892 unsigned char *p;
15893 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
15895 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15896 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15898 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15899 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15901 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15902 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
15904 break;
15906 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15907 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15909 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15910 insert_float (elt, p);
15912 break;
15914 default:
15915 gcc_unreachable ();
15918 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15919 length * elt_size, 0);
15920 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15921 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
15922 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
15923 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15925 break;
15927 case CONST:
15928 if (mode == VOIDmode
15929 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15930 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15931 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
15933 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
15934 break;
15936 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15937 case SYMBOL_REF:
15938 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15939 break;
15940 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15941 case LABEL_REF:
15942 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15943 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15944 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15946 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15947 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15948 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15950 break;
15952 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15953 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
15954 break;
15956 case PLUS:
15957 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
15958 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
15960 loc_result
15961 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15962 break;
15964 /* FALLTHRU */
15965 do_default:
15966 default:
15967 if ((is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15968 && GET_MODE (rtl) == int_mode
15969 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15970 && dwarf_version >= 4)
15971 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
15973 /* Value expression. */
15974 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
15975 if (loc_result)
15976 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
15977 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15979 break;
15982 return loc_result;
15985 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
15986 address ranges where a given location is valid.
15987 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
15988 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
15989 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
15990 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
15992 static const char *
15993 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
15995 const char *secname;
15997 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
15998 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
15999 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
16000 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
16001 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
16002 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
16003 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
16004 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
16005 else
16006 secname = text_section_label;
16008 return secname;
16011 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
16013 static bool
16014 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
16016 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
16017 || VAR_P (decl))
16018 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
16021 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16022 for VARLOC. */
16024 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16025 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
16026 enum var_init_status initialized)
16028 int have_address = 0;
16029 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16030 machine_mode mode;
16032 if (want_address != 2)
16034 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
16035 /* Single part. */
16036 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16038 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16039 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16040 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16041 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
16042 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16044 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16045 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
16046 mode, initialized);
16047 if (descr)
16048 have_address = 1;
16049 else
16051 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
16052 if (x != varloc)
16053 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
16054 initialized);
16057 else
16058 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16060 else
16061 return 0;
16063 else
16065 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
16066 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
16067 else
16068 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
16069 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
16070 have_address = 1;
16073 if (!descr)
16074 return 0;
16076 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16077 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16079 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16081 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16082 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16083 return 0;
16085 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16086 have_address = 1;
16088 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16089 if (want_address && !have_address)
16091 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16092 "Want address and only have value");
16093 return 0;
16096 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16097 if (!want_address && have_address)
16099 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16100 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16102 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16104 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16105 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16106 return 0;
16108 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16109 op = DW_OP_deref;
16110 else
16111 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16113 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16116 return descr;
16119 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
16120 if it is not possible. */
16122 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16123 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16125 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
16126 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
16127 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16128 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
16129 else
16130 return NULL;
16133 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16134 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
16136 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16137 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
16139 rtx p;
16140 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
16141 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
16142 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
16143 rtx varloc;
16144 enum var_init_status initialized;
16146 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
16147 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16148 return NULL;
16150 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
16151 descr = NULL;
16152 descr_tail = &descr;
16154 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
16156 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
16157 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
16158 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
16159 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
16160 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
16162 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
16163 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
16165 padsize += bitsize;
16166 continue;
16168 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
16169 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
16170 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
16171 if (cur_descr == NULL)
16173 padsize += bitsize;
16174 continue;
16177 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
16178 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
16179 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
16180 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
16181 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
16182 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
16184 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
16185 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16186 last = *tail;
16188 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
16190 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16191 last = *tail;
16194 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
16196 padsize += bitsize;
16197 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
16198 addr_table entries it uses. */
16199 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16200 continue;
16203 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
16204 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
16205 if (padsize)
16207 if (padsize > decl_size)
16209 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16210 goto discard_descr;
16212 decl_size -= padsize;
16213 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
16214 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16216 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16217 goto discard_descr;
16219 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16220 padsize = 0;
16222 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
16223 descr_tail = tail;
16224 if (bitsize > decl_size)
16225 goto discard_descr;
16226 decl_size -= bitsize;
16227 if (last == NULL)
16229 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
16230 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
16231 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16233 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16234 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16235 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16239 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
16240 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
16241 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
16242 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16243 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
16244 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
16245 else
16246 break;
16248 while (1);
16249 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
16250 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
16251 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
16252 adjustment. */
16253 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16255 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
16256 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16257 if (memsize != bitsize)
16259 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
16260 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
16261 goto discard_descr;
16262 if (memsize < bitsize)
16263 goto discard_descr;
16264 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16265 offset = memsize - bitsize;
16269 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
16270 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16271 goto discard_descr;
16272 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16276 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
16277 the decl. */
16278 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
16280 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
16281 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16282 goto discard_descr;
16284 return descr;
16286 discard_descr:
16287 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
16288 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
16289 return NULL;
16292 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
16293 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
16294 function. */
16296 static dw_loc_list_ref
16297 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
16299 const char *endname, *secname;
16300 rtx varloc;
16301 enum var_init_status initialized;
16302 struct var_loc_node *node;
16303 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16304 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
16305 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
16306 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
16308 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
16309 actually construct the list of locations.
16310 The first location information is what is passed to the
16311 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
16312 locations just get added on to that list.
16313 Note that we only know the start address for a location
16314 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
16315 the range [current location start, next location start].
16316 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
16317 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
16319 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16321 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
16322 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
16323 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
16325 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16327 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
16328 inside DWARF expressions. */
16329 if (want_address != 2)
16330 continue;
16331 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16332 if (descr == NULL)
16333 continue;
16335 else
16337 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16338 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16339 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
16341 if (descr)
16343 bool range_across_switch = false;
16344 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
16345 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
16346 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
16347 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
16348 of first partition and second one starting at the
16349 beginning of second partition. */
16350 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
16351 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
16352 && current_function_decl)
16354 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
16355 range_across_switch = true;
16357 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16358 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16359 else if (node->next)
16360 endname = node->next->label;
16361 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
16362 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
16363 else if (!current_function_decl)
16364 endname = text_end_label;
16365 else
16367 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
16368 current_function_funcdef_no);
16369 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
16372 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
16373 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16374 && node == loc_list->first
16375 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
16376 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
16377 (*listp)->force = true;
16378 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16380 if (range_across_switch)
16382 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16383 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16384 else
16386 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16387 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16388 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
16389 initialized);
16391 gcc_assert (descr);
16392 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16393 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16394 if (node->next)
16395 endname = node->next->label;
16396 else
16397 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
16398 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
16399 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
16400 endname, secname);
16401 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16406 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
16407 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
16408 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
16409 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
16410 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
16411 available. */
16412 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
16413 gen_llsym (list);
16415 return list;
16418 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
16419 as location description. */
16421 static bool
16422 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
16424 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
16425 return !list->ll_symbol;
16428 /* Duplicate a single element of location list. */
16430 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
16431 copy_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16433 dw_loc_descr_ref copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
16434 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
16435 return copy;
16438 /* To each location in list LIST append loc descr REF. */
16440 static void
16441 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16443 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16444 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
16445 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16446 while (list)
16448 copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16449 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
16450 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
16451 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16452 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16456 /* To each location in list LIST prepend loc descr REF. */
16458 static void
16459 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16461 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16462 dw_loc_descr_ref ref_end = list->expr;
16463 add_loc_descr (&ref, list->expr);
16464 list->expr = ref;
16465 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16466 while (list)
16468 dw_loc_descr_ref end = list->expr;
16469 list->expr = copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
16470 while (copy->dw_loc_next != ref_end)
16471 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
16472 copy->dw_loc_next = end;
16473 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16477 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
16478 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
16479 to expression in RET on each position in program.
16480 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
16482 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
16483 element. General case would involve sorting the lists in program order
16484 and merging them that will need some additional work.
16485 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
16486 structures. */
16488 static void
16489 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
16491 if (!list)
16492 return;
16493 if (!*ret)
16495 *ret = list;
16496 return;
16498 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
16500 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
16501 return;
16503 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
16505 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
16506 *ret = list;
16507 return;
16509 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
16510 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
16511 " location lists.\n");
16512 *ret = NULL;
16513 return;
16516 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
16517 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
16519 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16520 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
16522 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
16523 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
16525 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
16527 gcc_assert (!rtl);
16528 return 0;
16530 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
16532 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
16533 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
16534 populated. */
16535 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
16537 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16538 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
16539 return 0;
16541 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16542 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16545 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
16546 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
16547 it into simple arithmetics.
16549 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
16551 static dw_loc_list_ref
16552 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
16553 loc_descr_context *context)
16555 tree obj, offset;
16556 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16557 machine_mode mode;
16558 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
16559 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
16561 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
16562 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16563 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
16564 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
16565 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
16567 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
16568 return 0;
16570 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
16572 expansion_failed (obj,
16573 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
16574 return 0;
16576 if (!offset && !bitpos)
16577 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
16578 context);
16579 else if (toplev
16580 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16581 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16583 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
16584 if (!list_ret)
16585 return 0;
16586 if (offset)
16588 /* Variable offset. */
16589 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
16590 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16591 return 0;
16592 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16593 if (!list_ret)
16594 return 0;
16595 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16596 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16598 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16599 if (bytepos > 0)
16600 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16601 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
16602 bytepos, 0));
16603 else if (bytepos < 0)
16604 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16605 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16606 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16608 return list_ret;
16611 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
16612 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
16613 operations that are skipped. */
16615 static void
16616 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
16617 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
16619 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
16621 nops.add (loc);
16622 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
16626 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
16627 P. */
16629 bool
16630 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16632 ggc_free (loc);
16633 return true;
16636 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
16637 finishes LOC. */
16639 static void
16640 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
16642 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
16643 return;
16645 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
16646 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
16648 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
16649 operations list. */
16650 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
16652 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
16654 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
16655 labels. */
16656 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16657 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
16658 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
16659 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
16661 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
16662 iteration. */
16663 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
16664 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
16665 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
16668 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
16672 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
16674 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
16675 struct loc_descr_context
16677 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
16678 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
16679 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
16680 tree context_type;
16681 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
16682 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
16683 tree base_decl;
16684 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
16685 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
16686 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
16687 /* True if integral PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for the first argument passed
16688 by consumer. Used for DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes. */
16689 bool placeholder_arg;
16690 /* True if PLACEHOLDER_EXPR has been seen. */
16691 bool placeholder_seen;
16694 /* DWARF procedures generation
16696 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
16697 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
16698 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
16699 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
16701 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
16702 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
16703 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
16704 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
16705 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
16706 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
16708 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
16709 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
16711 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
16712 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
16713 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
16715 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
16716 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
16718 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
16719 single stack slot.
16721 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
16722 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
16723 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
16724 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
16725 returns. */
16727 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
16728 struct dwarf_procedure_info
16730 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
16731 currently translated. */
16732 tree fndecl;
16733 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
16734 unsigned args_count;
16737 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
16738 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
16739 equate it to this DIE. */
16741 static dw_die_ref
16742 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
16743 dw_die_ref parent_die)
16745 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
16747 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
16748 || location == NULL)
16749 return NULL;
16751 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, parent_die, fndecl);
16752 if (fndecl)
16753 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
16754 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
16755 return dwarf_proc_die;
16758 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
16759 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
16760 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
16762 static bool
16763 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
16765 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
16766 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
16767 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
16768 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
16771 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
16772 visited nodes. For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
16773 offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation. */
16775 static bool
16776 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
16777 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
16778 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
16780 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
16781 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
16782 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
16784 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
16786 bool existed;
16787 unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
16789 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
16790 if (existed)
16792 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
16793 flow comes from. */
16794 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
16795 break;
16797 l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
16799 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
16800 offset. */
16801 if (l->frame_offset_rel)
16803 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off;
16804 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
16806 case DW_OP_pick:
16807 off = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16808 break;
16809 case DW_OP_dup:
16810 off = 0;
16811 break;
16812 case DW_OP_over:
16813 off = 1;
16814 break;
16815 default:
16816 gcc_unreachable ();
16818 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
16819 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
16820 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
16821 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
16822 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
16823 one, etc.).
16825 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
16826 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
16827 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
16828 off += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
16830 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
16831 if (off > 255)
16832 return false;
16834 if (off == 0)
16836 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_dup;
16837 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16839 else if (off == 1)
16841 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_over;
16842 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
16844 else
16846 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_pick;
16847 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = off;
16851 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
16852 on the stack. */
16853 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
16855 case DW_OP_deref:
16856 case DW_OP_swap:
16857 case DW_OP_rot:
16858 case DW_OP_abs:
16859 case DW_OP_neg:
16860 case DW_OP_not:
16861 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
16862 case DW_OP_skip:
16863 case DW_OP_reg0:
16864 case DW_OP_reg1:
16865 case DW_OP_reg2:
16866 case DW_OP_reg3:
16867 case DW_OP_reg4:
16868 case DW_OP_reg5:
16869 case DW_OP_reg6:
16870 case DW_OP_reg7:
16871 case DW_OP_reg8:
16872 case DW_OP_reg9:
16873 case DW_OP_reg10:
16874 case DW_OP_reg11:
16875 case DW_OP_reg12:
16876 case DW_OP_reg13:
16877 case DW_OP_reg14:
16878 case DW_OP_reg15:
16879 case DW_OP_reg16:
16880 case DW_OP_reg17:
16881 case DW_OP_reg18:
16882 case DW_OP_reg19:
16883 case DW_OP_reg20:
16884 case DW_OP_reg21:
16885 case DW_OP_reg22:
16886 case DW_OP_reg23:
16887 case DW_OP_reg24:
16888 case DW_OP_reg25:
16889 case DW_OP_reg26:
16890 case DW_OP_reg27:
16891 case DW_OP_reg28:
16892 case DW_OP_reg29:
16893 case DW_OP_reg30:
16894 case DW_OP_reg31:
16895 case DW_OP_bregx:
16896 case DW_OP_piece:
16897 case DW_OP_deref_size:
16898 case DW_OP_nop:
16899 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
16900 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
16901 case DW_OP_stack_value:
16902 break;
16904 case DW_OP_addr:
16905 case DW_OP_const1u:
16906 case DW_OP_const1s:
16907 case DW_OP_const2u:
16908 case DW_OP_const2s:
16909 case DW_OP_const4u:
16910 case DW_OP_const4s:
16911 case DW_OP_const8u:
16912 case DW_OP_const8s:
16913 case DW_OP_constu:
16914 case DW_OP_consts:
16915 case DW_OP_dup:
16916 case DW_OP_over:
16917 case DW_OP_pick:
16918 case DW_OP_lit0:
16919 case DW_OP_lit1:
16920 case DW_OP_lit2:
16921 case DW_OP_lit3:
16922 case DW_OP_lit4:
16923 case DW_OP_lit5:
16924 case DW_OP_lit6:
16925 case DW_OP_lit7:
16926 case DW_OP_lit8:
16927 case DW_OP_lit9:
16928 case DW_OP_lit10:
16929 case DW_OP_lit11:
16930 case DW_OP_lit12:
16931 case DW_OP_lit13:
16932 case DW_OP_lit14:
16933 case DW_OP_lit15:
16934 case DW_OP_lit16:
16935 case DW_OP_lit17:
16936 case DW_OP_lit18:
16937 case DW_OP_lit19:
16938 case DW_OP_lit20:
16939 case DW_OP_lit21:
16940 case DW_OP_lit22:
16941 case DW_OP_lit23:
16942 case DW_OP_lit24:
16943 case DW_OP_lit25:
16944 case DW_OP_lit26:
16945 case DW_OP_lit27:
16946 case DW_OP_lit28:
16947 case DW_OP_lit29:
16948 case DW_OP_lit30:
16949 case DW_OP_lit31:
16950 case DW_OP_breg0:
16951 case DW_OP_breg1:
16952 case DW_OP_breg2:
16953 case DW_OP_breg3:
16954 case DW_OP_breg4:
16955 case DW_OP_breg5:
16956 case DW_OP_breg6:
16957 case DW_OP_breg7:
16958 case DW_OP_breg8:
16959 case DW_OP_breg9:
16960 case DW_OP_breg10:
16961 case DW_OP_breg11:
16962 case DW_OP_breg12:
16963 case DW_OP_breg13:
16964 case DW_OP_breg14:
16965 case DW_OP_breg15:
16966 case DW_OP_breg16:
16967 case DW_OP_breg17:
16968 case DW_OP_breg18:
16969 case DW_OP_breg19:
16970 case DW_OP_breg20:
16971 case DW_OP_breg21:
16972 case DW_OP_breg22:
16973 case DW_OP_breg23:
16974 case DW_OP_breg24:
16975 case DW_OP_breg25:
16976 case DW_OP_breg26:
16977 case DW_OP_breg27:
16978 case DW_OP_breg28:
16979 case DW_OP_breg29:
16980 case DW_OP_breg30:
16981 case DW_OP_breg31:
16982 case DW_OP_fbreg:
16983 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
16984 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
16985 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
16986 ++frame_offset_;
16987 break;
16989 case DW_OP_drop:
16990 case DW_OP_xderef:
16991 case DW_OP_and:
16992 case DW_OP_div:
16993 case DW_OP_minus:
16994 case DW_OP_mod:
16995 case DW_OP_mul:
16996 case DW_OP_or:
16997 case DW_OP_plus:
16998 case DW_OP_shl:
16999 case DW_OP_shr:
17000 case DW_OP_shra:
17001 case DW_OP_xor:
17002 case DW_OP_bra:
17003 case DW_OP_eq:
17004 case DW_OP_ge:
17005 case DW_OP_gt:
17006 case DW_OP_le:
17007 case DW_OP_lt:
17008 case DW_OP_ne:
17009 case DW_OP_regx:
17010 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
17011 --frame_offset_;
17012 break;
17014 case DW_OP_call2:
17015 case DW_OP_call4:
17016 case DW_OP_call_ref:
17018 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
17019 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
17021 if (stack_usage == NULL)
17022 return false;
17023 frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
17024 break;
17027 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
17028 case DW_OP_entry_value:
17029 case DW_OP_const_type:
17030 case DW_OP_regval_type:
17031 case DW_OP_deref_type:
17032 case DW_OP_convert:
17033 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
17034 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
17035 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
17036 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
17037 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
17038 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
17039 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
17040 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
17041 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
17042 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
17043 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
17044 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
17045 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
17046 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
17047 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
17048 /* Fall through... */
17050 default:
17051 gcc_unreachable ();
17054 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
17055 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17057 case DW_OP_bra:
17058 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
17059 frame_offsets))
17060 return false;
17061 /* Fall through. */
17063 case DW_OP_skip:
17064 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
17065 break;
17067 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17068 return true;
17070 default:
17071 l = l->dw_loc_next;
17072 break;
17076 return true;
17079 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
17080 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
17081 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
17082 offset *before* LOC is executed. Return if all relocations were
17083 successful. */
17085 static bool
17086 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17087 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
17089 /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
17090 this operation. */
17091 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
17093 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
17094 frame_offsets);
17097 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
17098 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
17100 static dw_die_ref
17101 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
17103 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
17104 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
17105 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17106 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
17107 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
17109 tree cursor;
17110 unsigned i;
17112 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
17113 declaration. */
17114 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
17115 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
17116 return dwarf_proc_die;
17118 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard. */
17119 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17120 return NULL;
17122 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
17123 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
17124 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
17125 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
17126 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
17127 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
17128 return NULL;
17130 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
17131 cursor != NULL_TREE;
17132 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
17133 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
17134 return NULL;
17136 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
17137 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
17138 return NULL;
17139 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
17140 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
17141 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
17142 return NULL;
17143 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
17145 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
17146 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
17147 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
17148 the moment. */
17149 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
17150 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
17151 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
17152 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
17153 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
17154 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
17155 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
17156 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
17157 if (!loc_body)
17158 return NULL;
17160 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
17161 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
17162 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
17163 epilogue = NULL;
17164 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
17166 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
17167 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
17168 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
17169 epilogue = op_couple;
17171 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
17172 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
17173 return NULL;
17175 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
17176 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
17177 not anymore, so give it another try. */
17178 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
17180 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
17181 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
17182 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
17183 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
17184 dwarf_proc_die
17185 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
17186 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
17188 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
17189 returns one stack slot. */
17190 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
17192 return dwarf_proc_die;
17196 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
17197 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
17198 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
17199 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
17200 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
17201 to refer to register values).
17203 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
17204 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
17205 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
17206 will not be generated.
17208 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
17209 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
17211 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
17212 and dpi fields were null. */
17214 static dw_loc_list_ref
17215 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
17216 struct loc_descr_context *context)
17218 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
17219 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
17220 int have_address = 0;
17221 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
17223 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
17224 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
17225 problem... */
17227 if (context != NULL
17228 && context->base_decl == loc
17229 && want_address == 0)
17231 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17232 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
17233 NULL, NULL, NULL);
17234 else
17235 return NULL;
17238 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
17240 case ERROR_MARK:
17241 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
17242 return 0;
17244 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
17245 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
17246 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
17247 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
17248 that the context allows. */
17249 if (context != NULL
17250 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
17251 && want_address >= 1)
17253 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17255 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
17256 have_address = 1;
17257 break;
17259 else
17260 return NULL;
17262 /* For DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes, PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for
17263 the single argument passed by consumer. */
17264 else if (context != NULL
17265 && context->placeholder_arg
17266 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17267 && want_address == 0)
17269 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 0, 0);
17270 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17271 context->placeholder_seen = true;
17272 break;
17274 else
17275 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17276 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
17277 break;
17279 case CALL_EXPR:
17281 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
17282 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
17283 int i;
17284 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
17286 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
17287 goto call_expansion_failed;
17289 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
17290 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
17291 goto call_expansion_failed;
17293 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
17294 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
17295 goto call_expansion_failed;
17297 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
17298 be the top-most one on the stack. */
17299 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
17301 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
17302 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
17303 context);
17305 if (loc_descr == NULL)
17306 goto call_expansion_failed;
17308 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
17311 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
17312 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17313 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
17314 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17315 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17316 break;
17318 call_expansion_failed:
17319 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
17320 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17321 return 0;
17324 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
17325 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
17326 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
17327 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
17328 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
17329 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
17330 return 0;
17332 case ADDR_EXPR:
17333 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
17334 e.g. for &this->field. */
17335 if (want_address)
17337 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
17338 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
17339 if (list_ret)
17340 have_address = 1;
17341 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
17342 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17343 have_address = 1;
17345 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
17346 if (!list_ret && !ret)
17347 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
17348 else
17350 if (want_address)
17351 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
17352 return NULL;
17354 break;
17356 case VAR_DECL:
17357 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
17359 rtx rtl;
17360 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
17361 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
17363 if (targetm.have_tls)
17365 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
17366 data. */
17367 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
17368 return 0;
17370 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
17371 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
17372 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
17373 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
17374 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
17375 operand shouldn't be. */
17376 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
17377 return 0;
17378 dtprel = dtprel_true;
17379 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
17380 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
17381 tls_op = (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
17382 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address);
17384 else
17386 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
17387 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17388 return 0;
17389 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
17390 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
17391 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
17392 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
17393 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
17394 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
17397 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17398 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17399 return 0;
17401 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
17402 return 0;
17403 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17404 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
17405 return 0;
17407 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
17408 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
17409 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17411 have_address = 1;
17412 break;
17414 /* FALLTHRU */
17416 case PARM_DECL:
17417 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
17418 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
17420 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
17421 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
17422 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
17423 with the stack frame size. */
17424 unsigned i = 0;
17425 tree cursor;
17427 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
17428 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
17429 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
17431 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
17432 must belong to the current function. */
17433 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
17435 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
17436 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
17437 break;
17439 /* FALLTHRU */
17441 case RESULT_DECL:
17442 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
17443 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
17444 want_address, context);
17445 /* FALLTHRU */
17447 case FUNCTION_DECL:
17449 rtx rtl;
17450 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
17452 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
17454 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
17455 have_address = want_address != 0;
17456 break;
17458 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
17459 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
17461 if (TREE_CODE (loc) != FUNCTION_DECL
17462 && early_dwarf
17463 && current_function_decl
17464 && want_address != 1
17465 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (loc)
17466 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
17467 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17468 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == current_function_decl
17469 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17470 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
17472 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (loc);
17473 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_variable_value, 0, 0);
17474 if (ref)
17476 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
17477 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
17478 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
17480 else
17482 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
17483 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = loc;
17485 break;
17487 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
17488 return 0;
17490 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
17492 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
17493 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17494 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
17495 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
17497 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17499 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
17500 return 0;
17502 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
17503 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
17504 else
17506 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
17508 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
17509 if (want_address == 2)
17511 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
17512 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17513 have_address = 1;
17515 else
17517 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17518 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
17519 if (MEM_P (rtl))
17521 mem_mode = mode;
17522 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17523 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17524 have_address = 1;
17526 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
17527 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17529 if (!ret)
17530 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
17531 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
17534 break;
17536 case MEM_REF:
17537 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17539 have_address = 1;
17540 goto do_plus;
17542 /* Fallthru. */
17543 case INDIRECT_REF:
17544 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17545 have_address = 1;
17546 break;
17548 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
17549 case SSA_NAME:
17550 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
17551 return NULL;
17553 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
17554 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
17555 context);
17557 CASE_CONVERT:
17558 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17559 case SAVE_EXPR:
17560 case MODIFY_EXPR:
17561 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
17562 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
17563 context);
17565 case COMPONENT_REF:
17566 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
17567 case ARRAY_REF:
17568 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
17569 case REALPART_EXPR:
17570 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
17572 tree obj, offset;
17573 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
17574 machine_mode mode;
17575 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17577 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17578 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
17580 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
17582 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
17583 want_address == 2
17584 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1,
17585 context);
17586 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
17587 for nonzero bitpos. */
17588 if (list_ret == 0)
17589 return 0;
17590 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
17592 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17593 "bitfield access");
17594 return 0;
17597 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
17599 /* Variable offset. */
17600 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
17601 if (list_ret1 == 0)
17602 return 0;
17603 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17604 if (!list_ret)
17605 return 0;
17606 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
17609 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17610 if (bytepos > 0)
17611 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
17612 else if (bytepos < 0)
17613 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
17615 have_address = 1;
17616 break;
17619 case INTEGER_CST:
17620 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17621 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17622 have_address = 1;
17623 else if (want_address == 2
17624 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
17625 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
17626 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
17627 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
17628 have_address = 1;
17629 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
17630 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
17631 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
17632 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
17633 else
17635 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17636 "Integer operand is not host integer");
17637 return 0;
17639 break;
17641 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17642 case REAL_CST:
17643 case STRING_CST:
17644 case COMPLEX_CST:
17645 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
17646 have_address = 1;
17647 else if (TREE_CODE (loc) == CONSTRUCTOR)
17649 tree type = TREE_TYPE (loc);
17650 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17651 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
17652 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17653 constructor_elt *ce;
17655 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
17657 /* This is very limited, but it's enough to output
17658 pointers to member functions, as long as the
17659 referenced function is defined in the current
17660 translation unit. */
17661 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (loc), cnt, ce)
17663 tree val = ce->value;
17665 tree field = ce->index;
17667 if (val)
17668 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17670 if (!field || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
17672 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17673 "bitfield in record type constructor");
17674 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17675 ret = NULL;
17676 break;
17679 HOST_WIDE_INT fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
17680 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = int_byte_position (field);
17681 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
17682 if (pos < offset)
17684 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17685 "out-of-order fields in record constructor");
17686 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17687 ret = NULL;
17688 break;
17690 if (pos > offset)
17692 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, pos - offset, 0);
17693 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17694 offset = pos;
17696 if (val && fieldsize != 0)
17698 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, want_address, context);
17699 if (!ret1)
17701 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17702 "unsupported expression in field");
17703 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
17704 ret = NULL;
17705 break;
17707 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17709 if (fieldsize)
17711 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, fieldsize, 0);
17712 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17713 offset = pos + fieldsize;
17717 if (offset != size)
17719 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size - offset, 0);
17720 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
17721 offset = size;
17724 have_address = !!want_address;
17726 else
17727 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17728 "constructor of non-record type");
17730 else
17731 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
17732 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17733 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
17734 break;
17736 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
17737 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
17738 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
17739 op = DW_OP_and;
17740 goto do_binop;
17742 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
17743 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
17744 op = DW_OP_xor;
17745 goto do_binop;
17747 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
17748 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
17749 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
17750 op = DW_OP_or;
17751 goto do_binop;
17753 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
17754 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
17755 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
17756 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
17757 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
17758 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17759 return 0;
17760 op = DW_OP_div;
17761 goto do_binop;
17763 case MINUS_EXPR:
17764 op = DW_OP_minus;
17765 goto do_binop;
17767 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
17768 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
17769 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
17770 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
17771 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
17773 op = DW_OP_mod;
17774 goto do_binop;
17776 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17777 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17778 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
17779 return 0;
17781 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17782 if (list_ret == 0)
17783 return 0;
17784 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17785 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
17786 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
17787 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
17788 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17789 break;
17791 case MULT_EXPR:
17792 op = DW_OP_mul;
17793 goto do_binop;
17795 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
17796 op = DW_OP_shl;
17797 goto do_binop;
17799 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
17800 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
17801 goto do_binop;
17803 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
17804 case PLUS_EXPR:
17805 do_plus:
17806 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
17808 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
17809 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
17810 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
17811 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
17812 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
17813 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
17814 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
17815 offset_int wi_addend;
17816 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
17817 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
17819 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17820 if (list_ret == 0)
17821 return 0;
17823 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
17824 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
17825 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
17826 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
17827 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
17828 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
17829 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
17830 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
17831 : NULL;
17833 if (loc_naddend != NULL
17834 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
17835 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
17837 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
17838 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17839 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
17841 else
17843 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
17845 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
17846 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
17847 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
17849 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
17851 break;
17854 op = DW_OP_plus;
17855 goto do_binop;
17857 case LE_EXPR:
17858 op = DW_OP_le;
17859 goto do_comp_binop;
17861 case GE_EXPR:
17862 op = DW_OP_ge;
17863 goto do_comp_binop;
17865 case LT_EXPR:
17866 op = DW_OP_lt;
17867 goto do_comp_binop;
17869 case GT_EXPR:
17870 op = DW_OP_gt;
17871 goto do_comp_binop;
17873 do_comp_binop:
17874 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
17876 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17877 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17878 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
17879 TREE_CODE (loc));
17880 break;
17882 else
17883 goto do_binop;
17885 case EQ_EXPR:
17886 op = DW_OP_eq;
17887 goto do_binop;
17889 case NE_EXPR:
17890 op = DW_OP_ne;
17891 goto do_binop;
17893 do_binop:
17894 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17895 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17896 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
17897 return 0;
17899 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17900 if (list_ret == 0)
17901 return 0;
17902 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
17903 break;
17905 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
17906 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
17907 op = DW_OP_not;
17908 goto do_unop;
17910 case ABS_EXPR:
17911 op = DW_OP_abs;
17912 goto do_unop;
17914 case NEGATE_EXPR:
17915 op = DW_OP_neg;
17916 goto do_unop;
17918 do_unop:
17919 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17920 if (list_ret == 0)
17921 return 0;
17923 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
17924 break;
17926 case MIN_EXPR:
17927 case MAX_EXPR:
17929 const enum tree_code code =
17930 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
17932 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
17933 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
17934 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
17935 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
17938 /* fall through */
17940 case COND_EXPR:
17942 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
17943 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
17944 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
17945 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
17946 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
17948 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
17949 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
17950 return 0;
17952 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
17953 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
17955 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
17956 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
17957 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
17959 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
17960 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
17961 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
17963 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
17964 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
17965 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
17966 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
17967 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
17969 break;
17971 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
17972 return 0;
17974 default:
17975 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
17976 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
17977 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
17978 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
17980 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17981 "language specific tree node");
17982 return 0;
17985 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
17986 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
17987 if (flag_checking)
17988 gcc_unreachable ();
17990 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
17991 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
17992 return NULL;
17995 if (!ret && !list_ret)
17996 return 0;
17998 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
17999 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
18001 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18003 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18004 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18005 return 0;
18007 if (ret)
18008 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18009 else
18010 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18011 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18012 have_address = 1;
18014 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
18015 if (want_address && !have_address)
18017 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18018 "Want address and only have value");
18019 return 0;
18022 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
18024 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
18025 if (!want_address && have_address)
18027 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
18029 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
18031 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18032 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18033 return 0;
18035 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18036 op = DW_OP_deref;
18037 else
18038 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
18040 if (ret)
18041 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18042 else
18043 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18045 if (ret)
18046 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
18048 return list_ret;
18051 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
18052 expressions. */
18054 static dw_loc_list_ref
18055 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18056 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18058 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
18060 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
18061 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
18062 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
18063 return result;
18066 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
18067 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18068 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18069 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18071 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
18072 if (!ret)
18073 return NULL;
18074 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
18076 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18077 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
18078 return NULL;
18080 return ret->expr;
18083 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
18084 which is not less than the value itself. */
18086 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
18087 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
18089 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
18092 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
18093 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
18094 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
18095 ERROR_MARK node. */
18097 static inline tree
18098 field_type (const_tree decl)
18100 tree type;
18102 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18103 return integer_type_node;
18105 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18106 if (type == NULL_TREE)
18107 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18109 return type;
18112 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
18113 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
18114 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
18116 static inline unsigned
18117 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
18119 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18122 static inline unsigned
18123 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
18125 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18128 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
18130 static inline offset_int
18131 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
18133 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
18136 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
18137 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
18138 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
18139 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
18141 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18142 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
18144 tree tree_size;
18145 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
18147 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
18148 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18149 if (*cst_size != -1)
18150 return NULL;
18152 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
18153 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
18154 ctx.dpi = NULL;
18155 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
18156 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
18158 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
18159 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
18160 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
18161 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
18162 : NULL);
18165 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
18166 struct vlr_context
18168 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
18169 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
18170 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
18171 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
18172 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
18173 tree struct_type;
18174 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
18175 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
18176 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
18177 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
18178 tree variant_part_offset;
18181 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
18182 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
18183 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
18184 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
18186 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
18187 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
18188 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
18190 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18192 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18193 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
18194 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
18196 tree tree_result;
18197 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
18199 *cst_offset = 0;
18201 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18202 return NULL;
18203 else
18204 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18206 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
18207 case. */
18208 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
18209 return NULL;
18211 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18212 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
18213 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
18214 matter. */
18215 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
18216 && TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) == INTEGER_CST)
18218 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
18219 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
18220 offset_int bitpos_int;
18221 tree type;
18222 tree field_size_tree;
18223 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
18224 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
18225 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
18226 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
18227 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
18229 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
18230 type = field_type (decl);
18231 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
18232 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
18234 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
18236 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
18237 a flexible array member. */
18238 if (!field_size_tree)
18239 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
18241 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
18242 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
18243 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
18244 else
18245 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
18247 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
18249 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
18250 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
18251 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
18252 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
18253 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
18254 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
18255 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
18256 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
18257 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
18259 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
18261 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
18262 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
18263 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
18264 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
18265 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
18266 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
18267 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
18268 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
18269 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
18270 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
18271 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
18273 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
18274 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
18275 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
18276 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
18277 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
18278 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
18279 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
18280 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
18281 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
18282 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
18283 structure type.)
18285 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
18286 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
18287 must have believed that the containing object started (within
18288 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
18289 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
18290 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
18291 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
18293 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
18294 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
18295 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
18297 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
18298 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
18299 be. */
18300 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18302 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
18303 bitfields. */
18304 object_offset_in_bits
18305 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
18307 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
18309 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
18311 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
18312 object_offset_in_bits
18313 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
18316 object_offset_in_bytes
18317 = wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
18318 if (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE)
18320 *cst_offset = object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
18321 return NULL;
18323 tree_result = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, object_offset_in_bytes);
18325 else
18326 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
18327 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
18329 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
18330 tree_result = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
18331 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result);
18333 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
18334 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
18335 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
18337 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
18338 return NULL;
18340 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
18341 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
18342 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
18343 NULL, /* dpi */
18344 false, /* placeholder_arg */
18345 false /* placeholder_seen */
18347 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
18349 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
18350 multiple elements. */
18351 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
18352 return NULL;
18353 else
18354 return loc_result->expr;
18357 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
18358 associated with them. */
18360 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
18362 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
18363 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
18364 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
18366 static inline void
18367 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
18368 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
18370 if (descr == 0)
18371 return;
18372 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
18373 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
18374 else
18375 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
18378 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
18380 static void
18381 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18383 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
18384 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
18385 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
18386 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18387 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18388 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18390 if (dwarf_version == 2
18391 || die->die_parent == NULL
18392 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
18393 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18395 else if (dwarf_version > 2
18396 && die->die_parent
18397 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
18398 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18401 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
18402 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
18403 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
18404 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
18405 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
18406 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
18407 function above).
18409 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18410 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18411 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18412 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
18413 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
18414 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
18415 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
18416 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
18417 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
18418 function below.)
18420 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
18422 static void
18423 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
18424 tree decl,
18425 struct vlr_context *ctx)
18427 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
18428 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
18430 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
18432 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
18433 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
18435 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
18436 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
18437 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
18438 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
18440 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
18442 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
18444 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
18446 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
18447 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
18448 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18450 /* Extract the vtable address. */
18451 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18452 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18454 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
18455 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
18456 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
18458 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
18459 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18460 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
18461 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18463 /* Extract the offset. */
18464 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
18465 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18467 /* Add it to the object address. */
18468 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
18469 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
18471 else
18472 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
18474 else
18476 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
18478 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
18479 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
18480 moment. */
18481 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
18483 loc_descr = NULL;
18484 offset = 0;
18487 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
18488 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
18489 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
18490 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
18493 if (! loc_descr)
18495 /* While DW_AT_data_bit_offset has been added already in DWARF4,
18496 e.g. GDB only added support to it in November 2016. For DWARF5
18497 we need newer debug info consumers anyway. We might change this
18498 to dwarf_version >= 4 once most consumers catched up. */
18499 if (dwarf_version >= 5
18500 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18501 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
18503 tree off = bit_position (decl);
18504 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (off) && get_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_size))
18506 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_byte_size);
18507 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_offset);
18508 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_bit_offset, tree_to_uhwi (off));
18509 return;
18512 if (dwarf_version > 2)
18514 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
18515 if (offset < 0)
18516 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18517 else
18518 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
18519 return;
18521 else
18523 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18525 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
18526 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
18527 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
18528 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
18529 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
18533 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
18536 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
18538 static void
18539 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
18541 while (size != 0)
18543 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
18544 val >>= 8;
18545 --size;
18549 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
18551 static HOST_WIDE_INT
18552 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
18554 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
18556 src += size;
18557 while (size != 0)
18559 val <<= 8;
18560 val |= *--src & 0xff;
18561 --size;
18563 return val;
18566 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
18568 static void
18569 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
18571 int i;
18573 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
18575 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
18576 return;
18579 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
18580 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
18582 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
18584 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
18585 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
18587 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18588 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18590 else
18591 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
18593 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
18594 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
18598 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
18600 static void
18601 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
18603 long val[4];
18604 int i;
18605 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18607 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), mode);
18609 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
18610 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4; i++)
18612 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
18613 array += 4;
18617 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
18618 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
18619 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
18620 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
18621 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
18623 static bool
18624 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
18626 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
18628 case CONST_INT:
18630 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
18632 if (val < 0)
18633 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
18634 else
18635 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
18637 return true;
18639 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
18641 wide_int w1 = rtx_mode_t (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
18642 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
18643 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
18644 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
18645 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
18647 return true;
18649 case CONST_DOUBLE:
18650 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
18651 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
18652 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
18653 represented. */
18654 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
18655 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (rtl)))
18656 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
18657 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
18658 else
18660 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
18661 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
18662 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
18664 insert_float (rtl, array);
18665 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
18667 return true;
18669 case CONST_VECTOR:
18671 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
18672 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
18673 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
18674 unsigned char *array
18675 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
18676 unsigned int i;
18677 unsigned char *p;
18678 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
18680 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
18682 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
18683 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18685 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18686 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
18688 break;
18690 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
18691 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
18693 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
18694 insert_float (elt, p);
18696 break;
18698 default:
18699 gcc_unreachable ();
18702 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
18704 return true;
18706 case CONST_STRING:
18707 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18709 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
18710 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
18711 rtl_addr:
18712 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
18713 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18714 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
18715 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
18716 return true;
18718 return false;
18720 case CONST:
18721 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
18722 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
18723 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18724 case SYMBOL_REF:
18725 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
18726 return false;
18727 /* FALLTHROUGH */
18728 case LABEL_REF:
18729 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18730 goto rtl_addr;
18731 return false;
18733 case PLUS:
18734 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
18735 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
18736 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
18737 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
18738 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
18739 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
18740 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
18741 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
18742 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
18743 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
18744 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
18745 return false;
18747 case HIGH:
18748 case CONST_FIXED:
18749 return false;
18751 case MEM:
18752 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
18753 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
18754 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
18756 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
18757 return true;
18759 return false;
18761 default:
18762 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
18763 gcc_unreachable ();
18765 return false;
18768 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
18769 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
18770 output). */
18771 static tree
18772 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
18773 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18775 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
18776 *walk_subtrees = 0;
18778 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
18779 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18780 return *tp;
18781 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
18782 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
18783 be conservative. */
18784 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (*tp))
18785 return *tp;
18786 else if (VAR_P (*tp))
18788 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
18789 if (!node || !node->definition)
18790 return *tp;
18792 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
18793 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
18795 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
18796 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
18797 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
18798 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
18799 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
18800 return *tp;
18802 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
18803 return *tp;
18805 return NULL_TREE;
18808 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
18809 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
18811 static rtx
18812 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
18814 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
18816 STRIP_NOPS (init);
18818 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
18819 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
18820 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18822 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
18823 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18824 scalar_int_mode mode;
18826 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
18827 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
18828 && domain
18829 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
18830 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
18831 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
18832 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
18833 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
18835 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
18836 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
18837 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
18838 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
18841 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
18842 CONCAT: FIXME! */
18843 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
18844 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
18845 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
18846 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
18848 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
18849 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
18850 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
18851 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
18853 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
18854 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
18855 reference variables which won't be output. */
18856 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
18857 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
18859 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
18860 possible. */
18861 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
18862 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
18864 case VECTOR_CST:
18865 break;
18866 case CONSTRUCTOR:
18867 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
18869 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
18870 bool constant_p = true;
18871 tree value;
18872 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
18874 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
18875 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
18876 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
18877 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
18878 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
18880 constant_p = false;
18881 break;
18884 if (constant_p)
18886 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
18887 break;
18890 /* FALLTHRU */
18892 default:
18893 return NULL;
18896 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
18898 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
18899 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
18902 return rtl;
18905 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
18907 static rtx
18908 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
18910 rtx rtl;
18912 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
18913 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
18914 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
18916 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
18917 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
18918 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
18919 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
18920 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
18921 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
18922 referenced within the function.
18924 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
18925 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
18926 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
18927 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
18929 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
18930 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
18931 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
18932 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
18933 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
18934 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
18936 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
18937 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
18938 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
18939 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
18940 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
18941 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
18942 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
18943 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
18944 output at debug-time.
18946 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
18947 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
18948 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
18949 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
18950 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
18951 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
18952 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
18953 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
18954 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
18955 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
18956 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
18957 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
18958 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
18960 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
18961 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
18962 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
18963 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
18964 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
18965 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
18966 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
18967 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
18968 I'd like to fix it.
18970 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
18971 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
18972 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
18973 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
18974 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
18975 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
18976 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
18977 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
18978 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
18979 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
18980 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
18982 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
18983 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
18985 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
18986 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
18987 fixed registers. */
18988 if (! reload_completed)
18990 if (rtl
18991 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
18992 || (MEM_P (rtl)
18993 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
18994 || (REG_P (rtl)
18995 && VAR_P (decl)
18996 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
18998 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
18999 return rtl;
19001 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19003 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
19005 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19006 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
19007 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19008 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19009 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
19010 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19011 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
19013 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19014 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
19015 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
19016 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
19018 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
19019 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
19020 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
19021 if (dmode == pmode)
19022 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19023 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
19024 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
19025 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19026 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19028 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19029 if (REG_P (inc))
19030 rtl = inc;
19031 else if (MEM_P (inc))
19033 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19034 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
19035 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19036 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
19037 else
19038 rtl = inc;
19043 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
19044 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
19045 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
19046 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
19047 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
19048 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
19049 thing to do. */
19050 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
19051 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
19052 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19053 /* Not passed in memory. */
19054 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19055 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
19056 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19057 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
19058 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
19059 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
19060 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
19061 #endif
19063 /* Big endian correction check. */
19064 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
19065 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
19066 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19067 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
19069 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19070 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
19071 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
19073 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19074 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19077 else if (VAR_P (decl)
19078 && rtl
19079 && MEM_P (rtl)
19080 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
19081 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19083 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19084 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
19085 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
19087 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
19088 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
19089 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
19090 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
19091 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
19092 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
19093 if (rsize > dsize)
19094 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19095 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
19096 rsize - dsize));
19099 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
19100 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
19101 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
19102 if (!rtl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19103 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
19105 if (rtl)
19106 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19108 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
19109 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
19110 code, and thus is not emitted. */
19111 if (rtl)
19112 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
19114 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
19115 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
19116 it. */
19117 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19118 && VAR_P (decl)
19119 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
19120 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
19121 && DECL_NAME (decl)
19122 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
19123 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
19125 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
19126 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
19127 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
19128 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
19129 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19132 return rtl;
19135 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
19136 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
19137 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
19139 static tree
19140 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
19142 tree val_expr, cvar;
19143 machine_mode mode;
19144 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
19145 tree offset;
19146 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
19148 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
19149 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
19150 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
19151 be handled as such. */
19152 if (!VAR_P (decl)
19153 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
19154 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
19155 || !is_fortran ())
19156 return NULL_TREE;
19158 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
19159 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
19160 return NULL_TREE;
19162 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
19163 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
19165 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
19166 || !VAR_P (cvar)
19167 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
19168 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
19169 return NULL_TREE;
19171 *value = 0;
19172 if (offset != NULL)
19174 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
19175 return NULL_TREE;
19176 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
19178 if (bitpos != 0)
19179 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
19181 return cvar;
19184 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
19185 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
19186 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
19187 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
19188 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
19189 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
19190 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
19191 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
19192 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
19193 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
19195 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
19196 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
19197 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
19198 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
19200 static bool
19201 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
19203 rtx rtl;
19204 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19205 var_loc_list *loc_list;
19206 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
19208 if (early_dwarf)
19209 return false;
19211 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19212 return false;
19214 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
19215 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
19216 return true;
19218 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
19219 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
19221 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
19222 the location. */
19224 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
19225 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19226 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19227 return true;
19229 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
19230 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
19231 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
19232 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
19233 if (loc_list
19234 && loc_list->first
19235 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
19236 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
19237 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
19238 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
19240 struct var_loc_node *node;
19242 node = loc_list->first;
19243 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
19244 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
19245 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
19246 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
19247 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
19248 return true;
19250 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
19251 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
19252 list = NULL;
19253 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
19254 cache_p = false;
19255 if (cache_p)
19257 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
19258 if (cache)
19259 list = cache->loc_list;
19261 if (list == NULL)
19263 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
19264 NULL);
19265 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
19266 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
19267 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
19269 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
19270 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
19271 DECL_UID (decl),
19272 INSERT);
19273 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
19274 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
19275 cache->loc_list = list;
19276 *slot = cache;
19279 if (list)
19281 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
19282 return true;
19284 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
19285 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
19286 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
19289 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
19290 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
19292 static bool
19293 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
19295 tree type;
19297 if (init == NULL_TREE)
19298 return false;
19300 STRIP_NOPS (init);
19301 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19303 case STRING_CST:
19304 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19305 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19307 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
19308 scalar_int_mode mode;
19310 if (!is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
19311 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
19312 return false;
19313 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19314 return false;
19315 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
19317 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
19318 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19319 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
19320 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
19322 else
19323 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
19324 return true;
19326 return false;
19327 case CONSTRUCTOR:
19328 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
19329 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19330 return false;
19331 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19333 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
19334 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19335 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
19336 constructor_elt *ce;
19338 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
19339 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19340 return false;
19342 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
19343 if (fieldsize <= 0)
19344 return false;
19346 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
19347 memset (array, '\0', size);
19348 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19350 tree val = ce->value;
19351 tree index = ce->index;
19352 int pos = curpos;
19353 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19354 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
19355 * fieldsize;
19356 else if (index)
19357 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
19359 if (val)
19361 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19362 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19363 return false;
19365 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
19366 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
19368 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
19369 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
19370 while (count-- > 0)
19372 if (val)
19373 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
19374 curpos += fieldsize;
19377 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
19379 return true;
19381 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
19382 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
19384 tree field = NULL_TREE;
19385 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
19386 constructor_elt *ce;
19388 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
19389 return false;
19391 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
19392 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
19394 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
19396 tree val = ce->value;
19397 int pos, fieldsize;
19399 if (ce->index != 0)
19400 field = ce->index;
19402 if (val)
19403 STRIP_NOPS (val);
19405 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
19406 return false;
19408 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19409 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
19410 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
19411 return false;
19412 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
19413 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
19414 return false;
19415 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
19416 pos = int_byte_position (field);
19417 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
19418 if (val && fieldsize != 0
19419 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
19420 return false;
19422 return true;
19424 return false;
19425 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19426 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
19427 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
19428 default:
19429 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
19433 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
19434 attribute is the const value T. */
19436 static bool
19437 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
19439 tree init;
19440 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
19441 rtx rtl;
19443 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
19444 return false;
19446 init = t;
19447 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
19449 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST)
19451 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (init))
19453 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_uhwi (init));
19454 return true;
19456 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (init))
19458 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_shwi (init));
19459 return true;
19462 if (! early_dwarf)
19464 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
19465 if (rtl)
19466 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
19468 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
19469 if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
19470 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
19472 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
19473 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
19475 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
19477 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
19479 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
19480 return true;
19482 ggc_free (array);
19485 return false;
19488 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
19489 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
19490 variable with static storage duration
19491 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
19493 static bool
19494 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
19497 if (!decl
19498 || (!VAR_P (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
19499 || (VAR_P (decl) && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
19500 return false;
19502 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
19503 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
19504 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19505 /* OK */;
19506 else
19507 return false;
19509 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
19510 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
19511 return false;
19513 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
19516 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
19517 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
19518 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
19519 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
19520 expressions. */
19522 static dw_loc_list_ref
19523 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
19525 int ix;
19526 dw_fde_ref fde;
19527 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
19528 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
19529 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
19530 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
19531 dw_cfa_location remember;
19533 fde = cfun->fde;
19534 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
19536 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
19537 list_tail = &list;
19538 list = NULL;
19540 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
19541 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
19542 remember = next_cfa;
19544 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
19546 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
19547 advance opcodes. */
19548 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
19549 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19551 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19552 last_label = start_label;
19554 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
19556 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
19557 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
19558 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19559 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19560 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19561 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19564 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
19566 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
19568 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
19569 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
19570 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
19571 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
19572 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19574 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19575 start_label, last_label, section);
19577 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19578 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19579 start_label = last_label;
19581 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
19582 break;
19584 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
19585 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
19586 gcc_unreachable ();
19588 default:
19589 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
19590 break;
19592 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
19594 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19596 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19597 start_label, last_label, section);
19599 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19600 last_cfa = next_cfa;
19601 start_label = last_label;
19603 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19604 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
19605 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19606 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
19610 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
19612 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
19613 start_label, last_label, section);
19614 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
19615 start_label = last_label;
19618 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
19619 start_label,
19620 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
19621 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
19622 section);
19624 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
19625 gen_llsym (list);
19627 return list;
19630 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
19631 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
19632 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
19633 before the latter is negated. */
19635 static void
19636 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
19638 rtx reg, elim;
19640 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
19641 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
19642 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19643 #else
19644 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
19645 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
19646 #endif
19648 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
19649 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
19650 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
19651 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
19653 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
19654 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
19657 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
19659 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
19660 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
19661 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
19662 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
19663 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
19664 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
19665 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
19666 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19667 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
19668 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
19669 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
19670 : stack_pointer_rtx));
19673 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
19674 the value of the attribute. */
19676 static void
19677 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
19679 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
19681 if (demangle_name_func)
19682 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
19684 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
19688 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
19689 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
19690 of TYPE accordingly.
19692 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
19693 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
19695 static void
19696 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
19697 dw_die_ref context_die)
19699 tree dtype;
19700 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
19702 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
19703 return;
19705 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
19706 if (!dtype)
19707 return;
19709 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19710 if (!dtype_die)
19712 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
19713 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
19714 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
19717 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
19720 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
19722 static const char *
19723 comp_dir_string (void)
19725 const char *wd;
19726 char *wd1;
19727 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
19729 if (cached_wd != NULL)
19730 return cached_wd;
19732 wd = get_src_pwd ();
19733 if (wd == NULL)
19734 return NULL;
19736 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
19738 int wdlen;
19740 wdlen = strlen (wd);
19741 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
19742 strcpy (wd1, wd);
19743 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
19744 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
19745 wd = wd1;
19748 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
19749 return cached_wd;
19752 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
19754 static void
19755 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
19757 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
19758 if (wd != NULL)
19759 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
19762 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
19763 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
19764 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
19765 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
19767 static void
19768 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
19769 int forms, struct loc_descr_context *context)
19771 dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
19772 dw_loc_list_ref list;
19773 bool strip_conversions = true;
19774 bool placeholder_seen = false;
19776 while (strip_conversions)
19777 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
19779 case ERROR_MARK:
19780 case SAVE_EXPR:
19781 return;
19783 CASE_CONVERT:
19784 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19785 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
19786 break;
19788 default:
19789 strip_conversions = false;
19790 break;
19793 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
19794 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
19795 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
19797 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
19799 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
19800 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
19801 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
19802 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
19803 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
19804 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
19805 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
19806 for signed types. This is needed only for
19807 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
19808 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
19809 regardless of the underlying type. */
19810 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
19811 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
19813 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
19814 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19815 else
19816 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
19818 else
19819 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
19820 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
19821 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
19822 unambiguously. */
19823 add_AT_wide (die, attr, value);
19824 return;
19827 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
19828 another DIE. */
19829 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
19831 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
19833 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
19834 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
19835 Ada). */
19836 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
19837 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
19838 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
19839 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
19841 else if (VAR_P (value)
19842 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
19843 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
19844 decl = value;
19846 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
19848 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19850 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
19851 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
19852 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
19853 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
19854 later parameter. */
19855 if (decl_die != NULL)
19857 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
19858 return;
19863 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
19864 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
19865 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
19866 return;
19868 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
19869 if (context && context->placeholder_arg)
19871 placeholder_seen = context->placeholder_seen;
19872 context->placeholder_seen = false;
19874 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
19876 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
19877 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
19878 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
19879 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
19880 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
19882 if (placeholder_seen)
19884 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
19885 dpi.fndecl = NULL_TREE;
19886 dpi.args_count = 1;
19887 if (!resolve_args_picking (list2->expr, 1, &dpi))
19888 return;
19890 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
19891 return;
19895 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
19896 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
19897 if (list == NULL
19898 || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0
19899 || placeholder_seen)
19900 return;
19902 if (current_function_decl == 0)
19903 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
19904 else
19905 context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
19907 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
19908 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19909 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
19910 context_die);
19911 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
19912 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
19915 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
19916 default. */
19918 static int
19919 lower_bound_default (void)
19921 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
19923 case DW_LANG_C:
19924 case DW_LANG_C89:
19925 case DW_LANG_C99:
19926 case DW_LANG_C11:
19927 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
19928 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
19929 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
19930 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
19931 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
19932 return 0;
19933 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
19934 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
19935 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
19936 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
19937 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
19938 return 1;
19939 case DW_LANG_UPC:
19940 case DW_LANG_D:
19941 case DW_LANG_Python:
19942 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
19943 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
19944 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
19945 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
19946 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
19947 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
19948 case DW_LANG_PLI:
19949 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
19950 default:
19951 return -1;
19955 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
19956 a representation for that bound. */
19958 static void
19959 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
19960 tree bound, struct loc_descr_context *context)
19962 int dflt;
19964 while (1)
19965 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
19967 /* Strip all conversions. */
19968 CASE_CONVERT:
19969 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
19970 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
19971 break;
19973 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
19974 are even omitted when they are the default. */
19975 case INTEGER_CST:
19976 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
19977 attribute. */
19978 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
19979 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
19980 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
19981 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
19982 return;
19984 /* FALLTHRU */
19986 default:
19987 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
19988 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
19989 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
19990 magic in such a case. */
19991 if (is_ada ()
19992 && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
19993 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
19994 return;
19996 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
19997 dw_scalar_form_constant
19998 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19999 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
20000 context);
20001 return;
20005 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
20006 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
20007 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
20008 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
20010 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
20011 available. */
20013 static void
20014 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
20016 unsigned dimension_number;
20017 tree lower, upper;
20018 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
20020 for (dimension_number = 0;
20021 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
20022 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
20024 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
20026 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
20027 break;
20029 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
20030 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
20031 here. */
20033 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
20034 available.
20036 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
20037 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
20038 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
20039 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
20040 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
20041 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
20042 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
20043 array. */
20044 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
20045 if (child)
20046 while (1)
20048 child = child->die_sib;
20049 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20050 subrange_die = child;
20051 if (child == type_die->die_child)
20053 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
20054 child = NULL;
20055 break;
20057 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20058 break;
20060 if (!subrange_die)
20061 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
20063 if (domain)
20065 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
20066 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
20067 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
20069 /* Define the index type. */
20070 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
20071 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
20073 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
20074 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
20075 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
20076 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
20077 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
20078 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
20079 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
20081 else
20082 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
20083 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
20086 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
20087 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
20088 dimension arr(N:*)
20089 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
20090 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
20091 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
20093 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
20094 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
20095 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
20096 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
20099 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
20100 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
20101 bounds. */
20105 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
20107 static void
20108 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20110 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20111 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20112 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
20114 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
20116 case ERROR_MARK:
20117 size = 0;
20118 break;
20119 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20120 case RECORD_TYPE:
20121 case UNION_TYPE:
20122 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20123 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
20124 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
20126 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
20127 return;
20129 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
20130 break;
20131 case FIELD_DECL:
20132 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
20133 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
20134 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
20135 even for bit-fields. */
20136 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
20137 break;
20138 default:
20139 gcc_unreachable ();
20142 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
20143 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
20144 though. */
20145 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20146 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20147 && size_expr != NULL)
20148 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
20150 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
20151 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
20152 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
20153 if (size >= 0)
20154 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20157 /* Add a DW_AT_alignment attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's non-default
20158 alignment. */
20160 static void
20161 add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20163 if (dwarf_version < 5 && dwarf_strict)
20164 return;
20166 unsigned align;
20168 if (DECL_P (tree_node))
20170 if (!DECL_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20171 return;
20173 align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20175 else if (TYPE_P (tree_node))
20177 if (!TYPE_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20178 return;
20180 align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20182 else
20183 gcc_unreachable ();
20185 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_alignment, align);
20188 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
20189 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
20190 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
20191 bit-field itself.
20193 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
20194 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
20195 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
20196 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
20197 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
20198 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
20200 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
20202 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
20203 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
20204 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
20206 static inline void
20207 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
20209 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
20210 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
20211 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
20212 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
20213 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
20214 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
20216 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
20218 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20219 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
20221 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
20222 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
20223 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
20224 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
20225 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20226 return;
20228 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
20230 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
20231 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
20232 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
20233 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
20234 below must take account of these differences. */
20235 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
20236 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
20238 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
20240 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
20241 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
20242 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
20245 bit_offset
20246 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
20247 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
20248 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
20250 if (bit_offset < 0)
20251 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
20252 else
20253 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
20256 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
20257 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
20259 static inline void
20260 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20262 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
20263 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
20264 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
20266 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
20267 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
20270 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
20271 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
20273 static inline void
20274 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
20276 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20278 case DW_LANG_C:
20279 case DW_LANG_C89:
20280 case DW_LANG_C99:
20281 case DW_LANG_C11:
20282 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20283 if (prototype_p (func_type))
20284 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
20285 break;
20286 default:
20287 break;
20291 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
20292 by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
20293 the block mapping. */
20295 static inline dw_die_ref
20296 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
20298 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
20300 if (DECL_P (origin))
20302 dw_die_ref c;
20303 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
20304 /* "Unwrap" the decls DIE which we put in the imported unit context.
20305 We are looking for the abstract copy here. */
20306 if (in_lto_p
20307 && origin_die
20308 && (c = get_AT_ref (origin_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
20309 /* ??? Identify this better. */
20310 && c->with_offset)
20311 origin_die = c;
20313 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
20314 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
20315 else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
20316 origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
20318 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
20319 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
20320 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
20321 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
20322 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
20323 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
20324 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
20325 here. */
20327 if (origin_die)
20328 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
20329 return origin_die;
20332 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
20334 static inline void
20335 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
20337 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
20339 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
20341 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
20342 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
20343 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
20344 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
20345 0));
20347 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
20348 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
20349 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
20350 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
20351 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
20355 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
20356 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
20357 standardized it. */
20359 static void
20360 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20362 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
20364 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
20365 if (name[0] == '*')
20366 name = &name[1];
20368 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
20369 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
20370 else
20371 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
20374 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
20376 static void
20377 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20379 expanded_location s;
20381 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
20382 return;
20383 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20384 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
20385 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20386 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
20387 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
20390 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
20392 static void
20393 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20395 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
20396 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
20398 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
20400 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
20401 asm_name->die = die;
20402 asm_name->created_for = decl;
20403 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
20404 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
20406 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
20407 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
20410 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired. */
20412 static void
20413 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
20415 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
20416 && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
20417 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
20418 && !(VAR_P (decl) && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
20419 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
20420 add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
20423 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
20424 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
20426 static void
20427 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
20428 bool no_linkage_name)
20430 tree decl_name;
20432 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20433 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20435 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20436 if (name)
20437 add_name_attribute (die, name);
20438 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20439 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
20441 if (!no_linkage_name)
20442 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
20445 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20446 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20447 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20448 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
20450 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
20451 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
20452 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
20454 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20457 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
20459 static void
20460 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
20462 dw_attr_node attr;
20464 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
20465 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
20466 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20467 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
20468 if (value->pos)
20469 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
20470 else
20471 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
20472 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20475 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
20477 static void
20478 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
20480 dw_attr_node attr;
20482 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
20483 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
20484 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
20485 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
20486 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
20489 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
20490 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
20492 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
20495 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20496 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
20498 void
20499 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
20501 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20502 dw_die_ref die;
20504 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
20505 die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
20506 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
20507 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
20508 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
20509 current_function_funcdef_no);
20510 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
20512 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
20513 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
20514 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
20516 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
20517 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
20519 else
20521 die->die_sib = die;
20522 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
20525 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
20527 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
20529 static void
20530 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
20532 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
20535 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
20537 static inline void
20538 pop_decl_scope (void)
20540 decl_scope_table->pop ();
20543 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
20545 static tree
20546 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20548 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
20549 *walk_subtrees = 0;
20550 else
20552 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
20553 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
20554 return *tp;
20556 return NULL_TREE;
20559 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
20560 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
20562 static tree
20563 uses_local_type (tree type)
20565 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
20566 return used;
20569 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
20570 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
20571 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
20572 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
20573 the current active scope. */
20575 static dw_die_ref
20576 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
20578 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
20579 tree containing_scope;
20581 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
20582 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
20584 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
20585 it refers to. */
20586 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
20587 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
20588 else
20589 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
20591 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
20592 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20594 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
20595 /* OK */;
20596 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20597 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20598 else
20599 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20602 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
20603 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
20604 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
20605 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
20606 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
20608 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
20610 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
20611 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
20612 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
20613 scope_die = context_die;
20614 else
20615 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20617 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
20619 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
20620 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20621 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
20622 else
20624 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
20625 if (scope_die == NULL)
20626 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
20629 else
20630 scope_die = context_die;
20632 return scope_die;
20635 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
20637 static inline int
20638 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20640 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
20641 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
20642 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
20643 return 1;
20645 return 0;
20648 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
20650 static inline int
20651 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20653 return (context_die
20654 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
20655 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
20656 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
20657 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
20660 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
20661 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
20663 static inline int
20664 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
20666 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
20667 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
20670 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
20671 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
20672 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
20673 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
20675 static void
20676 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
20677 bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
20679 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
20680 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
20682 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
20683 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
20684 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
20685 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
20686 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
20687 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
20688 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
20690 if (code == ERROR_MARK
20691 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
20692 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
20693 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
20694 || code == VOID_TYPE)
20695 return;
20697 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
20698 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
20699 reverse,
20700 context_die);
20702 if (type_die != NULL)
20703 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
20706 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
20707 function call type. */
20708 static void
20709 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
20711 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
20713 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
20714 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
20716 if (is_fortran ()
20717 && id_equal (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl), "MAIN__"))
20719 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
20720 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
20721 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
20722 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
20723 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
20724 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
20725 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
20726 value = DW_CC_program;
20728 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
20729 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
20732 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
20733 is not DW_CC_normal. */
20734 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
20735 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
20738 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
20739 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
20740 was declared without a tag. */
20742 static const char *
20743 type_tag (const_tree type)
20745 const char *name = 0;
20747 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
20749 tree t = 0;
20751 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
20752 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
20753 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
20754 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
20756 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
20757 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
20758 involved. */
20759 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
20760 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20762 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
20763 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
20764 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
20765 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
20766 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
20767 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20768 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
20771 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
20772 if (!name && t != 0)
20773 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
20776 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
20779 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
20780 for bit field types. */
20782 static inline tree
20783 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
20785 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
20786 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
20789 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
20790 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
20792 #if 0
20793 static const char *
20794 decl_start_label (tree decl)
20796 rtx x;
20797 const char *fnname;
20799 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
20800 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
20802 x = XEXP (x, 0);
20803 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
20805 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
20806 return fnname;
20808 #endif
20810 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
20811 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
20812 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
20813 static bool
20814 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
20816 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
20817 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20818 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
20820 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20821 if (!array_die)
20822 return false;
20823 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
20824 return true;
20826 return false;
20829 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
20830 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
20831 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
20833 static void
20834 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20836 dw_die_ref array_die;
20838 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
20839 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
20840 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
20841 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
20842 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
20843 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
20844 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
20845 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
20846 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
20848 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
20850 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
20851 return;
20853 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
20854 tree element_type;
20856 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
20857 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
20858 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
20859 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20860 && is_fortran ()
20861 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
20863 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20865 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
20866 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
20867 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
20868 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
20869 if (size >= 0)
20870 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20871 /* ??? We can't annotate types late, but for LTO we may not
20872 generate a location early either (gfortran.dg/save_6.f90). */
20873 else if (! (early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
20874 && TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
20875 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE)
20877 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
20878 tree rszdecl = szdecl;
20880 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
20881 if (!DECL_P (szdecl))
20883 if (TREE_CODE (szdecl) == INDIRECT_REF
20884 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0)))
20886 rszdecl = TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0);
20887 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (rszdecl))
20888 != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
20889 size = 0;
20891 else
20892 size = 0;
20894 if (size > 0)
20896 dw_loc_list_ref loc
20897 = loc_list_from_tree (rszdecl, szdecl == rszdecl ? 2 : 0,
20898 NULL);
20899 if (loc)
20901 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length,
20902 loc);
20903 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
20904 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, dwarf_version >= 5
20905 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
20906 : DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20910 return;
20913 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
20914 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
20915 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
20917 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
20918 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
20920 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
20921 if (is_fortran ()
20922 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20923 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
20924 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
20925 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
20927 #if 0
20928 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
20929 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
20930 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
20931 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
20932 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
20933 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
20934 for multidimensional arrays. */
20935 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
20936 #endif
20938 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
20940 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
20941 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
20942 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
20943 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
20944 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
20946 else
20947 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
20949 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
20950 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
20951 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
20952 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
20953 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20955 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
20956 break;
20957 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
20960 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
20961 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
20962 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
20963 context_die);
20965 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
20966 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
20967 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20969 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
20970 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
20972 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
20975 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
20976 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
20978 static void
20979 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
20980 dw_die_ref context_die)
20982 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
20983 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
20984 struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL,
20985 false, false };
20986 enum dwarf_tag subrange_tag = DW_TAG_subrange_type;
20987 int dim;
20989 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
20990 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
20992 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
20993 switch (info->ordering)
20995 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
20996 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
20997 break;
20998 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
20999 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21000 break;
21001 default:
21002 break;
21005 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21007 if (info->data_location)
21008 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
21009 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21010 if (info->associated)
21011 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
21012 dw_scalar_form_constant
21013 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21014 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21015 if (info->allocated)
21016 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
21017 dw_scalar_form_constant
21018 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21019 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21020 if (info->stride)
21022 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
21023 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
21024 const int forms
21025 = (info->stride_in_bits)
21026 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
21027 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
21028 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21029 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
21031 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
21034 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
21036 if (info->rank)
21038 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_rank, info->rank,
21039 dw_scalar_form_constant
21040 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21041 subrange_tag = DW_TAG_generic_subrange;
21042 context.placeholder_arg = true;
21046 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21048 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
21050 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (subrange_tag, array_die, NULL);
21052 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
21053 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
21054 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21055 false, context_die);
21056 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
21057 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
21058 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
21059 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
21060 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21061 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
21062 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
21063 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
21064 info->dimen[dim].stride,
21065 dw_scalar_form_constant
21066 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21067 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
21068 &context);
21071 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
21072 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21073 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21074 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21075 context_die);
21077 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21078 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21080 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21083 #if 0
21084 static void
21085 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21087 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21088 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
21090 if (origin != NULL)
21091 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
21092 else
21094 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21095 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
21096 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
21099 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21100 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21101 else
21102 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
21104 #endif
21106 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21107 emit full debugging info for them. */
21109 static void
21110 retry_incomplete_types (void)
21112 set_early_dwarf s;
21113 int i;
21115 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
21116 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21117 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
21118 vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
21121 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
21123 static enum dwarf_tag
21124 record_type_tag (tree type)
21126 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
21127 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21129 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
21131 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
21132 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21134 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
21135 return DW_TAG_class_type;
21137 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
21138 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21139 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
21140 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21142 default:
21143 gcc_unreachable ();
21147 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
21148 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
21149 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
21150 DIE. */
21152 static dw_die_ref
21153 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21155 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21157 if (type_die == NULL)
21159 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
21160 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21161 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21162 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
21163 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21165 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
21166 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
21167 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
21168 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21170 if (!dwarf_strict)
21171 add_AT_unsigned (type_die, DW_AT_encoding,
21172 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
21173 ? DW_ATE_unsigned
21174 : DW_ATE_signed);
21176 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
21177 return type_die;
21178 else
21179 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21181 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
21182 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
21183 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
21184 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
21186 tree link;
21188 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21189 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
21190 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
21191 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21193 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
21194 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21195 context_die);
21197 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
21199 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21200 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21203 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
21204 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
21205 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
21206 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
21208 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
21209 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21211 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
21212 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
21214 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
21215 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
21217 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
21218 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
21220 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
21221 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
21223 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
21224 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
21225 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
21226 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
21227 form that can represent negative values. */
21228 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
21229 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
21230 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
21231 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
21232 else
21233 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
21235 else
21236 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
21237 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
21238 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
21239 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, value);
21242 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
21243 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21244 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21246 else
21247 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21249 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
21251 return type_die;
21254 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
21255 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
21256 type.
21258 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
21259 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
21260 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
21261 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
21262 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
21263 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
21264 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
21265 argument type of some subprogram type.
21266 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
21267 are emitted. */
21269 static dw_die_ref
21270 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
21271 dw_die_ref context_die)
21273 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
21274 tree ultimate_origin;
21275 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
21277 if (DECL_P (node_or_origin))
21279 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
21281 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
21282 thing.
21283 ??? When in LTO the DIE parent is the "abstract" copy and the
21284 context_die is the specification "copy". But this whole block
21285 should eventually be no longer needed. */
21286 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die && !in_lto_p)
21288 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
21290 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
21291 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
21292 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21293 parm_die = NULL;
21295 else
21296 gcc_unreachable ();
21299 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
21301 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
21302 we would have added below. If any attributes are
21303 missing, fall through to add them. */
21304 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21305 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
21306 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
21307 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
21309 else
21311 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
21312 return parm_die;
21317 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
21318 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
21319 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21320 bool reusing_die;
21321 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
21322 reusing_die = true;
21323 else
21325 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
21326 reusing_die = false;
21329 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
21331 case tcc_declaration:
21332 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
21333 if (node || ultimate_origin)
21334 origin = ultimate_origin;
21336 if (reusing_die)
21337 goto add_location;
21339 if (origin != NULL)
21340 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
21341 else if (emit_name_p)
21342 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
21343 if (origin == NULL
21344 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
21345 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
21346 decl_function_context
21347 (node_or_origin))))
21349 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
21350 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
21351 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
21352 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21353 false, context_die);
21354 else
21355 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
21356 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
21357 false, context_die);
21359 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
21360 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21361 add_location:
21362 if (node && node != origin)
21363 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
21364 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
21365 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
21366 node == NULL);
21368 break;
21370 case tcc_type:
21371 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
21372 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
21373 context_die);
21374 break;
21376 default:
21377 gcc_unreachable ();
21380 return parm_die;
21383 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
21384 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
21385 parameter pack.
21387 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
21388 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
21389 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21390 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
21391 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
21392 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
21394 static dw_die_ref
21395 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
21396 tree pack_arg,
21397 dw_die_ref subr_die,
21398 tree *next_arg)
21400 tree arg;
21401 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
21403 gcc_assert (parm_pack
21404 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
21405 && subr_die);
21407 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
21408 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
21410 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21412 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
21413 parm_pack))
21414 break;
21415 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
21416 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
21417 parm_pack_die);
21419 if (next_arg)
21420 *next_arg = arg;
21421 return parm_pack_die;
21424 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
21425 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
21427 static void
21428 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21430 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
21433 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
21434 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
21435 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
21436 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
21438 static void
21439 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21441 tree link;
21442 tree formal_type = NULL;
21443 tree first_parm_type;
21444 tree arg;
21446 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21448 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
21449 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
21451 else
21452 arg = NULL_TREE;
21454 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21456 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
21457 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
21458 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
21460 dw_die_ref parm_die;
21462 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
21463 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
21464 break;
21466 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
21467 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
21469 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
21470 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
21471 context_die);
21472 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
21473 && link == first_parm_type)
21475 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21476 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21477 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
21479 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
21480 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21483 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
21484 if (arg)
21485 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
21488 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
21489 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
21490 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
21491 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
21493 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
21494 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
21495 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
21496 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
21497 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
21498 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
21501 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
21502 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
21503 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
21504 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
21505 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
21507 static void
21508 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
21510 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
21512 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
21513 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
21514 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
21515 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
21516 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
21518 dw_die_ref type_die;
21519 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
21521 push_decl_scope (type);
21522 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
21523 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21524 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
21525 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
21527 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
21528 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
21529 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
21530 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
21531 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
21533 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
21534 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
21535 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
21537 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
21538 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
21541 else
21542 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
21544 pop_decl_scope ();
21548 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
21549 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
21550 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
21552 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21553 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
21554 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
21555 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21556 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
21557 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
21558 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
21559 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
21560 values to point to themselves. */
21562 static void
21563 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
21565 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
21567 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
21570 tree local_decl;
21572 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
21573 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
21574 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
21575 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
21576 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
21577 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
21578 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
21579 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
21583 tree subblock;
21585 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
21586 subblock != NULL_TREE;
21587 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
21588 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
21593 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
21594 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
21595 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
21596 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
21597 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
21598 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
21599 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
21600 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
21601 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
21602 point to themselves. */
21604 static void
21605 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
21607 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
21609 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
21610 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21612 tree arg;
21614 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
21615 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
21616 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
21617 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
21618 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
21623 /* Mark the early DIE for DECL as the abstract instance. */
21625 static void
21626 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
21628 dw_die_ref old_die;
21630 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
21631 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
21633 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
21634 return;
21636 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21637 /* With early debug we always have an old DIE unless we are in LTO
21638 and the user did not compile but only link with debug. */
21639 if (in_lto_p && ! old_die)
21640 return;
21641 gcc_assert (old_die != NULL);
21642 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline)
21643 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21644 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
21645 return;
21647 /* Go ahead and put DW_AT_inline on the DIE. */
21648 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
21650 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21651 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
21652 else
21653 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
21655 else
21657 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
21658 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
21659 else
21660 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
21663 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
21664 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
21665 add_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21667 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
21670 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
21671 htab_traverse.
21673 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21674 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
21676 bool
21677 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
21679 dw_die_ref die;
21681 die = lookup_type_die (type);
21682 if (die != NULL)
21683 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21684 return true;
21687 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
21688 through htab_traverse.
21690 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
21691 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
21692 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
21695 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
21696 void *)
21698 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
21699 dw_die_ref die;
21701 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
21702 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
21703 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
21704 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
21705 if (die)
21707 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
21708 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
21709 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
21710 if (node && node->definition)
21712 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21713 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
21714 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
21715 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
21718 return 1;
21721 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
21723 static void
21724 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
21726 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
21727 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
21730 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
21732 static void
21733 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
21735 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
21736 types_used_by_vars_hash
21737 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
21740 /* Generate a DW_TAG_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
21741 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
21743 static dw_die_ref
21744 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
21745 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
21747 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
21748 tree block = ca_loc->block;
21750 while (block
21751 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
21752 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
21754 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
21755 if (stmt_die)
21756 break;
21757 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
21759 if (stmt_die == NULL)
21760 stmt_die = subr_die;
21761 die = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site), stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
21762 add_AT_lbl_id (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_return_pc), ca_loc->label);
21763 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
21764 add_AT_flag (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_tail_call), 1);
21765 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
21767 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
21768 if (tdie)
21769 add_AT_die_ref (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), tdie);
21770 else
21771 add_AT_addr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), ca_loc->symbol_ref,
21772 false);
21774 return die;
21777 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
21778 block-local). */
21780 static void
21781 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21783 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21784 dw_die_ref subr_die;
21785 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21787 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
21788 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
21790 namespace S
21792 void func() { ... }
21795 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
21796 late debug:
21798 Early debug
21799 -----------
21801 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
21802 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
21803 context is the namespace.
21805 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
21807 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
21808 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
21810 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
21811 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
21813 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
21814 -------------------------------------
21816 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
21817 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
21818 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
21819 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
21820 info is enough.
21822 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
21823 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
21824 it with the location information that should now be available.
21826 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
21827 are also called a multiple times:
21829 class Base
21831 public:
21832 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
21835 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
21837 Early debug
21838 -----------
21840 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
21841 member of the Base class. This is done via
21842 rest_of_type_compilation.
21844 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
21845 DW_AT_declaration.
21847 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
21848 while generating the abstract instance of the base
21849 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
21850 debug of reachable functions.
21852 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
21853 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
21854 in (1).
21856 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
21857 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
21858 (2).
21860 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
21861 -----------------------------------
21863 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
21864 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
21865 we will just annotate the location information now
21866 available.
21868 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
21869 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
21871 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
21872 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
21873 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
21874 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
21875 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
21876 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21877 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
21879 /* A concrete instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
21880 if (origin != NULL)
21882 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
21884 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
21885 inline function. */
21886 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
21887 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
21889 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21891 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
21892 cached version. */
21893 subr_die = old_die;
21895 else
21897 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
21898 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
21899 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
21900 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
21901 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
21902 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
21903 K::K". */
21904 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
21907 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
21908 much as possible. */
21909 else if (old_die)
21911 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
21912 additional information. */
21913 if (declaration)
21914 return;
21916 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
21917 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
21918 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
21919 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
21920 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
21922 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
21923 something we have already output. */
21924 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
21925 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
21926 return;
21928 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
21929 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
21930 Fall through and generate it. */
21933 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
21934 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
21935 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
21936 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
21937 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
21938 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
21939 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
21940 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21941 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
21942 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
21943 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
21944 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
21945 building libgfortran:
21947 module some_m
21948 contains
21949 logical function funky (FLAG)
21950 funky = .true.
21951 end function
21952 end module
21954 || (old_die->die_parent
21955 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
21956 || context_die == NULL)
21957 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
21958 /* The location attributes may be in the abstract origin
21959 which in the case of LTO might be not available to
21960 look at. */
21961 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
21962 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
21963 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
21964 == (unsigned) s.line)
21965 && (!debug_column_info
21966 || s.column == 0
21967 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
21968 == (unsigned) s.column)))))
21970 subr_die = old_die;
21972 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
21973 parameters so they can be augmented with location
21974 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
21975 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
21976 them further down. */
21977 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
21980 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
21981 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
21984 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
21985 declaration. */
21986 else
21988 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
21989 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
21990 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
21991 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
21992 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
21993 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
21994 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
21995 if (debug_column_info
21996 && s.column
21997 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
21998 != (unsigned) s.column))
21999 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22001 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
22002 emit the real type on the definition die. */
22003 if (is_cxx () && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22005 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
22006 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
22007 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22008 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22011 /* When we process the method declaration, we haven't seen
22012 the out-of-class defaulted definition yet, so we have to
22013 recheck now. */
22014 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || ! dwarf_strict)
22015 && !get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted))
22017 int defaulted
22018 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22019 DW_AT_defaulted);
22020 if (defaulted != -1)
22022 /* Other values must have been handled before. */
22023 gcc_assert (defaulted == DW_DEFAULTED_out_of_class);
22024 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22029 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
22030 else
22032 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22034 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22035 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22037 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
22038 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22039 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22041 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
22042 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22043 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22046 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22047 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22048 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22050 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
22051 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
22053 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22055 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22058 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
22059 DIE. */
22060 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
22061 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
22063 if (declaration)
22065 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22067 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22069 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
22070 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
22071 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22072 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22073 DW_AT_explicit) == 1)
22074 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
22076 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
22077 a DW_AT_deleted attribute. */
22078 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22079 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22080 DW_AT_deleted) == 1)
22081 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_deleted, 1);
22083 /* If this is a C++11 defaulted special function member then
22084 generate a DW_AT_defaulted attribute. */
22085 if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22087 int defaulted
22088 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22089 DW_AT_defaulted);
22090 if (defaulted != -1)
22091 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22094 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with & ref-qualifier
22095 then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22096 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22097 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22098 DW_AT_reference) == 1)
22099 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
22101 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with &&
22102 ref-qualifier then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22103 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22104 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22105 DW_AT_rvalue_reference)
22106 == 1)
22107 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
22110 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
22111 the DIE with it. */
22112 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
22114 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
22116 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
22118 if (!crtl->has_bb_partition)
22120 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22121 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
22123 /* We have already generated the labels. */
22124 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22125 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22127 else
22129 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
22130 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22131 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22132 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
22133 current_function_funcdef_no);
22134 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
22135 current_function_funcdef_no);
22136 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
22137 false);
22140 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
22141 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
22142 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
22143 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
22144 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
22145 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
22146 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
22147 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
22148 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
22149 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
22150 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
22151 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
22154 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
22155 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
22156 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
22158 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
22159 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
22160 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
22162 #endif
22165 else
22167 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
22168 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22170 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
22172 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22174 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
22175 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
22176 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
22177 alignment offset. */
22178 bool range_list_added = false;
22179 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22180 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
22181 false);
22182 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22183 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
22184 &range_list_added, false);
22185 if (range_list_added)
22186 add_ranges (NULL);
22188 else
22190 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
22191 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
22192 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
22193 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
22194 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
22195 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
22196 sections when given "b foo". */
22197 const char *name = NULL;
22198 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
22199 dw_die_ref seg_die;
22201 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
22202 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22203 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22205 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
22206 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
22207 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
22209 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22210 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22212 if (decl_name != NULL
22213 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
22215 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
22216 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22217 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
22219 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
22221 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
22222 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
22223 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22224 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22226 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
22227 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22228 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
22229 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
22230 if (want_pubnames ())
22231 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
22234 else
22235 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
22236 false);
22239 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
22241 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
22242 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
22243 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
22244 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
22245 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
22246 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
22247 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
22248 function. */
22249 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
22251 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
22252 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
22254 else
22256 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
22257 if (list->dw_loc_next)
22258 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
22259 else
22260 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
22263 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
22264 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
22265 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
22266 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
22267 by this displacement. */
22268 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
22270 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
22272 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
22273 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
22274 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
22275 last field of the FRAME record. */
22276 const tree frame_type
22277 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
22278 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
22280 tree fb_expr
22281 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
22282 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
22283 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
22285 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
22286 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
22289 resolve_variable_values ();
22292 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
22293 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22294 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
22296 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
22297 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
22298 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
22299 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
22300 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
22301 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
22302 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
22303 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
22304 an ellipsis at the end. */
22306 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
22307 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
22308 its formal parameters. */
22309 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22311 else if (declaration)
22312 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
22313 else
22315 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
22316 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
22317 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
22318 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
22319 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
22320 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
22321 : NULL;
22323 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
22324 emit their relevant DIEs.
22326 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
22327 as well as it being a normal function.
22329 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
22330 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
22331 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
22332 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
22333 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
22334 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
22335 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
22336 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
22337 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
22338 children DIE.
22340 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
22341 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
22343 if (generic_decl_parm
22344 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
22345 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
22346 parm, subr_die,
22347 &parm);
22348 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
22350 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22352 if (early_dwarf
22353 && parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
22354 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
22355 && parm_die
22356 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22357 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
22359 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22361 else if (parm)
22362 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
22364 if (generic_decl_parm)
22365 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
22368 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
22369 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
22370 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
22371 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
22372 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
22373 parameters at all. */
22374 if (early_dwarf)
22376 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22378 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
22379 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
22380 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22382 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22383 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
22387 if (subr_die != old_die)
22388 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
22389 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22391 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
22392 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
22394 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
22395 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
22396 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
22397 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
22398 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
22399 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
22400 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
22402 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
22403 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
22404 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
22405 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
22406 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
22407 constructor function. */
22408 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
22409 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
22411 int call_site_note_count = 0;
22412 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
22414 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
22415 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
22416 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
22418 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
22419 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
22420 location info. */
22421 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
22423 if (call_arg_locations && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22425 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
22426 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
22428 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
22429 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
22430 rtx arg, next_arg;
22432 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
22433 ? NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note)
22434 : NULL_RTX);
22435 arg; arg = next_arg)
22437 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
22438 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
22439 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
22441 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
22442 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22443 && next_arg
22444 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
22445 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
22446 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22447 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
22448 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
22449 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22451 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22452 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22453 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
22455 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
22456 continue;
22457 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
22458 have no static information: we cannot generate both
22459 DW_AT_call_origin and DW_AT_call_target
22460 attributes. */
22461 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
22463 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22465 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22466 continue;
22468 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
22469 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
22471 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
22472 continue;
22475 reg = NULL;
22476 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22477 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
22478 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22479 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
22481 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
22482 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
22483 get_address_mode (mem),
22484 GET_MODE (mem),
22485 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22487 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22488 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22490 tree tdecl
22491 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
22492 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
22493 if (tdie == NULL)
22494 continue;
22496 else
22497 continue;
22498 if (reg == NULL
22499 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
22500 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
22501 continue;
22502 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
22503 VOIDmode,
22504 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22505 if (val == NULL)
22506 continue;
22507 if (die == NULL)
22508 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22509 cdie = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site_parameter), die,
22510 NULL_TREE);
22511 if (reg != NULL)
22512 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
22513 else if (tdie != NULL)
22514 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_parameter),
22515 tdie);
22516 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_value), val);
22517 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
22519 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
22520 if (mode == VOIDmode)
22521 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
22522 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
22523 0), 1),
22524 mode, VOIDmode,
22525 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22526 if (val != NULL)
22527 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_data_value),
22528 val);
22531 if (die == NULL
22532 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
22533 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
22534 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
22536 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
22538 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
22539 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
22540 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
22541 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
22542 VOIDmode,
22543 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22544 if (tval)
22545 add_AT_loc (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target), tval);
22546 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
22548 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
22549 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
22550 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
22551 VOIDmode,
22552 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
22553 if (tval)
22554 add_AT_loc (die,
22555 dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target_clobbered),
22556 tval);
22559 if (die != NULL)
22561 call_site_note_count++;
22562 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
22563 tail_call_site_note_count++;
22567 call_arg_locations = NULL;
22568 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
22569 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
22570 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
22571 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
22573 if (call_site_count >= 0
22574 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
22575 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_calls), 1);
22576 else
22577 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls), 1);
22579 call_site_count = -1;
22580 tail_call_site_count = -1;
22583 /* Mark used types after we have created DIEs for the functions scopes. */
22584 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
22587 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
22589 hashval_t
22590 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
22592 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
22595 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
22596 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
22598 bool
22599 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
22601 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
22604 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
22605 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
22606 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
22607 class/namespace scoped declaration.
22609 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
22610 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
22611 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
22612 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
22613 static inline bool
22614 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
22616 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
22617 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
22620 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
22622 static inline bool
22623 local_function_static (tree decl)
22625 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl));
22626 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
22627 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22628 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
22631 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
22632 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
22634 static void
22635 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
22637 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
22638 tree com_decl;
22639 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
22640 tree ultimate_origin;
22641 dw_die_ref var_die;
22642 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
22643 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
22644 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22645 bool specialization_p = false;
22646 bool no_linkage_name = false;
22648 /* While C++ inline static data members have definitions inside of the
22649 class, force the first DIE to be a declaration, then let gen_member_die
22650 reparent it to the class context and call gen_variable_die again
22651 to create the outside of the class DIE for the definition. */
22652 if (!declaration
22653 && old_die == NULL
22654 && decl
22655 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22656 && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22657 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl, DW_AT_inline) != -1)
22659 declaration = true;
22660 if (dwarf_version < 5)
22661 no_linkage_name = true;
22664 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
22665 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
22666 origin = ultimate_origin;
22667 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
22669 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
22670 of a data member. */
22671 if (com_decl)
22673 dw_die_ref com_die;
22674 dw_loc_list_ref loc = NULL;
22675 die_node com_die_arg;
22677 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
22678 if (var_die)
22680 if (! early_dwarf && get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
22682 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
22683 if (loc)
22685 if (off)
22687 /* Optimize the common case. */
22688 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22689 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22690 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22691 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
22692 == SYMBOL_REF)
22694 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22695 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22696 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
22698 else
22699 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22701 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22702 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22705 return;
22708 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
22709 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22711 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22712 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
22713 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
22714 if (! early_dwarf)
22715 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22716 if (com_die == NULL)
22718 const char *cnam
22719 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
22720 die_node **slot;
22722 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
22723 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
22724 if (loc)
22726 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22727 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
22728 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
22729 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22731 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22732 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22733 if (want_pubnames ())
22734 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
22735 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
22736 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
22737 *slot = com_die;
22739 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
22741 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22742 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
22743 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22745 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
22746 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
22747 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
22748 decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
22749 context_die);
22750 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
22751 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22752 if (loc)
22754 if (off)
22756 /* Optimize the common case. */
22757 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
22758 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
22759 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
22760 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
22762 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
22763 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
22764 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
22766 else
22767 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
22769 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
22771 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
22772 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22773 if (decl)
22774 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
22775 return;
22778 if (old_die)
22780 if (declaration)
22782 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
22783 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
22784 the second pass. */
22785 return;
22787 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
22788 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
22790 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
22791 DW_AT_specification. */
22793 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
22795 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
22796 new DIE that will get annotated with
22797 DW_AT_abstract_origin. Clear things so we can get a
22798 new DIE. */
22799 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
22800 old_die = NULL;
22802 else
22804 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
22805 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
22806 var_die = old_die;
22808 /* ??? In LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
22809 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
22810 references to them. Thus we dumped them again, also add a
22811 reference to them. */
22812 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
22813 if (in_lto_p
22814 && variably_modified_type_p
22815 (type, decl_function_context (decl_or_origin)))
22817 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22818 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
22819 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22820 else
22821 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
22822 false, context_die);
22825 goto gen_variable_die_location;
22829 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
22830 to have DW_TAG_member tag in DWARF{3,4} and we emit it for compatibility
22831 also in DWARF2; the specification should still be DW_TAG_variable
22832 referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
22833 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die) && dwarf_version < 5)
22834 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
22835 else
22836 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
22838 if (origin != NULL)
22839 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
22841 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
22842 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
22844 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
22845 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
22846 sharing them.
22848 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
22849 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
22851 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
22852 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
22853 specialization_p = true;
22854 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
22856 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22857 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
22859 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22860 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22862 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22863 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22865 if (debug_column_info
22866 && s.column
22867 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22868 != (unsigned) s.column))
22869 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22871 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
22872 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
22875 else
22876 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl, no_linkage_name);
22878 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
22879 || (origin != NULL
22880 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
22881 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
22882 decl_function_context
22883 (decl_or_origin))))
22885 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
22887 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22888 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22889 context_die);
22890 else
22891 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
22892 context_die);
22895 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
22897 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22898 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22900 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22901 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22903 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
22905 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
22908 if (declaration)
22909 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22911 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
22912 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
22913 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
22915 gen_variable_die_location:
22916 if (! declaration
22917 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
22918 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
22919 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
22920 already set. */
22921 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin)
22922 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
22923 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin))))
22925 if (early_dwarf)
22926 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
22927 else
22928 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
22929 decl == NULL);
22931 else
22932 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
22934 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
22935 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
22936 DW_AT_const_expr) == 1
22937 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr)
22938 && !specialization_p)
22939 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr, 1);
22941 if (!dwarf_strict)
22943 int inl = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
22944 DW_AT_inline);
22945 if (inl != -1
22946 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_inline)
22947 && !specialization_p)
22948 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_inline, inl);
22952 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
22954 static void
22955 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22957 dw_die_ref const_die;
22958 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
22960 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22961 if (const_die)
22962 return;
22964 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
22965 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
22966 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
22967 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
22968 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22969 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22970 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22971 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22972 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
22975 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
22977 static void
22978 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22980 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22981 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22982 rtx insn;
22983 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22985 if (!lbl_die)
22987 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
22988 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
22990 if (origin != NULL)
22991 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
22992 else
22993 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
22996 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
22997 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
22998 else if (! early_dwarf)
23000 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
23002 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
23003 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
23004 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
23005 if (insn
23006 && (LABEL_P (insn)
23007 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
23008 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
23010 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
23011 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
23012 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
23013 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
23014 it if it ever does happen. */
23015 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
23017 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23018 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23020 else if (insn
23021 && NOTE_P (insn)
23022 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
23023 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
23025 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23026 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23031 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
23032 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
23033 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
23035 static inline void
23036 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23038 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
23040 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23042 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
23043 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
23044 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
23045 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_column, s.column);
23050 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
23051 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
23053 static inline void
23054 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23056 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23058 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
23059 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23061 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
23062 dw_die_ref pdie;
23063 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
23065 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
23067 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23068 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23069 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
23072 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
23073 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
23074 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
23075 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
23076 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
23077 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
23078 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
23079 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
23081 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
23083 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
23084 if (pdie == NULL)
23085 break;
23086 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
23087 break;
23088 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
23089 if (new_attr == NULL
23090 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
23091 break;
23092 attr = new_attr;
23093 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
23095 if (attr != NULL
23096 && ((*ranges_table)[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset].num
23097 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
23098 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
23100 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset;
23101 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
23102 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
23103 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23105 ++supercnt;
23106 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt].num
23107 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
23109 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
23110 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23111 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
23112 ++thiscnt;
23113 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
23114 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, off + supercnt - thiscnt,
23115 false);
23116 note_rnglist_head (off + supercnt - thiscnt);
23117 return;
23120 unsigned int offset = add_ranges (stmt, true);
23121 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, false);
23122 note_rnglist_head (offset);
23124 bool prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (stmt);
23125 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
23128 add_ranges (chain, prev_in_cold != BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain));
23129 prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain);
23130 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
23132 while (chain);
23133 add_ranges (NULL);
23135 else
23137 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23138 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23139 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23140 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
23141 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23142 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
23146 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
23148 static void
23149 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23151 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
23152 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
23153 if (!old_die)
23155 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23156 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23159 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23161 if (old_die)
23163 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
23164 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
23165 function. */
23166 if (flag_checking)
23167 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
23168 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
23169 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
23171 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
23172 break;
23174 return;
23177 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
23179 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
23180 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
23181 if (old_die)
23183 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
23184 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
23185 old_die = NULL;
23188 tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23189 if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
23190 add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
23193 if (old_die)
23194 stmt_die = old_die;
23196 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
23197 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
23198 high/low attributes. */
23199 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23201 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
23202 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
23205 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
23208 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
23210 static void
23211 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
23213 tree decl;
23215 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
23216 be abstract. */
23217 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
23219 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
23221 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
23222 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23223 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
23225 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
23227 dw_die_ref subr_die
23228 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
23230 if (call_arg_locations)
23231 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
23232 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
23233 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
23234 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23235 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
23237 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
23241 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
23242 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
23244 static void
23245 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
23247 dw_die_ref decl_die;
23249 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
23250 return;
23252 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
23253 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
23254 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
23255 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
23256 context_die);
23258 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
23260 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23261 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23262 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23265 add_alignment_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23267 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
23268 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
23269 trees. */
23270 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
23271 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23272 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
23273 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
23275 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23276 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23278 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
23280 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
23281 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
23284 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. TYPE can be an
23285 OFFSET_TYPE, for a pointer to data member, or a RECORD_TYPE, for a
23286 pointer to member function. */
23288 static void
23289 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
23291 if (lookup_type_die (type))
23292 return;
23294 dw_die_ref ptr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
23295 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
23297 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
23298 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
23299 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
23300 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23301 context_die);
23302 add_alignment_attribute (ptr_die, type);
23304 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
23305 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != METHOD_TYPE)
23307 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
23308 add_AT_loc (ptr_die, DW_AT_use_location, op);
23312 static char *producer_string;
23314 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
23315 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
23317 static char *
23318 gen_producer_string (void)
23320 size_t j;
23321 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
23322 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23323 char *producer, *tail;
23324 const char *p;
23325 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
23326 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
23328 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
23329 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
23331 case OPT_o:
23332 case OPT_d:
23333 case OPT_dumpbase:
23334 case OPT_dumpdir:
23335 case OPT_auxbase:
23336 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
23337 case OPT_quiet:
23338 case OPT_version:
23339 case OPT_v:
23340 case OPT_w:
23341 case OPT_L:
23342 case OPT_D:
23343 case OPT_I:
23344 case OPT_U:
23345 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
23346 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
23347 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
23348 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
23349 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
23350 case OPT__output_pch_:
23351 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
23352 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
23353 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
23354 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
23355 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
23356 case OPT____:
23357 case OPT__sysroot_:
23358 case OPT_nostdinc:
23359 case OPT_nostdinc__:
23360 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
23361 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
23362 case OPT_fresolution_:
23363 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
23364 /* Ignore these. */
23365 continue;
23366 default:
23367 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
23368 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
23369 continue;
23370 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
23371 == '-');
23372 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
23374 case 'M':
23375 case 'i':
23376 case 'W':
23377 continue;
23378 case 'f':
23379 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
23380 "dump", 4) == 0)
23381 continue;
23382 break;
23383 default:
23384 break;
23386 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
23387 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
23388 break;
23391 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
23392 tail = producer;
23393 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
23394 tail += plen;
23396 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
23398 len = strlen (p);
23399 *tail = ' ';
23400 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
23401 tail += len + 1;
23404 *tail = '\0';
23405 return producer;
23408 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
23409 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
23410 LTO translation unit languages. */
23411 static const char *
23412 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
23414 if (strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang2) == 0)
23415 return "GNU C++17";
23416 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
23417 return "GNU C++14";
23418 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
23419 return "GNU C++11";
23420 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
23421 return "GNU C++98";
23423 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
23424 return "GNU C11";
23425 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
23426 return "GNU C99";
23427 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
23428 return "GNU C89";
23430 gcc_unreachable ();
23434 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
23436 static dw_die_ref
23437 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
23439 dw_die_ref die;
23440 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
23441 int language;
23443 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
23445 if (filename)
23447 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
23448 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
23449 if (filename[0] != '<')
23450 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
23453 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
23455 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
23456 from the global list of translation units. */
23457 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
23459 unsigned i;
23460 tree t;
23461 const char *common_lang = NULL;
23463 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
23465 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
23466 continue;
23467 if (!common_lang)
23468 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
23469 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
23471 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23472 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
23473 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
23474 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
23475 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
23476 else
23478 /* Fall back to C. */
23479 common_lang = NULL;
23480 break;
23484 if (common_lang)
23485 language_string = common_lang;
23488 language = DW_LANG_C;
23489 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
23490 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
23492 language = DW_LANG_C89;
23493 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23495 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
23496 language = DW_LANG_C99;
23498 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23499 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0)
23500 language = DW_LANG_C11;
23503 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
23505 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
23506 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23508 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
23509 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
23510 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
23511 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23512 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++17") == 0)
23513 /* For now. */
23514 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
23517 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
23518 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
23519 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23521 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
23522 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
23523 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23525 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
23526 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
23528 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
23529 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
23530 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
23531 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
23534 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
23535 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
23536 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
23537 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
23538 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
23540 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
23541 language = DW_LANG_Go;
23544 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
23545 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
23546 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
23548 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
23550 switch (language)
23552 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
23553 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
23554 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
23555 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
23556 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
23557 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
23558 lowercases everything. */
23559 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
23560 break;
23561 default:
23562 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
23563 break;
23565 return die;
23568 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
23570 static void
23571 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
23572 dw_die_ref context_die)
23574 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
23575 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
23577 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23578 context_die);
23579 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
23581 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
23582 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
23584 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
23585 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
23586 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
23587 if (access == access_public_node)
23589 if (dwarf_version == 2
23590 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
23591 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
23593 else if (access == access_protected_node)
23594 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
23595 else if (dwarf_version > 2
23596 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
23597 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
23600 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
23601 structure. */
23602 static bool
23603 is_variant_part (tree decl)
23605 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
23606 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
23609 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
23610 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
23612 static tree
23613 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
23615 bool continue_stripping = true;
23616 while (continue_stripping)
23617 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
23619 CASE_CONVERT:
23620 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
23621 break;
23622 default:
23623 continue_stripping = false;
23624 break;
23627 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
23628 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
23629 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
23630 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
23631 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
23632 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
23633 else
23634 return NULL_TREE;
23637 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
23638 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
23639 return true. Return false otherwise. */
23641 static bool
23642 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
23644 tree discr_type = TREE_TYPE (src);
23646 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
23648 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (discr_type);
23649 if (debug_type != NULL)
23650 discr_type = debug_type;
23653 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (discr_type))
23654 return false;
23656 /* Signedness can vary between the original type and the debug type. This
23657 can happen for character types in Ada for instance: the character type
23658 used for code generation can be signed, to be compatible with the C one,
23659 but from a debugger point of view, it must be unsigned. */
23660 bool is_orig_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
23661 bool is_debug_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (discr_type);
23663 if (is_orig_unsigned != is_debug_unsigned)
23664 src = fold_convert (discr_type, src);
23666 if (!(is_debug_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
23667 return false;
23669 dest->pos = is_debug_unsigned;
23670 if (is_debug_unsigned)
23671 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
23672 else
23673 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
23675 return true;
23678 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
23679 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
23680 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
23682 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
23683 part to *DISCR_DECL
23685 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
23686 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
23688 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
23689 the above array.
23691 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
23692 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
23694 static void
23695 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
23696 tree struct_type,
23697 tree *discr_decl,
23698 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
23699 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
23701 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
23702 tree variant;
23703 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
23704 unsigned i;
23706 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
23707 *discr_lists_length = 0;
23708 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
23709 variant != NULL_TREE;
23710 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
23711 ++*discr_lists_length;
23713 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23714 *discr_lists_p
23715 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
23716 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
23717 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
23719 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
23720 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
23721 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
23722 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
23723 variant != NULL_TREE;
23724 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
23726 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
23728 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
23729 it. */
23730 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
23731 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
23732 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
23733 this one. */
23734 continue;
23736 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
23737 possibility: single values or ranges. */
23738 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
23740 tree next_round_match_expr;
23741 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
23742 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
23744 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
23745 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
23746 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
23747 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
23749 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23750 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23752 else
23753 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
23755 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
23756 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
23757 one. */
23760 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
23762 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
23763 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
23764 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23766 candidate_discr
23767 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
23768 struct_type);
23770 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23771 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
23772 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
23773 goto abort;
23774 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
23777 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
23779 /* We are matching:
23780 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
23781 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
23782 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
23783 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
23784 inclusive or exclusive. */
23785 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
23786 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
23787 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
23788 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
23789 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
23791 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
23792 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
23793 to increment or decrement it. */
23794 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
23795 lower_cst_included = true;
23796 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
23797 lower_cst_included = false;
23798 else
23799 goto abort;
23801 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
23802 upper_cst_included = true;
23803 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
23804 upper_cst_included = false;
23805 else
23806 goto abort;
23808 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
23809 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
23810 operand. */
23811 candidate_discr_1
23812 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
23813 struct_type);
23814 candidate_discr_2
23815 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
23816 struct_type);
23817 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
23818 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
23819 else
23820 goto abort;
23822 /* Extract bounds from both. */
23823 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
23824 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
23825 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
23827 if (!lower_cst_included)
23828 lower_cst
23829 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), lower_cst,
23830 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1));
23831 if (!upper_cst_included)
23832 upper_cst
23833 = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), upper_cst,
23834 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1));
23836 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
23837 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
23838 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
23839 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
23840 goto abort;
23842 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
23845 else
23846 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
23847 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
23848 goto abort;
23850 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
23851 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
23852 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
23853 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
23854 goto abort;
23855 else
23856 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
23858 if (new_node != NULL)
23860 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
23861 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
23863 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
23867 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
23868 in. */
23869 return;
23871 abort:
23872 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
23873 free (*discr_lists_p);
23874 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
23875 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23878 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
23879 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
23880 under CONTEXT_DIE.
23882 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
23883 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
23884 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
23885 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
23886 values are inferred from these attributes.
23888 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
23889 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
23890 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
23891 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
23892 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
23893 describe in DWARF. */
23895 static void
23896 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
23897 dw_die_ref context_die)
23899 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
23900 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
23901 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
23902 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
23903 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
23904 NULL, /* dpi */
23905 false, /* placeholder_arg */
23906 false /* placeholder_seen */
23909 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
23910 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
23911 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23912 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
23913 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
23914 unsigned i;
23916 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
23917 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
23918 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
23920 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
23922 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
23923 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
23925 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
23927 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
23929 if (discr_die)
23930 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
23931 else
23932 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
23933 discrimimant information in the output. */
23934 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
23937 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
23938 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
23939 expressions for it for each member. */
23940 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
23941 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23943 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
23944 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
23945 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
23946 NULL_TREE));
23947 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
23948 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
23949 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
23951 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
23952 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
23953 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
23954 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
23957 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
23958 i = 0;
23959 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
23960 variant != NULL_TREE;
23961 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
23963 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
23964 dw_die_ref variant_die;
23966 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
23967 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
23968 under these records. */
23969 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
23971 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
23972 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
23974 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
23975 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
23976 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
23977 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
23978 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
23980 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
23981 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
23982 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
23983 list. */
23984 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
23985 else
23986 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
23988 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
23989 member != NULL_TREE;
23990 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
23992 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
23993 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
23994 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
23996 if (is_variant_part (member))
23998 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
23999 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
24000 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
24001 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
24002 we recurse. */
24004 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
24005 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24006 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member));
24007 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24009 else
24011 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
24012 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24017 free (discr_lists);
24020 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
24022 static void
24023 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24025 tree member;
24026 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
24028 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
24030 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
24031 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
24032 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
24033 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
24034 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
24035 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
24036 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
24037 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
24038 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
24039 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
24040 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
24042 /* First output info about the base classes. */
24043 if (binfo)
24045 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
24046 int i;
24047 tree base;
24049 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
24050 gen_inheritance_die (base,
24051 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
24052 type,
24053 context_die);
24056 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
24057 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24059 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
24060 bool static_inline_p
24061 = (TREE_STATIC (member)
24062 && (lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (member, DW_AT_inline)
24063 != -1));
24065 /* Ignore clones. */
24066 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
24067 continue;
24069 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
24070 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
24071 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
24072 do put them in the right order. */
24074 if (dw_die_ref child = lookup_decl_die (member))
24076 /* Handle inline static data members, which only have in-class
24077 declarations. */
24078 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
24079 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24080 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ())
24082 ref = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
24083 /* For C++17 inline static data members followed by redundant
24084 out of class redeclaration, we might get here with
24085 child being the DIE created for the out of class
24086 redeclaration and with its DW_AT_specification being
24087 the DIE created for in-class definition. We want to
24088 reparent the latter, and don't want to create another
24089 DIE with DW_AT_specification in that case, because
24090 we already have one. */
24091 if (ref
24092 && static_inline_p
24093 && ref->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24094 && ref->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24095 && get_AT (ref, DW_AT_specification) == NULL)
24097 child = ref;
24098 ref = NULL;
24099 static_inline_p = false;
24103 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24104 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
24105 && ref == NULL)
24107 reparent_child (child, context_die);
24108 if (dwarf_version < 5)
24109 child->die_tag = DW_TAG_member;
24111 else
24112 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
24115 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
24116 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
24117 conflict in our mappings. */
24118 else if (is_variant_part (member)
24119 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
24121 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
24122 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24124 else
24126 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
24127 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
24130 /* For C++ inline static data members emit immediately a DW_TAG_variable
24131 DIE that will refer to that DW_TAG_member/DW_TAG_variable through
24132 DW_AT_specification. */
24133 if (static_inline_p)
24135 int old_extern = DECL_EXTERNAL (member);
24136 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = 0;
24137 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, comp_unit_die ());
24138 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = old_extern;
24143 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
24144 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
24145 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
24147 static void
24148 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24149 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24151 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24153 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
24154 still incomplete. */
24155 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24156 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
24157 member;
24158 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24159 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
24160 return;
24163 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24164 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
24165 int nested = 0;
24166 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
24167 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24168 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
24169 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
24170 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
24172 if (type_die && ! complete)
24173 return;
24175 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24176 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24177 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
24178 nested = 1;
24180 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24182 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
24183 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24184 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
24186 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
24187 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
24189 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
24191 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
24192 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
24193 scope_die, type);
24194 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24195 if (old_die)
24196 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
24197 else
24198 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
24200 else
24201 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
24203 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
24204 then give a list of members. */
24205 if (complete && !ns_decl)
24207 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
24208 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
24209 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24210 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
24211 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
24212 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
24214 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24215 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
24218 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
24219 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
24220 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
24221 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
24223 push_decl_scope (type);
24224 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
24225 pop_decl_scope ();
24227 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
24228 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
24229 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
24231 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
24232 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
24234 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
24236 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
24237 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
24238 lookup_type_die (vtype));
24241 else
24243 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
24245 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
24246 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
24247 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
24248 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
24251 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24252 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
24255 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
24257 static void
24258 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24260 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
24261 dw_die_ref subr_die
24262 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
24263 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
24265 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
24266 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
24267 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24268 context_die);
24269 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, type);
24270 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
24272 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
24273 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
24274 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24275 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type, DW_AT_reference) != -1)
24276 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
24277 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24278 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type,
24279 DW_AT_rvalue_reference) != -1)
24280 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
24283 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
24285 static void
24286 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
24288 dw_die_ref type_die;
24289 tree type;
24291 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
24293 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24294 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
24295 return;
24298 /* As we avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs (see decl_ultimate_origin
24299 checks in process_scope_var and modified_type_die), this should be called
24300 only for original types. */
24301 gcc_assert (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == NULL
24302 || decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == decl);
24304 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
24305 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
24307 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
24308 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
24310 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
24311 if (type == error_mark_node)
24312 return;
24314 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
24315 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
24317 else
24319 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
24320 if (type == error_mark_node)
24321 return;
24323 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24325 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
24326 an anonymous type, e.g:
24327 typedef struct {...} foo;
24328 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
24329 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
24330 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
24331 the C++ FE.
24333 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
24334 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
24335 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
24336 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
24337 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
24338 anonymous struct DIE. */
24339 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24340 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24342 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
24343 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
24344 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
24345 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
24346 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
24347 this debug info. */
24348 add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
24352 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
24353 context_die);
24355 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
24356 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
24357 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
24358 created. */
24359 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24361 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
24363 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
24365 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
24366 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
24368 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
24369 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
24372 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
24374 static void
24375 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
24376 dw_die_ref context_die,
24377 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24379 int need_pop;
24381 if (type == NULL_TREE
24382 || !is_tagged_type (type))
24383 return;
24385 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24386 need_pop = 0;
24387 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
24388 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
24389 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
24390 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
24391 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
24392 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
24393 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
24394 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
24395 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
24397 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
24399 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24400 return;
24402 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
24403 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24404 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24405 need_pop = 1;
24407 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
24408 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
24410 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
24411 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
24412 decls_for_scope. */
24413 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
24414 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
24415 specification. */
24416 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
24417 context_die = NULL;
24418 need_pop = 0;
24420 else
24422 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
24423 need_pop = 0;
24426 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
24428 /* This might have been written out by the call to
24429 declare_in_namespace. */
24430 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24431 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
24433 else
24434 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24436 if (need_pop)
24437 pop_decl_scope ();
24439 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
24440 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
24441 when appropriate. */
24444 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
24446 static void
24447 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
24448 enum debug_info_usage usage)
24450 struct array_descr_info info;
24452 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
24453 return;
24455 if (flag_checking && type)
24456 verify_type (type);
24458 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
24459 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
24460 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
24461 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24462 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
24463 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
24464 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
24465 type. */
24466 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
24468 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
24469 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
24470 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
24472 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24473 return;
24475 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
24476 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
24477 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
24479 gen_decl_die (origin, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24480 return;
24483 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
24484 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type);
24486 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
24487 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
24489 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24491 gen_decl_die (name, NULL, NULL, context_die);
24492 return;
24495 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
24496 generate debug info for the typedef. */
24497 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
24499 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
24500 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
24501 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
24502 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
24503 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
24505 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
24506 return;
24509 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
24511 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
24513 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
24515 gen_type_die_with_usage (debug_type, context_die, usage);
24516 return;
24520 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
24521 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
24522 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
24523 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
24524 cloned type itself. Similarly function/method types can contain extra
24525 ref-qualification). */
24526 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
24527 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
24529 /* For function/method types, can't use type_main_variant here,
24530 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
24531 but try to canonicalize. */
24532 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
24533 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
24534 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
24535 && check_base_type (t, main)
24536 && check_lang_type (t, type))
24538 type = t;
24539 break;
24542 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
24543 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
24544 type = type_main_variant (type);
24546 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
24547 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
24548 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
24550 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
24551 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
24553 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
24554 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
24555 && (info.ndimensions
24556 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
24557 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
24558 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24559 return;
24563 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
24565 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
24566 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
24567 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
24568 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
24569 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
24570 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
24571 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
24572 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
24573 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
24574 return;
24577 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
24579 case ERROR_MARK:
24580 break;
24582 case POINTER_TYPE:
24583 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
24584 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
24585 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
24586 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
24587 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
24588 statement. */
24589 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24591 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
24592 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
24593 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24594 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24595 break;
24597 case OFFSET_TYPE:
24598 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
24599 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
24600 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
24601 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24603 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
24604 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24605 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
24607 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
24608 itself. */
24609 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
24610 break;
24612 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
24613 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24614 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24615 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24616 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24617 break;
24619 case METHOD_TYPE:
24620 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
24621 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
24622 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24623 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
24624 break;
24626 case ARRAY_TYPE:
24627 case VECTOR_TYPE:
24628 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
24629 break;
24631 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
24632 case RECORD_TYPE:
24633 case UNION_TYPE:
24634 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
24635 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
24636 return;
24638 case VOID_TYPE:
24639 case INTEGER_TYPE:
24640 case REAL_TYPE:
24641 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
24642 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
24643 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
24644 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
24645 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
24646 break;
24648 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
24649 case LANG_TYPE:
24650 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
24652 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
24653 if (type_die == NULL)
24655 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24656 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
24657 type);
24658 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24659 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
24662 break;
24664 default:
24665 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
24667 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
24668 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
24669 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
24670 if (!*die)
24672 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
24673 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
24674 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
24676 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
24677 break;
24679 gcc_unreachable ();
24682 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
24685 static void
24686 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24688 if (type != error_mark_node)
24690 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
24691 if (flag_checking)
24693 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
24694 if (die)
24695 check_die (die);
24700 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
24701 things which are local to the given block. */
24703 static void
24704 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24706 int must_output_die = 0;
24707 bool inlined_func;
24709 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
24710 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
24711 return;
24713 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
24715 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
24716 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
24717 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
24718 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
24720 tree sub;
24722 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
24723 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
24725 return;
24728 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
24729 block. */
24730 if (inlined_func)
24731 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
24732 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
24733 must_output_die = 1;
24734 else
24736 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
24737 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
24738 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24739 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
24740 as being a "significant" one. */
24741 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
24742 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
24743 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
24744 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24745 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
24746 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
24747 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
24748 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24749 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
24750 must_output_die = 1;
24753 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
24754 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
24755 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
24756 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
24757 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
24758 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
24759 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
24760 if (must_output_die)
24762 if (inlined_func)
24764 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
24765 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
24766 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
24767 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
24768 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
24769 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
24770 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
24771 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
24773 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
24774 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
24775 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
24776 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
24777 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24778 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
24780 else
24781 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
24783 else
24784 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
24787 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
24788 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
24789 static void
24790 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
24792 dw_die_ref die;
24793 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
24795 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24796 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24797 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL)
24799 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
24800 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
24801 else
24802 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
24803 /* Avoid re-creating the DIE late if it was optimized as unused early. */
24804 if (! die && ! early_dwarf)
24805 return;
24807 else
24808 die = NULL;
24810 /* Avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs and concrete static variables that
24811 will only be pruned later. */
24812 if ((origin || decl_ultimate_origin (decl))
24813 && (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
24814 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin) && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin))))
24816 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
24817 if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && die != NULL)
24819 die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
24820 if (die != NULL)
24821 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
24823 return;
24826 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
24827 add_child_die (context_die, die);
24828 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
24830 if (early_dwarf)
24831 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
24832 stmt, context_die);
24834 else
24836 if (decl && DECL_P (decl))
24838 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
24840 /* Early created DIEs do not have a parent as the decls refer
24841 to the function as DECL_CONTEXT rather than the BLOCK. */
24842 if (die && die->die_parent == NULL)
24844 gcc_assert (in_lto_p);
24845 add_child_die (context_die, die);
24849 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
24853 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
24854 all of its sub-blocks. */
24856 static void
24857 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24859 tree decl;
24860 unsigned int i;
24861 tree subblocks;
24863 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
24864 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
24865 return;
24867 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
24868 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
24869 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
24870 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
24871 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
24872 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24874 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
24875 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
24876 /* BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARs simply generate DIE stubs with abstract
24877 origin - avoid doing this twice as we have no good way to see
24878 if we've done it once already. */
24879 if (! early_dwarf)
24880 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
24882 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
24883 if (decl == current_function_decl)
24884 /* Ignore declarations of the current function, while they
24885 are declarations, gen_subprogram_die would treat them
24886 as definitions again, because they are equal to
24887 current_function_decl and endlessly recurse. */;
24888 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24889 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
24890 else
24891 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL_TREE, decl, context_die);
24895 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
24896 inlined call information. */
24898 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
24899 therein) of this block. */
24900 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
24901 subblocks != NULL;
24902 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
24903 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
24906 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
24908 bool
24909 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
24911 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
24912 return true;
24914 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
24915 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
24916 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
24917 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
24918 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
24919 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
24920 return true;
24922 return false;
24925 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
24926 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
24927 constructs like:
24929 typedef struct {...} foo;
24931 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
24932 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
24933 struct type. */
24935 static bool
24936 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
24938 if (decl == NULL_TREE
24939 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
24940 || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
24941 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
24942 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
24943 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
24944 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
24945 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
24946 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
24947 || !is_cxx (decl))
24948 return FALSE;
24950 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
24951 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
24952 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
24953 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
24956 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
24958 static inline dw_die_ref
24959 lookup_context_die (tree context)
24961 if (context)
24963 /* Find die that represents this context. */
24964 if (TYPE_P (context))
24966 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
24967 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
24968 if (!ctx)
24969 return NULL;
24970 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
24972 else
24973 return lookup_decl_die (context);
24975 return comp_unit_die ();
24978 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
24980 static inline dw_die_ref
24981 get_context_die (tree context)
24983 if (context)
24985 /* Find die that represents this context. */
24986 if (TYPE_P (context))
24988 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
24989 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
24991 else
24992 return force_decl_die (context);
24994 return comp_unit_die ();
24997 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
24999 static dw_die_ref
25000 force_decl_die (tree decl)
25002 dw_die_ref decl_die;
25003 unsigned saved_external_flag;
25004 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
25005 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25006 if (!decl_die)
25008 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25010 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25011 if (decl_die)
25012 return decl_die;
25014 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25016 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25017 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
25018 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
25019 declaration die. */
25020 save_fn = current_function_decl;
25021 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
25022 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25023 current_function_decl = save_fn;
25024 break;
25026 case VAR_DECL:
25027 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
25028 gen_decl_die() call. */
25029 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
25030 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
25031 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25032 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
25033 break;
25035 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25036 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25037 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25038 else
25039 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
25040 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25041 break;
25043 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
25044 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25045 break;
25047 default:
25048 gcc_unreachable ();
25051 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
25052 if (!decl_die)
25053 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25054 gcc_assert (decl_die);
25057 return decl_die;
25060 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
25061 always returned. */
25063 static dw_die_ref
25064 force_type_die (tree type)
25066 dw_die_ref type_die;
25068 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25069 if (!type_die)
25071 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25073 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
25074 false, context_die);
25075 gcc_assert (type_die);
25077 return type_die;
25080 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
25081 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
25083 static dw_die_ref
25084 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25086 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
25087 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
25088 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25089 /* Force out the namespace. */
25090 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
25092 return context_die;
25095 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
25096 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
25098 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
25099 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
25100 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
25101 members). */
25103 static dw_die_ref
25104 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
25106 dw_die_ref ns_context;
25108 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25109 return context_die;
25111 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
25112 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
25114 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
25115 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
25117 namespace S
25119 int i=5;
25120 int foo()
25122 int i=8;
25123 extern int i;
25124 return i;
25128 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
25129 return context_die;
25131 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
25132 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
25133 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
25134 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
25135 return context_die;
25137 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
25139 if (ns_context != context_die)
25141 if (is_fortran ())
25142 return ns_context;
25143 if (DECL_P (thing))
25144 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
25145 else
25146 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
25148 return context_die;
25151 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
25153 static void
25154 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
25156 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
25158 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
25159 they are an alias of. */
25160 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
25162 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
25163 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25164 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
25165 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
25166 context_die, decl);
25167 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
25168 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25170 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
25171 if (name)
25172 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
25174 else
25175 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25176 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
25177 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25178 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25180 else
25182 /* Output a namespace alias. */
25184 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
25185 dw_die_ref origin_die
25186 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25188 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
25189 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25190 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
25191 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
25192 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
25193 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
25194 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
25195 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
25197 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25198 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25199 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25200 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_export_symbols, 1);
25202 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
25203 if (want_pubnames ())
25204 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
25207 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
25208 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
25209 for all other decls it returns NULL.
25211 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
25212 It can be NULL otherwise. */
25214 static dw_die_ref
25215 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
25216 dw_die_ref context_die)
25218 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
25219 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
25221 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
25222 return NULL;
25224 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
25225 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
25226 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
25227 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
25228 return NULL;
25230 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
25232 case ERROR_MARK:
25233 break;
25235 case CONST_DECL:
25236 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25238 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
25239 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
25240 break;
25243 /* Emit its type. */
25244 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25246 /* And its containing namespace. */
25247 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25249 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
25250 break;
25252 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25253 #if 0
25254 /* FIXME */
25255 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
25256 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
25257 if (current_function_decl != decl)
25258 /* This is only a declaration. */;
25259 #endif
25261 /* We should have abstract copies already and should not generate
25262 stray type DIEs in late LTO dumping. */
25263 if (! early_dwarf)
25266 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
25267 else if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
25268 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
25269 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
25270 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
25272 /* If we're emitting a possibly inlined function emit it as
25273 abstract instance. */
25274 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
25275 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
25276 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
25277 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
25278 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
25279 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
25280 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25281 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
25283 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
25284 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25286 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
25287 have its containing type. */
25288 if (!origin)
25289 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
25290 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25291 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
25293 /* And its return type. */
25294 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
25296 /* And its virtual context. */
25297 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25298 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25300 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
25301 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
25302 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
25304 /* And its containing namespace. */
25305 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
25308 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
25309 if (decl)
25310 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25311 break;
25313 case TYPE_DECL:
25314 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25315 actual typedefs. */
25316 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25317 break;
25319 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
25320 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
25321 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
25322 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
25323 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
25324 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
25325 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
25326 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
25327 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
25328 case. */
25329 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
25330 break;
25332 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
25333 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
25334 else
25335 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
25336 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
25337 break;
25339 case LABEL_DECL:
25340 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
25341 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
25342 break;
25344 case VAR_DECL:
25345 case RESULT_DECL:
25346 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25347 variable declarations or definitions. */
25348 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25349 break;
25351 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25352 All types have been dumped early. */
25353 if (early_dwarf
25354 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25355 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25356 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25357 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25358 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25359 in VLA bound information for example. */
25360 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25361 current_function_decl)))
25363 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
25364 object. */
25365 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
25366 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25367 else
25368 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25371 if (early_dwarf)
25373 /* And its containing type. */
25374 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
25375 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
25376 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
25378 /* And its containing namespace. */
25379 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
25382 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
25383 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
25384 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
25385 function. */
25386 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
25387 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
25388 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
25389 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25390 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25391 context_die);
25392 else
25393 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
25394 break;
25396 case FIELD_DECL:
25397 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
25398 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
25399 anonymous unions and structs. */
25400 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
25401 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
25402 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
25404 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
25405 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
25407 break;
25409 case PARM_DECL:
25410 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
25411 All types have been dumped early. */
25412 if (early_dwarf
25413 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
25414 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
25415 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
25416 which copies both the decl and the types. */
25417 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
25418 in VLA bound information for example. */
25419 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
25420 current_function_decl)))
25422 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
25423 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
25424 else
25425 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
25427 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
25428 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
25429 context_die);
25431 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25432 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25433 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
25434 break;
25436 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25437 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
25438 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
25439 break;
25441 case NAMELIST_DECL:
25442 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
25443 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
25444 break;
25446 default:
25447 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
25448 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
25449 break;
25452 return NULL;
25455 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
25456 end of the parsing process.
25458 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
25459 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
25460 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
25461 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
25463 static void
25464 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
25466 set_early_dwarf s;
25468 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
25469 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
25470 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
25472 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
25473 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25474 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
25475 while we generate dwarf early. */
25476 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
25477 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
25479 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
25480 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
25481 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
25482 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25483 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
25485 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25487 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
25489 /* For nested functions, make sure we have DIEs for the parents first
25490 so that all nested DIEs are generated at the proper scope in the
25491 first shot. */
25492 tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
25493 if (context != NULL)
25495 dw_die_ref context_die = lookup_decl_die (context);
25496 current_function_decl = context;
25498 /* Avoid emitting DIEs multiple times, but still process CONTEXT
25499 enough so that it lands in its own context. This avoids type
25500 pruning issues later on. */
25501 if (context_die == NULL || is_declaration_die (context_die))
25502 dwarf2out_decl (context);
25505 /* Emit an abstract origin of a function first. This happens
25506 with C++ constructor clones for example and makes
25507 dwarf2out_abstract_function happy which requires the early
25508 DIE of the abstract instance to be present. */
25509 tree origin = DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
25510 dw_die_ref origin_die;
25511 if (origin != NULL
25512 /* Do not emit the DIE multiple times but make sure to
25513 process it fully here in case we just saw a declaration. */
25514 && ((origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin)) == NULL
25515 || is_declaration_die (origin_die)))
25517 current_function_decl = origin;
25518 dwarf2out_decl (origin);
25521 /* Emit the DIE for decl but avoid doing that multiple times. */
25522 dw_die_ref old_die;
25523 if ((old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl)) == NULL
25524 || is_declaration_die (old_die))
25526 current_function_decl = decl;
25527 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25530 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
25532 else
25533 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25535 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
25538 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
25539 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
25541 static void
25542 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
25544 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
25545 on the first pass. */
25546 if (VAR_P (decl) && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
25548 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25550 /* We may have to generate early debug late for LTO in case debug
25551 was not enabled at compile-time or the target doesn't support
25552 the LTO early debug scheme. */
25553 if (! die && in_lto_p)
25555 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25556 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25559 if (die)
25561 /* We get called via the symtab code invoking late_global_decl
25562 for symbols that are optimized out. Do not add locations
25563 for those, except if they have a DECL_VALUE_EXPR, in which case
25564 they are relevant for debuggers. */
25565 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (decl);
25566 if ((! node || ! node->definition) && ! DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
25567 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
25568 else
25569 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
25574 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
25575 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
25576 static void
25577 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
25579 if (!local)
25581 set_early_dwarf s;
25582 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25586 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25587 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
25588 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
25589 that DECL belongs to.
25590 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
25591 static void
25592 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
25593 tree name,
25594 tree lexical_block,
25595 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
25597 expanded_location xloc;
25598 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
25599 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
25601 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
25603 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
25604 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
25605 gcc_assert (decl);
25607 else
25608 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
25610 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
25612 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25613 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
25614 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
25615 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
25616 if (!at_import_die)
25618 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
25619 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
25620 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
25621 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
25624 else
25626 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25627 if (!at_import_die)
25629 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
25630 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
25631 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
25633 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
25635 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
25636 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25637 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
25638 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25639 return;
25640 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
25641 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
25643 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
25644 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
25645 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
25646 NULL_TREE);
25647 else
25648 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
25652 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25654 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25655 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
25656 lexical_block_die,
25657 lexical_block);
25658 else
25659 return;
25661 else
25662 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
25663 lexical_block_die,
25664 lexical_block);
25666 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
25667 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
25668 if (debug_column_info && xloc.column)
25669 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_column, xloc.column);
25670 if (name)
25671 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
25672 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25673 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
25676 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
25677 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
25678 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
25679 importing whole module.
25680 IMPLICIT is set if this hook is called for an implicit import
25681 such as inline namespace. */
25683 static void
25684 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
25685 bool child, bool implicit)
25687 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
25688 dw_die_ref scope_die;
25690 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25691 return;
25693 gcc_assert (decl);
25695 /* For DWARF5, just DW_AT_export_symbols on the DW_TAG_namespace
25696 should be enough, for DWARF4 and older even if we emit as extension
25697 DW_AT_export_symbols add the implicit DW_TAG_imported_module anyway
25698 for the benefit of consumers unaware of DW_AT_export_symbols. */
25699 if (implicit
25700 && dwarf_version >= 5
25701 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
25702 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
25703 return;
25705 set_early_dwarf s;
25707 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
25708 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
25709 itself. */
25711 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
25712 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
25713 if (context
25714 && TYPE_P (context)
25715 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
25716 return;
25718 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
25720 if (child)
25722 /* DW_TAG_imported_module was introduced in the DWARFv3 specification, so
25723 there is nothing we can do, here. */
25724 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
25725 return;
25727 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
25728 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
25729 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
25730 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
25733 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
25734 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
25737 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
25739 static dw_die_ref
25740 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
25742 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
25743 tree value;
25744 unsigned i;
25746 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25747 return NULL;
25749 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
25750 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
25751 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25753 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
25754 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
25755 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
25757 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25758 return nml_die;
25761 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
25763 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
25764 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
25765 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
25767 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
25768 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
25770 return nml_die;
25774 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
25776 static void
25777 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
25779 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
25781 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25783 case ERROR_MARK:
25784 return;
25786 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25787 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
25788 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
25789 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
25790 if (decl_function_context (decl)
25791 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
25792 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25793 context_die = NULL;
25794 break;
25796 case VAR_DECL:
25797 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
25798 if (local_function_static (decl))
25799 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25801 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
25802 variable declarations or definitions. */
25803 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25804 return;
25805 break;
25807 case CONST_DECL:
25808 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25809 return;
25810 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
25811 return;
25812 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
25813 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25814 break;
25816 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25817 case IMPORTED_DECL:
25818 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25819 return;
25820 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
25821 return;
25822 break;
25824 case TYPE_DECL:
25825 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
25826 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
25827 return;
25829 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
25830 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
25831 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
25832 return;
25834 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
25835 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25836 return;
25838 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
25839 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
25840 if (decl_function_context (decl))
25841 context_die = NULL;
25843 break;
25845 case NAMELIST_DECL:
25846 break;
25848 default:
25849 return;
25852 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25854 if (flag_checking)
25856 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25857 if (die)
25858 check_die (die);
25862 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
25864 static void
25865 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
25867 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25868 call_arg_locations = NULL;
25869 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
25870 call_site_count = -1;
25871 tail_call_site_count = -1;
25872 decl_loc_table->empty ();
25873 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
25876 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
25877 a lexical block. */
25879 static void
25880 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
25881 unsigned int blocknum)
25883 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
25884 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
25887 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
25888 lexical block. */
25890 static void
25891 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
25893 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
25894 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
25897 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
25898 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
25900 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
25901 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
25902 we may end up calling them anyway. */
25904 static bool
25905 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
25907 tree decl;
25908 unsigned int i;
25910 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
25911 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
25912 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
25913 return 0;
25914 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
25916 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
25917 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
25918 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
25919 return 0;
25922 return 1;
25925 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
25927 bool
25928 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
25930 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
25933 hashval_t
25934 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
25936 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
25939 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
25940 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
25941 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
25942 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
25943 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
25944 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
25945 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
25946 available unique index number. */
25948 static struct dwarf_file_data *
25949 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
25951 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
25953 if (!file_name)
25954 return NULL;
25956 dwarf_file_data **slot
25957 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
25958 INSERT);
25959 if (*slot)
25960 return *slot;
25962 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
25963 created->filename = file_name;
25964 created->emitted_number = 0;
25965 *slot = created;
25966 return created;
25969 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
25970 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
25971 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
25972 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
25973 types, which may include filenames. */
25975 static int
25976 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
25978 if (! fd->emitted_number)
25980 if (last_emitted_file)
25981 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
25982 else
25983 fd->emitted_number = 1;
25984 last_emitted_file = fd;
25986 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
25988 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
25989 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
25990 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
25991 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
25995 return fd->emitted_number;
25998 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
25999 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
26000 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
26002 static void
26003 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
26005 die_arg_entry entry;
26007 if (!die || !arg)
26008 return;
26010 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26012 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26013 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
26015 entry.die = die;
26016 entry.arg = arg;
26017 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
26020 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
26021 otherwise. */
26023 static bool
26024 generic_type_p (tree t)
26026 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
26027 return false;
26028 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
26031 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
26032 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
26033 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
26035 static void
26036 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
26038 if (!generic_type_p (t))
26039 return;
26041 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26043 if (!generic_type_instances)
26044 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
26046 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
26049 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
26050 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
26051 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
26053 static void
26054 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
26056 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26058 unsigned i, j;
26059 die_arg_entry *e;
26061 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
26062 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
26063 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
26064 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
26065 For those we try again at late-finish. */
26066 j = 0;
26067 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
26069 if (!e->die->removed
26070 && !tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
26072 dw_loc_descr_ref loc = NULL;
26073 if (! early_dwarf
26074 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
26075 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (e->arg, 2, NULL);
26076 if (loc)
26077 add_AT_loc (e->die, DW_AT_location, loc);
26078 else
26079 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
26082 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
26086 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
26087 that have been previously scheduled by
26088 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
26089 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
26091 static void
26092 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
26094 unsigned i;
26095 tree t;
26097 if (!generic_type_instances)
26098 return;
26100 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
26101 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
26102 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
26104 generic_type_instances = NULL;
26108 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
26110 static void
26111 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
26113 dw_die_ref die;
26114 dw_attr_node *attr;
26115 const char *dname;
26117 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
26118 if (!die)
26119 return;
26121 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
26122 if (!dname)
26123 return;
26125 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
26126 if (attr)
26128 struct indirect_string_node *node;
26130 node = find_AT_string (dname);
26131 /* replace the string. */
26132 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
26135 else
26136 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
26139 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
26140 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
26141 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
26142 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
26143 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
26144 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
26145 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
26147 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
26148 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
26149 our lookup table. */
26151 static void
26152 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
26154 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
26155 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
26156 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
26157 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
26158 static const char *last_label;
26159 static const char *last_postcall_label;
26160 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
26161 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
26162 tree decl;
26163 bool var_loc_p;
26165 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
26167 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
26169 call_site_count++;
26170 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26171 tail_call_site_count++;
26172 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
26174 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
26175 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
26176 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
26177 sites for them anyway. */
26178 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
26179 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
26180 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
26181 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
26182 x = SET_SRC (x);
26183 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
26184 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26185 if (!MEM_P (x)
26186 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
26187 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26188 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
26189 != FUNCTION_DECL))
26191 call_insn = loc_note;
26192 loc_note = NULL;
26193 var_loc_p = false;
26195 next_real = next_real_insn (call_insn);
26196 next_note = NULL;
26197 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26198 goto create_label;
26202 return;
26205 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
26206 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
26207 return;
26209 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
26210 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
26211 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
26212 calculation for next time. */
26213 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
26214 if (next_real)
26216 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
26217 next_real = NULL;
26220 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
26221 if (! next_note
26222 || next_note->deleted ()
26223 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
26224 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
26225 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
26226 next_note = NULL;
26228 if (! next_real)
26229 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
26231 if (next_note)
26233 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
26234 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
26236 else
26237 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
26239 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
26240 don't do anything. */
26241 if (var_loc_p
26242 && next_real == NULL_RTX
26243 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26244 return;
26246 create_label:
26248 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
26249 next_real = get_last_insn ();
26251 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
26252 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
26253 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
26254 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
26255 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
26256 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
26258 last_label = NULL;
26259 last_postcall_label = NULL;
26262 if (var_loc_p)
26264 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
26265 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
26266 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
26267 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
26268 if (newloc == NULL)
26269 return;
26271 else
26273 decl = NULL_TREE;
26274 newloc = NULL;
26277 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
26278 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
26279 create a new label and emit it. */
26280 if (last_label == NULL)
26282 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26283 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
26284 loclabel_num++;
26285 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26286 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
26287 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
26288 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
26289 && in_first_function_p
26290 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
26292 static rtx_insn *last_start;
26293 rtx_insn *insn;
26294 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
26295 if (insn == last_start)
26296 break;
26297 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
26298 continue;
26299 else
26301 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
26302 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
26303 continue;
26304 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
26305 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
26306 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
26307 continue;
26308 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
26309 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
26310 continue;
26311 #endif
26312 else
26314 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
26315 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26316 break;
26319 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
26321 last_start = loc_note;
26322 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
26327 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
26328 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
26330 if (!var_loc_p)
26332 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
26333 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
26334 rtx_insn *prev
26335 = loc_note != NULL_RTX ? prev_real_insn (loc_note) : call_insn;
26337 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
26338 ca_loc->next = NULL;
26339 ca_loc->label = last_label;
26340 gcc_assert (prev
26341 && (CALL_P (prev)
26342 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
26343 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
26344 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
26345 if (!CALL_P (prev))
26346 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
26347 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
26349 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
26350 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
26351 if (x)
26353 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
26354 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
26355 x = XEXP (x, 0);
26356 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
26357 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
26358 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
26359 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26360 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
26361 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
26362 declaration. */
26363 else if (MEM_P (x)
26364 && MEM_EXPR (x)
26365 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26366 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
26369 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
26370 if (call_arg_locations)
26371 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
26372 else
26373 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
26374 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
26376 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
26377 newloc->label = last_label;
26378 else
26380 if (!last_postcall_label)
26382 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
26383 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
26385 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
26388 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
26389 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
26392 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
26393 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
26394 structures. */
26396 static void
26397 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
26399 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
26402 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
26405 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
26407 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
26408 if (list->first)
26409 list->last_before_switch
26410 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
26411 return 1;
26414 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
26416 static void
26417 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
26419 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
26420 return;
26422 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
26425 /* Create a new line number table. */
26427 static dw_line_info_table *
26428 new_line_info_table (void)
26430 dw_line_info_table *table;
26432 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
26433 table->file_num = 1;
26434 table->line_num = 1;
26435 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
26437 return table;
26440 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
26441 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
26443 static void
26444 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
26446 dw_line_info_table *table;
26448 if (sec == text_section)
26449 table = text_section_line_info;
26450 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
26452 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
26453 if (!table)
26455 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
26456 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
26459 else
26461 const char *end_label;
26463 if (crtl->has_bb_partition)
26465 if (in_cold_section_p)
26466 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
26467 else
26468 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
26470 else
26472 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26473 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
26474 current_function_funcdef_no);
26475 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
26478 table = new_line_info_table ();
26479 table->end_label = end_label;
26481 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
26484 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26485 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
26486 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
26487 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
26488 cur_line_info_table = table;
26492 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
26493 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
26494 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
26495 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
26497 static void
26498 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
26500 section *sec = function_section (fun);
26502 if (sec != text_section)
26503 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26505 if (crtl->has_bb_partition && !cold_text_section)
26507 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
26508 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
26509 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
26510 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
26511 switch_to_section (sec);
26514 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
26515 call_site_count = 0;
26516 tail_call_site_count = 0;
26518 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
26521 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
26522 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
26523 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
26524 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
26525 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
26526 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
26527 list terminator.
26528 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
26529 terminate htab traversal. */
26532 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
26534 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
26535 struct var_loc_node *node;
26537 node = entry->first;
26538 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
26540 unsigned int i;
26541 const char *label = node->next->label;
26542 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26544 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
26546 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
26547 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
26549 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
26550 return 0;
26554 return 1;
26557 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
26558 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
26560 static void
26561 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
26563 if (in_first_function_p
26564 && !have_multiple_function_sections
26565 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
26566 && decl_loc_table)
26567 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
26568 in_first_function_p = false;
26569 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
26572 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
26573 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
26574 called. */
26575 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
26577 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
26578 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
26580 static void
26581 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
26583 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
26584 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
26585 main_translation_unit = unit;
26586 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
26587 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
26588 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
26589 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
26592 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
26594 static void
26595 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
26596 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
26598 dw_line_info_entry e;
26599 e.opcode = opcode;
26600 e.val = val;
26601 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
26604 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
26605 and record information relating to this source line, in
26606 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
26607 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
26609 static void
26610 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, unsigned int column,
26611 const char *filename,
26612 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
26614 unsigned int file_num;
26615 dw_line_info_table *table;
26617 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
26618 return;
26620 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
26621 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
26622 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
26623 discriminator = 0;
26625 if (!debug_column_info)
26626 column = 0;
26628 table = cur_line_info_table;
26629 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
26631 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
26632 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
26633 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
26634 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
26635 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
26636 that second line number entry. */
26637 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
26638 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
26639 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
26640 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
26641 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
26642 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
26643 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
26645 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
26646 && line == table->line_num
26647 && column == table->column_num
26648 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
26649 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
26650 return;
26652 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26654 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
26655 if (flag_debug_asm)
26657 if (debug_column_info)
26658 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26659 filename, line, column);
26660 else
26661 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
26662 filename, line);
26665 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
26667 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
26668 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
26669 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
26670 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
26671 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
26672 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26673 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
26674 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
26675 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, column);
26677 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26679 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
26680 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
26682 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
26684 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
26685 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
26686 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
26688 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26690 else
26692 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
26694 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
26696 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
26697 if (file_num != table->file_num)
26698 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
26699 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
26700 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
26701 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
26702 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
26703 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
26704 if (debug_column_info)
26705 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_column, column);
26708 table->file_num = file_num;
26709 table->line_num = line;
26710 table->column_num = column;
26711 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
26712 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
26713 table->in_use = true;
26716 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
26718 static void
26719 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
26721 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26723 macinfo_entry e;
26724 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
26725 e.lineno = lineno;
26726 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
26727 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26731 /* Record the end of a source file. */
26733 static void
26734 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26736 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26738 macinfo_entry e;
26739 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
26740 e.lineno = lineno;
26741 e.info = NULL;
26742 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26746 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26747 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26748 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26750 static void
26751 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26752 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26754 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26756 macinfo_entry e;
26757 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26758 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26759 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26761 e.code = 0;
26762 e.lineno = 0;
26763 e.info = NULL;
26764 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26766 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
26767 e.lineno = lineno;
26768 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26769 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26773 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
26774 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
26775 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
26777 static void
26778 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26779 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
26781 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
26783 macinfo_entry e;
26784 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
26785 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
26786 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
26788 e.code = 0;
26789 e.lineno = 0;
26790 e.info = NULL;
26791 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26793 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
26794 e.lineno = lineno;
26795 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
26796 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
26800 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
26802 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
26804 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
26805 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
26808 inline hashval_t
26809 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
26811 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
26814 inline bool
26815 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
26816 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
26818 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
26821 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
26823 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
26825 static void
26826 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
26828 int file_num;
26829 size_t len;
26830 struct indirect_string_node *node;
26831 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
26832 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
26834 switch (ref->code)
26836 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
26837 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
26838 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
26839 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
26840 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
26841 "Included from line number %lu",
26842 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26843 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
26844 break;
26845 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
26846 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
26847 break;
26848 case DW_MACINFO_define:
26849 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
26850 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
26851 if (!dwarf_strict
26852 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
26853 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
26854 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
26856 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
26857 ? DW_MACRO_define_strp : DW_MACRO_undef_strp;
26858 output_macinfo_op (ref);
26859 return;
26861 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
26862 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
26863 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
26864 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
26865 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26866 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
26867 break;
26868 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
26869 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
26870 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
26871 gcc_assert (node
26872 && (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
26873 || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index));
26874 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
26875 ref->code == DW_MACRO_define_strp
26876 ? "Define macro strp"
26877 : "Undefine macro strp");
26878 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
26879 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
26880 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
26881 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
26882 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
26883 ref->info);
26884 else
26885 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
26886 ref->info);
26887 break;
26888 case DW_MACRO_import:
26889 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Import");
26890 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
26891 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
26892 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
26893 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
26894 break;
26895 default:
26896 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
26897 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
26898 break;
26902 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
26903 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
26904 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
26905 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
26906 a DW_MACRO_import entry referencing it.
26907 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
26909 static unsigned
26910 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
26911 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
26913 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
26914 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
26915 unsigned char checksum[16];
26916 struct md5_ctx ctx;
26917 char *grp_name, *tail;
26918 const char *base;
26919 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
26920 macinfo_entry **slot;
26922 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
26923 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
26925 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
26926 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
26927 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
26928 in some included header file. */
26929 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
26930 return 0;
26931 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
26933 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
26934 return 0;
26936 else if (first->lineno == 0)
26937 return 0;
26939 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
26940 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
26941 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
26942 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
26943 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
26944 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
26945 break;
26946 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
26947 break;
26948 else
26950 unsigned char code = cur->code;
26951 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
26952 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
26953 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
26955 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
26956 count = i - idx;
26958 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
26959 usable characters from its basename. */
26960 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
26961 base = "";
26962 else
26963 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
26964 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
26965 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
26966 encoded_filename_len++;
26967 /* Count . at the end. */
26968 if (encoded_filename_len)
26969 encoded_filename_len++;
26971 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
26972 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
26974 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
26975 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
26976 + 16 * 2 + 1);
26977 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
26978 tail = grp_name + 4;
26979 if (encoded_filename_len)
26981 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
26982 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
26983 *tail++ = base[i];
26984 *tail++ = '.';
26986 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
26987 tail += linebuf_len;
26988 *tail++ = '.';
26989 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
26990 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
26992 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_import
26993 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
26994 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
26995 inc->code = DW_MACRO_import;
26996 inc->lineno = 0;
26997 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
26998 if (!*macinfo_htab)
26999 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
27000 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
27001 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
27002 if (*slot != NULL)
27004 inc->code = 0;
27005 inc->info = NULL;
27006 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
27007 a DW_MACRO_import op. */
27008 inc = *slot;
27009 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27010 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
27011 in the second pass. */
27012 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
27014 cur->code = 0;
27015 cur->info = NULL;
27018 else
27020 *slot = inc;
27021 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
27022 output_macinfo_op (inc);
27024 return count;
27027 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
27028 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
27029 index_string is called. */
27031 static void
27032 save_macinfo_strings (void)
27034 unsigned len;
27035 unsigned i;
27036 macinfo_entry *ref;
27038 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27040 switch (ref->code)
27042 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
27043 indirect strings. */
27044 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27045 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27046 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
27047 if (!dwarf_strict
27048 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
27049 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
27050 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
27051 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27052 break;
27053 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
27054 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
27055 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
27056 break;
27057 default:
27058 break;
27063 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
27065 static void
27066 output_macinfo (const char *debug_line_label, bool early_lto_debug)
27068 unsigned i;
27069 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
27070 macinfo_entry *ref;
27071 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
27072 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
27073 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27075 if (! length)
27076 return;
27078 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
27079 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_define
27080 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_undef
27081 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_start_file
27082 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_end_file);
27084 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
27085 offset expected by debuggers. */
27086 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_label);
27087 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
27088 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
27090 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
27091 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27093 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27094 "DWARF macro version number");
27095 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27096 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
27097 else
27098 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
27099 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_label,
27100 debug_line_section, NULL);
27103 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
27104 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
27105 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
27106 DW_MACRO_import, the DW_MACRO_import op is emitted and kept in
27107 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
27108 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
27109 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27111 switch (ref->code)
27113 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
27114 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
27115 break;
27116 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
27117 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
27118 files->pop ();
27119 break;
27120 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27121 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27122 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
27123 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
27124 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
27125 && i > 0
27126 && i + 1 < length
27127 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
27129 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
27130 if (count)
27132 i += count - 1;
27133 continue;
27136 break;
27137 case 0:
27138 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
27139 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
27140 if (i == 0)
27141 continue;
27142 default:
27143 break;
27145 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27146 ref->info = NULL;
27147 ref->code = 0;
27150 if (!macinfo_htab)
27151 return;
27153 /* Save the number of transparent includes so we can adjust the
27154 label number for the fat LTO object DWARF. */
27155 unsigned macinfo_label_base_adj = macinfo_htab->elements ();
27157 delete macinfo_htab;
27158 macinfo_htab = NULL;
27160 /* If any DW_MACRO_import were used, on those DW_MACRO_import entries
27161 terminate the current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
27162 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
27163 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
27164 switch (ref->code)
27166 case 0:
27167 continue;
27168 case DW_MACRO_import:
27170 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27171 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
27172 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
27173 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
27174 targetm.asm_out.named_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27175 SECTION_DEBUG
27176 | SECTION_LINKONCE
27177 | (early_lto_debug
27178 ? SECTION_EXCLUDE : 0),
27179 comdat_key);
27180 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
27181 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
27182 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
27183 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
27184 ref->code = 0;
27185 ref->info = NULL;
27186 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
27187 "DWARF macro version number");
27188 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
27189 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
27190 else
27191 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
27193 break;
27194 case DW_MACINFO_define:
27195 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
27196 output_macinfo_op (ref);
27197 ref->code = 0;
27198 ref->info = NULL;
27199 break;
27200 default:
27201 gcc_unreachable ();
27204 macinfo_label_base += macinfo_label_base_adj;
27207 /* Initialize the various sections and labels for dwarf output and prefix
27208 them with PREFIX if non-NULL. */
27210 static void
27211 init_sections_and_labels (bool early_lto_debug)
27213 /* As we may get called multiple times have a generation count for
27214 labels. */
27215 static unsigned generation = 0;
27217 if (early_lto_debug)
27219 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27221 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27222 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27223 NULL);
27224 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27225 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27226 NULL);
27227 debug_macinfo_section_name
27228 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27229 ? DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION);
27230 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27231 SECTION_DEBUG
27232 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27233 /* For macro info we have to refer to a debug_line section, so
27234 similar to split-dwarf emit a skeleton one for early debug. */
27235 debug_skeleton_line_section
27236 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27237 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27238 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27239 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27240 generation);
27242 else
27244 /* ??? Which of the following do we need early? */
27245 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27246 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27247 NULL);
27248 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27249 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27250 NULL);
27251 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
27252 SECTION_DEBUG
27253 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27254 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section
27255 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27256 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27257 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27258 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27259 generation);
27261 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27262 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split
27263 off dwo. */
27264 debug_skeleton_line_section
27265 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
27266 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27267 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27268 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27269 generation);
27270 debug_str_offsets_section
27271 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27272 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27273 NULL);
27274 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27275 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27276 generation);
27277 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27278 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27279 NULL);
27280 debug_macinfo_section_name
27281 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27282 ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27283 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27284 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27285 NULL);
27287 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION,
27288 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
27289 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27290 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27291 debug_line_str_section
27292 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27293 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27295 else
27297 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27299 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27300 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27301 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27302 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27303 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27304 ? DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27305 : DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
27306 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27307 debug_macinfo_section_name
27308 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27309 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION);
27310 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27311 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27313 else
27315 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
27316 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27317 NULL);
27318 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
27319 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27320 NULL);
27321 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
27322 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27323 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
27324 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27325 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
27326 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27327 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
27328 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
27329 generation);
27331 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
27332 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the
27333 split off dwo. */
27334 debug_skeleton_line_section
27335 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
27336 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27337 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
27338 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
27339 generation);
27340 debug_str_offsets_section
27341 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
27342 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
27343 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
27344 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
27345 generation);
27346 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27347 ? DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
27348 : DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
27349 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27350 NULL);
27351 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
27352 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
27353 NULL);
27354 debug_macinfo_section_name
27355 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27356 ? DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
27357 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
27358 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
27359 NULL);
27361 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
27362 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27363 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
27364 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27365 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
27366 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27367 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
27368 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27369 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
27370 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27371 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27372 debug_line_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION,
27373 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
27374 debug_ranges_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
27375 ? DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
27376 : DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
27377 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27378 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
27379 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
27382 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
27383 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27384 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
27385 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27386 info_section_emitted = false;
27387 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
27388 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27389 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
27390 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27391 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
27392 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_base_label,
27393 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 2 + generation);
27394 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
27395 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27396 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
27397 (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
27398 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
27399 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
27400 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL,
27401 generation);
27403 ++generation;
27406 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
27408 static void
27409 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27411 /* Allocate the file_table. */
27412 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
27414 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27415 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
27416 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27418 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
27419 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27421 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
27422 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27424 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
27425 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
27427 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
27428 vec_alloc (abbrev_die_table, 256);
27429 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
27430 abbrev_die_table->quick_push (NULL);
27432 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
27433 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
27435 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
27436 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
27437 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
27439 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
27441 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
27443 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27444 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
27445 #endif
27447 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
27448 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
27449 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
27450 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
27453 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
27454 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
27456 static void
27457 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
27459 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27460 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27461 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
27462 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
27463 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
27464 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
27466 switch_to_section (text_section);
27467 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
27468 #endif
27470 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
27471 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
27472 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
27474 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
27475 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
27476 #endif
27478 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
27479 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
27480 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
27481 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
27482 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
27485 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27486 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
27487 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
27488 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
27489 in the same order for each run. */
27492 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
27494 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27496 find_string_form (node);
27497 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27499 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
27500 node->index = *index;
27501 *index += 1;
27503 return 1;
27506 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
27507 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
27508 current offset. */
27511 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
27513 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27515 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27517 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
27518 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27519 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
27520 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
27521 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
27522 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
27524 return 1;
27527 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27528 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
27531 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
27533 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27535 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
27537 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
27538 indexes were assigned. */
27539 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
27540 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27541 *cur_idx += 1;
27543 return 1;
27546 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
27547 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
27550 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, enum dwarf_form form)
27552 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
27554 node->form = find_string_form (node);
27555 if (node->form == form && node->refcount > 0)
27557 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
27558 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
27561 return 1;
27564 /* Output the indexed string table. */
27566 static void
27567 output_indirect_strings (void)
27569 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
27570 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27571 debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27572 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27573 else
27575 unsigned int offset = 0;
27576 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
27578 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
27579 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
27581 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
27582 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
27583 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
27584 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
27585 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
27586 (&cur_idx);
27590 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
27591 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
27594 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
27596 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
27598 if (entry->refcount == 0)
27600 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
27601 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
27602 return 1;
27605 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
27606 (*cur_index)++;
27608 switch (entry->kind)
27610 case ate_kind_rtx:
27611 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
27612 "0x%x", entry->index);
27613 break;
27614 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
27615 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
27616 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
27617 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
27618 entry->addr.rtl);
27619 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27620 break;
27621 case ate_kind_label:
27622 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
27623 "0x%x", entry->index);
27624 break;
27625 default:
27626 gcc_unreachable ();
27628 return 1;
27631 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
27633 static void
27634 output_addr_table (void)
27636 unsigned int index = 0;
27637 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
27638 return;
27640 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
27641 addr_index_table
27642 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
27645 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
27646 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
27648 static void
27649 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
27651 dw_die_ref c;
27653 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
27654 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
27656 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
27658 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
27659 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
27661 static void
27662 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27664 dw_die_ref c;
27666 if (die->die_mark)
27667 die->die_mark = 0;
27668 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
27671 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
27672 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
27674 static void
27675 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
27677 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
27678 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
27680 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
27681 case DW_OP_convert:
27682 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
27683 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
27684 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
27685 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
27686 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
27687 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27688 break;
27689 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
27690 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
27692 dw_die_ref ref
27693 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
27694 if (ref == NULL)
27695 break;
27696 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
27697 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
27698 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
27700 /* FALLTHRU */
27701 case DW_OP_call2:
27702 case DW_OP_call4:
27703 case DW_OP_call_ref:
27704 case DW_OP_const_type:
27705 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
27706 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
27707 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27708 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27709 break;
27710 case DW_OP_regval_type:
27711 case DW_OP_deref_type:
27712 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
27713 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
27714 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
27715 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27716 break;
27717 case DW_OP_entry_value:
27718 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
27719 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
27720 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
27721 break;
27722 default:
27723 break;
27727 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
27728 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
27730 static void
27731 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
27733 dw_attr_node *a;
27734 unsigned ix;
27736 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27738 switch (AT_class (a))
27740 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
27741 get emitted. */
27742 case dw_val_class_loc:
27743 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
27744 break;
27745 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
27746 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27747 list != NULL;
27748 list = list->dw_loc_next)
27749 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
27750 break;
27752 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
27753 /* A reference to another DIE.
27754 Make sure that it will get emitted.
27755 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
27756 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
27757 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
27758 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
27759 break;
27761 case dw_val_class_str:
27762 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
27763 accounts properly for it. */
27764 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
27765 break;
27767 default:
27768 break;
27773 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
27775 static void
27776 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
27778 dw_die_ref c;
27780 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
27781 return;
27782 c = die->die_child;
27785 if (is_template_parameter (c))
27786 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
27787 c = c->die_sib;
27788 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
27791 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
27792 to DIE's children. */
27794 static void
27795 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
27797 dw_die_ref c;
27799 if (die->die_mark == 0)
27801 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
27802 die->die_mark = 1;
27803 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
27804 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
27805 args. */
27806 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
27808 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
27809 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
27810 unless it is a class.) */
27811 if (die->die_parent)
27812 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
27813 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
27815 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
27816 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
27818 /* If this node is a specification,
27819 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
27820 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
27821 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
27824 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
27826 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
27827 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
27828 die->die_mark = 2;
27830 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
27831 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
27832 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
27833 for all type definitions. */
27834 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
27835 || (use_debug_types
27836 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
27837 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
27838 else
27839 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
27843 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
27844 and if so, mark them. */
27846 static void
27847 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
27849 dw_die_ref c;
27851 if (die->die_mark == 2)
27852 return;
27854 switch (die->die_tag)
27856 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
27857 case DW_TAG_union_type:
27858 case DW_TAG_class_type:
27859 break;
27861 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
27862 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
27863 || die->die_definition != NULL)
27864 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
27865 return;
27867 default:
27868 return;
27871 /* Mark children. */
27872 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
27875 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
27877 static void
27878 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
27880 dw_die_ref c;
27882 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
27883 children have been marked as well. */
27884 if (die->die_mark == 2)
27885 return;
27887 switch (die->die_tag)
27889 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
27890 case DW_TAG_union_type:
27891 case DW_TAG_class_type:
27892 if (die->die_perennial_p)
27893 break;
27895 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
27896 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
27897 break;
27899 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
27900 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
27901 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
27902 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
27903 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
27904 if (c)
27905 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
27907 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
27908 return;
27910 case DW_TAG_const_type:
27911 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
27912 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
27913 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
27914 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
27915 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
27916 case DW_TAG_typedef:
27917 case DW_TAG_array_type:
27918 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
27919 case DW_TAG_friend:
27920 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
27921 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
27922 case DW_TAG_string_type:
27923 case DW_TAG_set_type:
27924 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
27925 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
27926 case DW_TAG_file_type:
27927 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
27928 mark them. */
27929 /* FALLTHROUGH */
27931 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
27932 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
27934 if (die->die_perennial_p)
27935 break;
27937 return;
27939 default:
27940 /* Mark everything else. */
27941 break;
27944 if (die->die_mark == 0)
27946 die->die_mark = 1;
27948 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
27949 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
27952 die->die_mark = 2;
27954 /* Mark children. */
27955 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
27958 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
27959 attributes. */
27961 static void
27962 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
27964 dw_attr_node *a;
27965 unsigned ix;
27967 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27968 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
27970 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
27971 s->refcount++;
27972 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
27973 twice in the hash table. */
27974 if (s->refcount
27975 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
27977 indirect_string_node **slot
27978 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
27979 htab_hash_string (s->str),
27980 INSERT);
27981 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
27982 *slot = s;
27987 /* Mark DIE and its children as removed. */
27989 static void
27990 mark_removed (dw_die_ref die)
27992 dw_die_ref c;
27993 die->removed = true;
27994 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_removed (c));
27997 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
27999 static void
28000 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
28002 dw_die_ref c;
28004 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
28005 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
28007 if (! die->die_child)
28008 return;
28010 c = die->die_child;
28011 do {
28012 dw_die_ref prev = c, next;
28013 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = next)
28014 if (c == die->die_child)
28016 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
28017 if (prev == c)
28018 /* No marked children at all. */
28019 die->die_child = NULL;
28020 else
28022 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28023 die->die_child = prev;
28025 c->die_sib = NULL;
28026 mark_removed (c);
28027 return;
28029 else
28031 next = c->die_sib;
28032 c->die_sib = NULL;
28033 mark_removed (c);
28036 if (c != prev->die_sib)
28037 prev->die_sib = c;
28038 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
28039 } while (c != die->die_child);
28042 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
28044 static void
28045 prune_unused_types (void)
28047 unsigned int i;
28048 limbo_die_node *node;
28049 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
28050 pubname_entry *pub;
28051 dw_die_ref base_type;
28053 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
28054 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
28055 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
28056 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28057 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
28058 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28059 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
28060 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
28062 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
28063 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
28065 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
28066 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
28067 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28068 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
28069 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28071 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
28072 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
28075 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
28076 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
28077 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
28078 not as roots in themselves. */
28079 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
28080 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
28081 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
28082 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28083 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
28085 /* For -fvar-tracking-assignments, also set the mark on nodes that could be
28086 referenced by DW_TAG_call_site DW_AT_call_origin (i.e. direct call
28087 callees). */
28088 cgraph_node *cnode;
28089 FOR_EACH_FUNCTION (cnode)
28090 if (cnode->referred_to_p (false))
28092 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (cnode->decl);
28093 if (die == NULL || die->die_mark)
28094 continue;
28095 for (cgraph_edge *e = cnode->callers; e; e = e->next_caller)
28096 if (e->caller != cnode
28097 && opt_for_fn (e->caller->decl, flag_var_tracking_assignments))
28099 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
28100 break;
28104 if (debug_str_hash)
28105 debug_str_hash->empty ();
28106 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
28107 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
28108 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
28109 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
28111 node = *pnode;
28112 if (!node->die->die_mark)
28113 *pnode = node->next;
28114 else
28116 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
28117 pnode = &node->next;
28120 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28121 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
28123 /* Leave the marks clear. */
28124 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
28125 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
28126 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
28127 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
28128 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
28131 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
28133 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
28135 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
28136 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
28139 inline hashval_t
28140 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
28142 hashval_t h;
28143 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
28144 return h;
28147 inline bool
28148 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
28149 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
28151 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
28152 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
28155 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
28156 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
28157 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
28158 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
28159 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
28160 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
28162 static inline void
28163 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
28165 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
28166 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28168 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
28169 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
28171 while (--ix > 0)
28173 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
28175 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line
28176 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_column
28177 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
28178 break;
28181 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
28183 die->die_attr->pop ();
28184 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
28188 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
28189 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
28191 static void
28192 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28194 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
28196 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28198 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28200 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28201 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28202 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28203 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28204 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28205 break;
28206 case DW_OP_convert:
28207 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28208 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28209 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28210 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28211 continue;
28212 /* FALLTHRU */
28213 case DW_OP_const_type:
28214 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28215 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28216 break;
28217 case DW_OP_entry_value:
28218 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
28219 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
28220 continue;
28221 default:
28222 continue;
28224 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
28225 if (base_type->die_mark)
28226 base_type->die_mark++;
28227 else
28229 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
28230 base_type->die_mark = 1;
28235 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
28237 static int
28238 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
28240 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
28241 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
28242 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
28243 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
28244 unsigned int align1, align2;
28245 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
28246 return -1;
28247 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
28248 return 1;
28249 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
28250 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
28251 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
28252 return 1;
28253 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
28254 return -1;
28255 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
28256 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
28257 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
28258 return 1;
28259 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
28260 return -1;
28261 align1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_alignment);
28262 align2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_alignment);
28263 if (align1 < align2)
28264 return 1;
28265 if (align1 > align2)
28266 return -1;
28267 return 0;
28270 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
28271 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
28272 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
28273 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
28274 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
28276 static void
28277 move_marked_base_types (void)
28279 unsigned int i;
28280 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
28282 if (base_types.is_empty ())
28283 return;
28285 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
28286 order later on. */
28287 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
28288 die = comp_unit_die ();
28289 c = die->die_child;
28292 dw_die_ref prev = c;
28293 c = c->die_sib;
28294 while (c->die_mark)
28296 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
28297 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
28298 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
28299 gcc_assert (die->die_child != NULL);
28300 c = prev->die_sib;
28303 while (c != die->die_child);
28304 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
28305 c = die->die_child;
28306 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
28308 base_type->die_mark = 0;
28309 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
28310 c->die_sib = base_type;
28311 c = base_type;
28315 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
28316 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
28317 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
28319 static bool
28320 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
28322 rtx rtl = *addr;
28324 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28326 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28327 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28328 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28329 TREE_TYPE (t)
28330 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28331 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
28332 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28333 return false;
28334 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28335 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28336 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
28337 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28338 return false;
28339 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28340 *addr = rtl;
28341 return true;
28344 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
28345 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28347 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
28349 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
28350 return false;
28352 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
28353 return false;
28356 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
28358 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
28359 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
28360 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
28361 return false;
28364 return true;
28367 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
28368 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
28369 from DW_OP_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
28371 static rtx
28372 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
28374 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
28375 unsigned char *array;
28376 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28377 tree decl;
28378 size_t len;
28379 dw_die_ref ref;
28381 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
28382 return NULL_RTX;
28383 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
28384 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
28385 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
28386 return NULL_RTX;
28388 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28389 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
28391 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
28392 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
28393 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
28394 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
28395 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
28396 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
28397 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
28398 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
28399 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
28400 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
28401 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
28402 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
28404 return rtl;
28407 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
28408 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
28409 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
28410 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
28411 with DW_OP_implicit_pointer if possible
28412 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
28414 static bool
28415 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28417 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
28418 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28419 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
28420 tree decl;
28422 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
28423 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
28424 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
28426 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
28427 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
28429 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
28431 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
28432 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
28433 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
28435 TREE_TYPE (t)
28436 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
28437 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
28438 if (!rtl)
28439 return false;
28441 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
28443 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28444 if (VAR_P (decl) && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
28446 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28447 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28448 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28450 loc->dw_loc_opc = dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer);
28451 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28452 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
28453 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28454 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28455 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28456 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
28457 return true;
28461 return false;
28464 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
28465 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
28466 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
28468 static bool
28469 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28471 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
28472 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28473 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28475 case DW_OP_addr:
28476 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28478 if ((prev == NULL
28479 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
28480 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
28481 && loc->dw_loc_next
28482 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
28483 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28484 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
28485 break;
28486 return false;
28488 break;
28489 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
28490 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
28491 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
28492 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
28494 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
28495 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
28496 return false;
28497 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
28498 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
28499 = add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
28501 break;
28502 case DW_OP_const4u:
28503 case DW_OP_const8u:
28504 if (loc->dtprel
28505 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
28506 return false;
28507 break;
28508 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
28509 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
28510 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
28512 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
28514 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
28515 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
28516 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
28517 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
28518 *loc = *repl;
28520 break;
28521 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28522 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
28523 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
28524 return false;
28525 break;
28526 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28527 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28528 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28529 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
28530 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28532 dw_die_ref ref
28533 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
28534 if (ref == NULL)
28535 return false;
28536 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28537 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28538 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28540 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value)
28542 if (prev == NULL
28543 && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL
28544 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
28545 switch (a->dw_attr)
28547 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
28548 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28549 alone we could transform it into reference. */
28550 case DW_AT_byte_size:
28551 case DW_AT_bit_size:
28552 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
28553 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
28554 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
28555 case DW_AT_count:
28556 case DW_AT_allocated:
28557 case DW_AT_associated:
28558 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
28559 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28560 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
28561 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die
28562 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28563 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28564 return true;
28565 default:
28566 break;
28568 if (dwarf_strict)
28569 return false;
28571 break;
28572 case DW_OP_const_type:
28573 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28574 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28575 case DW_OP_convert:
28576 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28577 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28578 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28579 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28580 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28581 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28582 while (loc->dw_loc_next
28583 && (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_convert
28584 || loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert))
28586 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
28587 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
28588 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28589 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28590 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28591 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28592 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
28593 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28594 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28595 break;
28596 else
28597 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28598 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
28599 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
28600 break;
28601 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28602 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
28603 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
28604 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
28605 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
28606 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
28607 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
28608 if (size1 == size2
28609 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
28610 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
28611 && loc != keep)
28612 || enc1 == enc2))
28614 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_convert after
28615 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
28616 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
28617 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
28618 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
28619 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
28620 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28621 else
28622 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
28623 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
28624 continue;
28626 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_convert after e.g. floating
28627 point typed stack entry. */
28628 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
28629 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
28630 break;
28632 break;
28633 default:
28634 break;
28636 return true;
28639 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
28640 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
28641 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
28642 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
28643 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_implicit_pointer
28644 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
28646 static void
28647 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
28649 if (!VAR_P (decl)
28650 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
28651 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
28652 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
28653 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
28654 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
28655 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
28656 return;
28658 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
28659 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
28660 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
28661 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
28662 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
28663 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
28664 return;
28665 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28666 return;
28667 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
28668 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
28669 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
28670 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
28671 we can add DW_OP_implicit_pointer. */
28672 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28673 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
28674 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
28676 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
28677 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28678 STRIP_NOPS (init);
28680 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
28681 return;
28682 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
28683 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
28684 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
28685 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
28686 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
28688 dw_die_ref ref;
28689 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
28691 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
28693 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
28694 if (!rtl)
28695 return;
28696 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
28698 else
28699 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
28700 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28701 if (ref == NULL
28702 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
28703 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
28704 return;
28705 l = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
28706 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28707 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28708 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28709 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
28713 /* Return NULL if l is a DWARF expression, or first op that is not
28714 valid DWARF expression. */
28716 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28717 non_dwarf_expression (dw_loc_descr_ref l)
28719 while (l)
28721 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28722 return l;
28723 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28725 case DW_OP_regx:
28726 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
28727 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28728 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28729 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28730 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28731 case DW_OP_piece:
28732 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
28733 return l;
28734 default:
28735 break;
28737 l = l->dw_loc_next;
28739 return NULL;
28742 /* Return adjusted copy of EXPR:
28743 If it is empty DWARF expression, return it.
28744 If it is valid non-empty DWARF expression,
28745 return copy of EXPR with DW_OP_deref appended to it.
28746 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_reg{N,x}, return
28747 copy of the DWARF expression with DW_OP_breg{N,x} <0> appended.
28748 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_stack_value, return
28749 copy of the DWARF expression without anything appended.
28750 Otherwise, return NULL. */
28752 static dw_loc_descr_ref
28753 copy_deref_exprloc (dw_loc_descr_ref expr)
28755 dw_loc_descr_ref tail = NULL;
28757 if (expr == NULL)
28758 return NULL;
28760 dw_loc_descr_ref l = non_dwarf_expression (expr);
28761 if (l && l->dw_loc_next)
28762 return NULL;
28764 if (l)
28766 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
28767 tail = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom)
28768 (DW_OP_breg0 + (l->dw_loc_opc - DW_OP_reg0)),
28769 0, 0);
28770 else
28771 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
28773 case DW_OP_regx:
28774 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx,
28775 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned, 0);
28776 break;
28777 case DW_OP_stack_value:
28778 break;
28779 default:
28780 return NULL;
28783 else
28784 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
28786 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, *p = &ret;
28787 while (expr != l)
28789 *p = new_loc_descr (expr->dw_loc_opc, 0, 0);
28790 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd1 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd1;
28791 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd2 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd2;
28792 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
28793 expr = expr->dw_loc_next;
28795 *p = tail;
28796 return ret;
28799 /* For DW_AT_string_length attribute with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
28800 reference to a variable or argument, adjust it if needed and return:
28801 -1 if the DW_AT_string_length attribute and DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size
28802 attribute if present should be removed
28803 0 keep the attribute perhaps with minor modifications, no need to rescan
28804 1 if the attribute has been successfully adjusted. */
28806 static int
28807 optimize_string_length (dw_attr_node *a)
28809 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a), lv;
28810 dw_die_ref die;
28811 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28813 tree decl = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
28814 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
28815 if (die)
28817 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28818 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
28819 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28821 else
28822 return -1;
28824 else
28825 die = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
28827 /* DWARF5 allows reference class, so we can then reference the DIE.
28828 Only do this for DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value. */
28829 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL && dwarf_version >= 5)
28831 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28832 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
28833 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
28834 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28835 return 0;
28838 dw_attr_node *av = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
28839 dw_loc_list_ref d;
28840 bool non_dwarf_expr = false;
28842 if (av == NULL)
28843 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28844 switch (AT_class (av))
28846 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28847 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
28848 if (d->expr && non_dwarf_expression (d->expr))
28849 non_dwarf_expr = true;
28850 break;
28851 case dw_val_class_loc:
28852 lv = AT_loc (av);
28853 if (lv == NULL)
28854 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28855 if (non_dwarf_expression (lv))
28856 non_dwarf_expr = true;
28857 break;
28858 default:
28859 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28862 /* If it is safe to transform DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value
28863 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_GNU_variable_value into
28864 DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, do so. */
28865 if (!non_dwarf_expr
28866 && (l->dw_loc_next != NULL || AT_class (av) == dw_val_class_loc))
28868 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_call4;
28869 if (l->dw_loc_next)
28870 l->dw_loc_next = NULL;
28871 else
28872 l->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
28873 return 0;
28876 /* For DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value, we can just
28877 copy over the DW_AT_location attribute from die to a. */
28878 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
28880 a->dw_attr_val = av->dw_attr_val;
28881 return 1;
28884 dw_loc_list_ref list, *p;
28885 switch (AT_class (av))
28887 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28888 p = &list;
28889 list = NULL;
28890 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
28892 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (d->expr);
28893 if (lv)
28895 *p = new_loc_list (lv, d->begin, d->end, d->section);
28896 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
28898 else if (!dwarf_strict && d->expr)
28899 return 0;
28901 if (list == NULL)
28902 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28903 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
28904 gen_llsym (list);
28905 *AT_loc_list_ptr (a) = list;
28906 return 1;
28907 case dw_val_class_loc:
28908 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (AT_loc (av));
28909 if (lv == NULL)
28910 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
28911 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = lv;
28912 return 1;
28913 default:
28914 gcc_unreachable ();
28918 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
28919 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
28920 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
28921 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
28922 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
28923 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
28925 static void
28926 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
28928 dw_die_ref c;
28929 dw_attr_node *a;
28930 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
28931 unsigned ix;
28932 bool remove_AT_byte_size = false;
28934 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
28935 switch (AT_class (a))
28937 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
28938 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
28939 loc = *curr;
28940 gcc_assert (loc);
28941 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
28942 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
28943 if (loc->replaced)
28944 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
28945 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
28947 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
28948 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
28949 References must be identical or completely separate.
28950 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
28951 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
28952 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
28953 while (*curr)
28955 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
28956 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (a, (*curr)->expr))
28958 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
28959 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
28961 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
28963 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
28964 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
28966 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
28967 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
28968 *curr = next;
28970 else
28972 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
28973 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
28976 if (loc == *start)
28977 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
28978 else
28980 loc->replaced = 1;
28981 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
28984 if (!*start)
28986 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
28987 ix--;
28989 break;
28990 case dw_val_class_loc:
28992 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
28993 /* DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value or
28994 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in DW_AT_string_length can be converted
28995 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, which is standard
28996 DWARF4 unlike DW_OP_GNU_variable_value. Or for DWARF5
28997 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value can be replaced
28998 with DW_FORM_ref referencing the same DIE as
28999 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value used to reference. */
29000 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length
29001 && l
29002 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
29003 && (l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29004 || (l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next == NULL
29005 && l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value)))
29007 switch (optimize_string_length (a))
29009 case -1:
29010 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29011 ix--;
29012 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29013 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29014 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29015 continue;
29016 default:
29017 break;
29018 case 1:
29019 /* Even if we keep the optimized DW_AT_string_length,
29020 it might have changed AT_class, so process it again. */
29021 ix--;
29022 continue;
29025 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
29026 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
29027 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
29028 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
29029 but shorter, location description. */
29030 if ((dwarf_version > 2
29031 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
29032 || l == NULL
29033 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
29034 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
29035 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (a, l))
29037 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29038 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
29039 if (l != NULL
29040 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
29041 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
29042 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
29043 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
29044 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
29046 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
29047 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29048 ix--;
29049 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
29050 break;
29052 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length)
29053 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
29054 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
29055 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
29056 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29057 ix--;
29059 else
29060 mark_base_types (l);
29062 break;
29063 case dw_val_class_addr:
29064 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
29065 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
29067 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29068 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29069 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29070 ix--;
29072 if ((die->die_tag == DW_TAG_call_site
29073 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_origin)
29074 || (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
29075 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin))
29077 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
29078 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
29079 dw_die_ref cdie;
29080 if (tdie == NULL
29081 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
29082 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
29083 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
29085 dw_die_ref pdie = cdie;
29086 /* Make sure we don't add these DIEs into type units.
29087 We could emit skeleton DIEs for context (namespaces,
29088 outer structs/classes) and a skeleton DIE for the
29089 innermost context with DW_AT_signature pointing to the
29090 type unit. See PR78835. */
29091 while (pdie && pdie->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
29092 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
29093 if (pdie == NULL)
29095 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
29096 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
29097 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
29098 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
29099 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
29100 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
29101 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
29102 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
29103 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl, true);
29104 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
29107 if (tdie)
29109 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29110 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
29111 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29113 else
29115 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
29116 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
29117 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
29118 ix--;
29121 break;
29122 default:
29123 break;
29126 if (remove_AT_byte_size)
29127 remove_AT (die, dwarf_version >= 5
29128 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
29129 : DW_AT_byte_size);
29131 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
29134 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
29135 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
29136 section. */
29138 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
29140 static void
29141 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29143 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29144 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29146 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29148 case DW_OP_const4u:
29149 case DW_OP_const8u:
29150 if (loc->dtprel)
29151 goto hash_addr;
29152 /* FALLTHRU */
29153 case DW_OP_const1u:
29154 case DW_OP_const1s:
29155 case DW_OP_const2u:
29156 case DW_OP_const2s:
29157 case DW_OP_const4s:
29158 case DW_OP_const8s:
29159 case DW_OP_constu:
29160 case DW_OP_consts:
29161 case DW_OP_pick:
29162 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29163 case DW_OP_breg0:
29164 case DW_OP_breg1:
29165 case DW_OP_breg2:
29166 case DW_OP_breg3:
29167 case DW_OP_breg4:
29168 case DW_OP_breg5:
29169 case DW_OP_breg6:
29170 case DW_OP_breg7:
29171 case DW_OP_breg8:
29172 case DW_OP_breg9:
29173 case DW_OP_breg10:
29174 case DW_OP_breg11:
29175 case DW_OP_breg12:
29176 case DW_OP_breg13:
29177 case DW_OP_breg14:
29178 case DW_OP_breg15:
29179 case DW_OP_breg16:
29180 case DW_OP_breg17:
29181 case DW_OP_breg18:
29182 case DW_OP_breg19:
29183 case DW_OP_breg20:
29184 case DW_OP_breg21:
29185 case DW_OP_breg22:
29186 case DW_OP_breg23:
29187 case DW_OP_breg24:
29188 case DW_OP_breg25:
29189 case DW_OP_breg26:
29190 case DW_OP_breg27:
29191 case DW_OP_breg28:
29192 case DW_OP_breg29:
29193 case DW_OP_breg30:
29194 case DW_OP_breg31:
29195 case DW_OP_regx:
29196 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29197 case DW_OP_piece:
29198 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29199 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29200 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29201 break;
29202 case DW_OP_skip:
29203 case DW_OP_bra:
29205 int offset;
29207 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
29208 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
29209 hstate.add_object (offset);
29211 break;
29212 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29213 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29214 switch (val2->val_class)
29216 case dw_val_class_const:
29217 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29218 break;
29219 case dw_val_class_vec:
29221 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29222 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29224 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
29225 hstate.add_int (len);
29226 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29228 break;
29229 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29230 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29231 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29232 break;
29233 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29234 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29235 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29236 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29237 break;
29238 case dw_val_class_addr:
29239 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
29240 break;
29241 default:
29242 gcc_unreachable ();
29244 break;
29245 case DW_OP_bregx:
29246 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29247 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29248 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29249 break;
29250 case DW_OP_addr:
29251 hash_addr:
29252 if (loc->dtprel)
29254 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29255 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29257 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
29258 break;
29259 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29260 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29262 if (loc->dtprel)
29264 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
29265 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
29267 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
29269 break;
29270 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29271 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29272 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
29273 break;
29274 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29275 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29276 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
29277 break;
29278 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29279 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29280 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29281 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29283 unsigned int byte_size
29284 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29285 unsigned int encoding
29286 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29287 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
29288 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29289 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29291 break;
29292 case DW_OP_convert:
29293 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29294 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29295 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29296 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29298 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
29299 break;
29301 /* FALLTHRU */
29302 case DW_OP_const_type:
29303 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29305 unsigned int byte_size
29306 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
29307 unsigned int encoding
29308 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
29309 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
29310 hstate.add_object (encoding);
29311 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_const_type
29312 && loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
29313 break;
29314 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
29315 switch (val2->val_class)
29317 case dw_val_class_const:
29318 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
29319 break;
29320 case dw_val_class_vec:
29322 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
29323 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
29325 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
29326 hstate.add_object (len);
29327 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
29329 break;
29330 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29331 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
29332 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
29333 break;
29334 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29335 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
29336 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
29337 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
29338 break;
29339 default:
29340 gcc_unreachable ();
29343 break;
29345 default:
29346 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29347 break;
29351 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
29353 static inline void
29354 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
29356 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29357 bool sizes_computed = false;
29358 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
29359 size_of_locs (loc);
29361 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
29363 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
29364 hstate.add_object (opc);
29365 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
29367 size_of_locs (loc);
29368 sizes_computed = true;
29370 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
29374 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
29376 static inline void
29377 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
29379 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
29380 inchash::hash hstate;
29382 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29384 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
29385 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
29386 if (curr->section)
29387 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
29388 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
29390 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
29393 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
29395 static inline bool
29396 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29398 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29399 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29400 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
29401 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
29403 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
29405 case DW_OP_const4u:
29406 case DW_OP_const8u:
29407 if (x->dtprel)
29408 goto hash_addr;
29409 /* FALLTHRU */
29410 case DW_OP_const1u:
29411 case DW_OP_const1s:
29412 case DW_OP_const2u:
29413 case DW_OP_const2s:
29414 case DW_OP_const4s:
29415 case DW_OP_const8s:
29416 case DW_OP_constu:
29417 case DW_OP_consts:
29418 case DW_OP_pick:
29419 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29420 case DW_OP_breg0:
29421 case DW_OP_breg1:
29422 case DW_OP_breg2:
29423 case DW_OP_breg3:
29424 case DW_OP_breg4:
29425 case DW_OP_breg5:
29426 case DW_OP_breg6:
29427 case DW_OP_breg7:
29428 case DW_OP_breg8:
29429 case DW_OP_breg9:
29430 case DW_OP_breg10:
29431 case DW_OP_breg11:
29432 case DW_OP_breg12:
29433 case DW_OP_breg13:
29434 case DW_OP_breg14:
29435 case DW_OP_breg15:
29436 case DW_OP_breg16:
29437 case DW_OP_breg17:
29438 case DW_OP_breg18:
29439 case DW_OP_breg19:
29440 case DW_OP_breg20:
29441 case DW_OP_breg21:
29442 case DW_OP_breg22:
29443 case DW_OP_breg23:
29444 case DW_OP_breg24:
29445 case DW_OP_breg25:
29446 case DW_OP_breg26:
29447 case DW_OP_breg27:
29448 case DW_OP_breg28:
29449 case DW_OP_breg29:
29450 case DW_OP_breg30:
29451 case DW_OP_breg31:
29452 case DW_OP_regx:
29453 case DW_OP_fbreg:
29454 case DW_OP_piece:
29455 case DW_OP_deref_size:
29456 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
29457 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
29458 case DW_OP_skip:
29459 case DW_OP_bra:
29460 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
29461 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
29462 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29463 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
29464 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
29465 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
29466 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
29467 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29468 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
29469 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29470 return false;
29471 switch (valx2->val_class)
29473 case dw_val_class_const:
29474 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29475 case dw_val_class_vec:
29476 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29477 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29478 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29479 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29480 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29481 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29482 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29483 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29484 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29485 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29486 case dw_val_class_addr:
29487 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
29488 default:
29489 gcc_unreachable ();
29491 case DW_OP_bregx:
29492 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
29493 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29494 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29495 case DW_OP_addr:
29496 hash_addr:
29497 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
29498 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29499 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29501 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29502 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
29503 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
29505 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29506 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29507 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29508 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29509 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29510 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29511 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29512 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29513 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
29514 case DW_OP_const_type:
29515 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29516 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
29517 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
29518 return false;
29519 switch (valx2->val_class)
29521 case dw_val_class_const:
29522 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
29523 case dw_val_class_vec:
29524 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29525 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
29526 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
29527 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
29528 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
29529 case dw_val_class_const_double:
29530 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
29531 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
29532 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
29533 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
29534 default:
29535 gcc_unreachable ();
29537 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29538 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29539 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29540 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29541 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
29542 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
29543 case DW_OP_convert:
29544 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29545 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29546 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29547 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
29548 return false;
29549 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29550 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
29551 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29552 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29553 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
29554 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
29555 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
29556 default:
29557 /* Other codes have no operands. */
29558 return true;
29562 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
29564 static inline bool
29565 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
29567 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
29568 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
29569 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
29570 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
29571 break;
29572 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
29575 /* Hashtable helpers. */
29577 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
29579 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29580 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
29581 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
29584 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
29586 inline hashval_t
29587 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
29589 return x->hash;
29592 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
29594 inline bool
29595 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
29596 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
29598 if (a == b)
29599 return 1;
29600 if (a->hash != b->hash)
29601 return 0;
29602 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
29603 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
29604 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
29605 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
29606 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
29607 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
29608 break;
29609 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
29612 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
29615 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29616 children and share them whenever possible. */
29618 static void
29619 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
29621 dw_die_ref c;
29622 dw_attr_node *a;
29623 unsigned ix;
29624 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
29626 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29627 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29629 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29630 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
29631 it and storing into the hash table. */
29632 hash_loc_list (list);
29633 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
29634 if (*slot == NULL)
29635 *slot = list;
29636 else
29637 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
29640 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
29644 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
29645 section. */
29647 static void
29648 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29650 dw_die_ref c;
29651 dw_attr_node *a;
29652 unsigned ix;
29654 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29655 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
29657 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29658 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
29659 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
29661 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
29662 or won't be output. */
29663 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
29664 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
29665 continue;
29667 curr->begin_entry
29668 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin), ate_kind_label);
29672 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
29675 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
29676 children and share them whenever possible. */
29678 static void
29679 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
29681 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
29682 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
29685 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
29686 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
29687 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
29688 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
29689 instance. */
29691 static void
29692 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
29694 limbo_die_node *node;
29696 /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
29697 limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
29698 partition than that of their parent function. */
29699 while ((node = limbo_die_list))
29701 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
29702 limbo_die_list = node->next;
29704 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
29706 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
29708 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
29709 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
29710 else if (is_cu_die (die))
29712 else if (seen_error ())
29713 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
29714 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
29715 else
29717 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
29718 nested function can be optimized away, which results
29719 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
29720 with the return type of that nested function. Force
29721 this to be a child of the containing function.
29723 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
29724 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
29725 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
29726 the function is likely unreachable too. */
29727 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
29729 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
29730 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
29731 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
29732 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
29733 else
29734 origin = comp_unit_die ();
29736 add_child_die (origin, die);
29742 /* Reset DIEs so we can output them again. */
29744 static void
29745 reset_dies (dw_die_ref die)
29747 dw_die_ref c;
29749 /* Remove stuff we re-generate. */
29750 die->die_mark = 0;
29751 die->die_offset = 0;
29752 die->die_abbrev = 0;
29753 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_sibling);
29755 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, reset_dies (c));
29758 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
29759 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
29761 static void
29762 dwarf2out_finish (const char *)
29764 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
29765 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
29766 unsigned char checksum[16];
29767 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
29769 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
29770 flush_limbo_die_list ();
29772 if (flag_checking)
29774 verify_die (comp_unit_die ());
29775 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29776 verify_die (node->die);
29779 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
29780 DIEs generated after early finish. */
29781 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
29783 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
29785 if (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload)
29787 gcc_assert (flag_fat_lto_objects || flag_generate_offload);
29789 /* Prune stuff so that dwarf2out_finish runs successfully
29790 for the fat part of the object. */
29791 reset_dies (comp_unit_die ());
29792 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29793 reset_dies (node->die);
29795 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
29796 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29798 comdat_type_node **slot
29799 = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
29801 /* Don't reset types twice. */
29802 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
29803 continue;
29805 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
29806 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
29807 attributes. */
29808 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
29809 reset_dies (ctnode->root_die);
29811 *slot = ctnode;
29814 /* Reset die CU symbol so we don't output it twice. */
29815 comp_unit_die ()->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
29817 /* Remove DW_AT_macro from the early output. */
29818 if (have_macinfo)
29819 remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE);
29821 /* Remove indirect string decisions. */
29822 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
29825 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
29827 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
29828 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
29830 #endif
29831 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
29832 move_marked_base_types ();
29834 /* Initialize sections and labels used for actual assembler output. */
29835 init_sections_and_labels (false);
29837 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
29838 have children. */
29839 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
29840 limbo_die_node *node;
29841 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29842 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
29843 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29844 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
29846 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
29847 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
29848 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
29849 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29851 limbo_die_node *cu;
29852 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
29853 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
29854 main_comp_unit_die->die_tag = DW_TAG_skeleton_unit;
29855 cu = limbo_die_list;
29856 gcc_assert (cu->die == main_comp_unit_die);
29857 limbo_die_list = limbo_die_list->next;
29858 cu->next = cu_die_list;
29859 cu_die_list = cu;
29861 else
29862 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
29864 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
29865 switch_to_section (text_section);
29866 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
29867 if (cold_text_section)
29869 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
29870 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
29873 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
29874 in .text. */
29875 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
29876 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
29878 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
29879 if (text_section_used)
29880 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
29881 text_end_label, true);
29883 else
29885 unsigned fde_idx;
29886 dw_fde_ref fde;
29887 bool range_list_added = false;
29889 if (text_section_used)
29890 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
29891 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
29892 if (cold_text_section_used)
29893 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
29894 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
29896 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
29898 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
29899 continue;
29900 if (!fde->in_std_section)
29901 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
29902 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
29903 true);
29904 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
29905 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
29906 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
29907 true);
29910 if (range_list_added)
29912 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
29913 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
29914 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
29915 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
29916 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
29917 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
29918 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
29919 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
29921 add_ranges (NULL);
29925 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
29926 offset expected by debuggers. */
29927 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
29928 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
29929 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
29931 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
29932 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
29933 dl_section_ref);
29935 if (have_macinfo)
29936 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
29937 macinfo_section_label);
29939 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29941 if (have_location_lists)
29943 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
29944 add_AT_loclistsptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_loclists_base,
29945 loc_section_label);
29946 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
29947 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
29948 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
29949 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
29950 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
29951 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
29954 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
29956 unsigned int index = 0;
29957 addr_index_table
29958 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
29959 (&index);
29963 loc_list_idx = 0;
29964 if (have_location_lists)
29966 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
29967 /* And finally assign indexes to the entries for -gsplit-dwarf. */
29968 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
29969 assign_location_list_indexes (comp_unit_die ());
29972 save_macinfo_strings ();
29974 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
29976 unsigned int index = 0;
29978 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
29979 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
29980 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
29981 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
29982 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
29983 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
29984 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
29987 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
29988 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
29989 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29990 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
29992 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
29993 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29995 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
29997 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
29998 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
29999 continue;
30001 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30002 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30003 attributes. */
30004 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30005 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30006 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30007 ? dl_section_ref
30008 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30010 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30011 *slot = ctnode;
30014 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30016 int mark;
30017 struct md5_ctx ctx;
30019 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && !vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30020 index_rnglists ();
30022 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
30023 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
30024 mark = 0;
30025 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
30026 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
30027 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
30029 if (dwarf_version < 5)
30031 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
30032 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
30033 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30034 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
30037 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
30038 comp-unit DIE. */
30039 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30041 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30042 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_rnglists_base,
30043 ranges_base_label);
30044 else
30045 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
30046 ranges_section_label);
30049 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
30050 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
30051 output_addr_table ();
30054 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
30055 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
30056 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo,
30057 dwarf_split_debug_info ? checksum : NULL);
30059 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30060 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die, checksum);
30062 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30063 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30065 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30066 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30067 output_abbrev_section ();
30070 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
30071 if (have_location_lists)
30073 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30074 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
30075 /* Output the location lists info. */
30076 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
30077 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30079 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 1);
30080 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
30081 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
30082 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
30083 "Initial length escape value indicating "
30084 "64-bit DWARF extension");
30085 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
30086 "Length of Location Lists");
30087 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
30088 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF Version");
30089 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
30090 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
30091 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? loc_list_idx : 0,
30092 "Offset Entry Count");
30094 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
30095 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
30097 unsigned int save_loc_list_idx = loc_list_idx;
30098 loc_list_idx = 0;
30099 output_loclists_offsets (comp_unit_die ());
30100 gcc_assert (save_loc_list_idx == loc_list_idx);
30102 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
30103 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30104 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
30107 output_pubtables ();
30109 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
30110 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
30111 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
30112 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
30113 generate a table that would have contained data. */
30114 if (info_section_emitted)
30116 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
30117 output_aranges ();
30120 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
30121 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
30123 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
30124 output_rnglists ();
30125 else
30126 output_ranges ();
30129 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30130 if (have_macinfo)
30132 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30133 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30134 output_macinfo (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
30135 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label, false);
30136 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30139 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
30140 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
30141 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
30142 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
30143 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
30144 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
30145 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
30146 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
30147 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
30148 output_line_info (false);
30150 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
30152 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30153 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30154 output_line_info (true);
30157 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30158 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30159 output_indirect_strings ();
30160 if (debug_line_str_hash)
30162 switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
30163 const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30164 debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
30165 output_indirect_string> (form);
30169 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a variable_value_struct). */
30171 inline hashval_t
30172 variable_value_hasher::hash (variable_value_struct *x)
30174 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
30177 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of variable_value_struct X is the same as
30178 UID of decl Y. */
30180 inline bool
30181 variable_value_hasher::equal (variable_value_struct *x, tree y)
30183 return x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y);
30186 /* Helper function for resolve_variable_value, handle
30187 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in one location expression.
30188 Return true if exprloc has been changed into loclist. */
30190 static bool
30191 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30193 dw_loc_descr_ref next;
30194 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = next)
30196 next = loc->dw_loc_next;
30197 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30198 || loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30199 continue;
30201 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30202 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != current_function_decl)
30203 continue;
30205 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30206 if (ref)
30208 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30209 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30210 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30211 continue;
30213 dw_loc_list_ref l = loc_list_from_tree (decl, 0, NULL);
30214 if (l == NULL)
30215 continue;
30216 if (l->dw_loc_next)
30218 if (AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
30219 continue;
30220 switch (a->dw_attr)
30222 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and loclist
30223 classes, so we can change them into a loclist. */
30224 case DW_AT_location:
30225 case DW_AT_string_length:
30226 case DW_AT_return_addr:
30227 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
30228 case DW_AT_frame_base:
30229 case DW_AT_segment:
30230 case DW_AT_static_link:
30231 case DW_AT_use_location:
30232 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
30233 if (prev)
30235 prev->dw_loc_next = NULL;
30236 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (l, AT_loc (a));
30238 if (next)
30239 add_loc_descr_to_each (l, next);
30240 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
30241 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
30242 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = l;
30243 have_location_lists = true;
30244 return true;
30245 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
30246 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value alone
30247 we could transform it into reference. */
30248 case DW_AT_byte_size:
30249 case DW_AT_bit_size:
30250 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
30251 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
30252 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
30253 case DW_AT_count:
30254 case DW_AT_allocated:
30255 case DW_AT_associated:
30256 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
30257 if (prev == NULL && next == NULL)
30258 break;
30259 /* FALLTHRU */
30260 default:
30261 if (dwarf_strict)
30262 continue;
30263 break;
30265 /* Create DW_TAG_variable that we can refer to. */
30266 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL,
30267 lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl));
30268 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30269 if (ref)
30271 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30272 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30273 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30275 continue;
30277 if (prev)
30279 prev->dw_loc_next = l->expr;
30280 add_loc_descr (&prev->dw_loc_next, next);
30281 free_loc_descr (loc, NULL);
30282 next = prev->dw_loc_next;
30284 else
30286 memcpy (loc, l->expr, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
30287 add_loc_descr (&loc, next);
30288 next = loc;
30290 loc = prev;
30292 return false;
30295 /* Attempt to resolve DW_OP_GNU_variable_value using loc_list_from_tree. */
30297 static void
30298 resolve_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30300 dw_attr_node *a;
30301 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30302 unsigned ix;
30304 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30305 switch (AT_class (a))
30307 case dw_val_class_loc:
30308 if (!resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, AT_loc (a)))
30309 break;
30310 /* FALLTHRU */
30311 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30312 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30313 gcc_assert (loc);
30314 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30315 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, loc->expr);
30316 break;
30317 default:
30318 break;
30322 /* Attempt to optimize DW_OP_GNU_variable_value refering to
30323 temporaries in the current function. */
30325 static void
30326 resolve_variable_values (void)
30328 if (!variable_value_hash || !current_function_decl)
30329 return;
30331 struct variable_value_struct *node
30332 = variable_value_hash->find_with_hash (current_function_decl,
30333 DECL_UID (current_function_decl));
30335 if (node == NULL)
30336 return;
30338 unsigned int i;
30339 dw_die_ref die;
30340 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (node->dies, i, die)
30341 resolve_variable_value (die);
30344 /* Helper function for note_variable_value, handle one location
30345 expression. */
30347 static void
30348 note_variable_value_in_expr (dw_die_ref die, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
30350 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30351 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30352 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30354 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30355 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30356 if (! ref && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
30358 /* ??? This is somewhat a hack because we do not create DIEs
30359 for variables not in BLOCK trees early but when generating
30360 early LTO output we need the dw_val_class_decl_ref to be
30361 fully resolved. For fat LTO objects we'd also like to
30362 undo this after LTO dwarf output. */
30363 gcc_assert (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30364 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
30365 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL);
30366 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL, ctx);
30367 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30368 gcc_assert (ref != NULL);
30370 if (ref)
30372 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30373 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
30374 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30375 continue;
30377 if (VAR_P (decl)
30378 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
30379 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
30380 && lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)))
30382 if (!variable_value_hash)
30383 variable_value_hash
30384 = hash_table<variable_value_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30386 tree fndecl = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
30387 struct variable_value_struct *node;
30388 struct variable_value_struct **slot
30389 = variable_value_hash->find_slot_with_hash (fndecl,
30390 DECL_UID (fndecl),
30391 INSERT);
30392 if (*slot == NULL)
30394 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<variable_value_struct> ();
30395 node->decl_id = DECL_UID (fndecl);
30396 *slot = node;
30398 else
30399 node = *slot;
30401 vec_safe_push (node->dies, die);
30406 /* Walk the tree DIE and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30407 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30409 static void
30410 note_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
30412 dw_die_ref c;
30413 dw_attr_node *a;
30414 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
30415 unsigned ix;
30417 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30418 switch (AT_class (a))
30420 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30421 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
30422 gcc_assert (loc);
30423 if (!loc->noted_variable_value)
30425 loc->noted_variable_value = 1;
30426 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
30427 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, loc->expr);
30429 break;
30430 case dw_val_class_loc:
30431 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, AT_loc (a));
30432 break;
30433 default:
30434 break;
30437 /* Mark children. */
30438 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, note_variable_value (c));
30441 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
30442 has run. */
30444 static void
30445 dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *filename)
30447 set_early_dwarf s;
30449 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
30450 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
30451 and overwrite only here. */
30452 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
30453 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
30454 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30455 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
30457 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
30458 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
30459 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
30460 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
30462 /* When emitting DWARF5 .debug_line_str, move DW_AT_name and
30463 DW_AT_comp_dir into .debug_line_str section. */
30464 if (!DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
30465 && dwarf_version >= 5
30466 && DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
30468 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
30470 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (comp_unit_die (),
30471 i ? DW_AT_comp_dir : DW_AT_name);
30472 if (a == NULL
30473 || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_str
30474 || strlen (AT_string (a)) + 1 <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
30475 continue;
30477 if (! debug_line_str_hash)
30478 debug_line_str_hash
30479 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
30481 struct indirect_string_node *node
30482 = find_AT_string_in_table (AT_string (a), debug_line_str_hash);
30483 set_indirect_string (node);
30484 node->form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
30485 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
30486 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
30490 /* With LTO early dwarf was really finished at compile-time, so make
30491 sure to adjust the phase after annotating the LTRANS CU DIE. */
30492 if (in_lto_p)
30494 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30495 return;
30498 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
30499 emit full debugging info for them. */
30500 retry_incomplete_types ();
30502 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
30503 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
30504 flush_limbo_die_list ();
30506 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
30507 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
30509 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
30510 for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
30512 tree decl = node->created_for;
30513 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
30514 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
30515 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
30516 constant and never written to disk. */
30517 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
30519 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
30520 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
30523 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
30525 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
30526 prune_unused_types ();
30528 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
30529 if (use_debug_types)
30531 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
30533 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
30534 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
30535 limbo die list. */
30536 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30538 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
30539 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
30540 references to the main compile unit). */
30541 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30542 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30543 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
30544 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
30546 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
30547 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
30548 referenced. Prune them. */
30549 prune_unused_types ();
30552 /* Traverse the DIE's and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
30553 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
30554 note_variable_value (comp_unit_die ());
30555 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30556 note_variable_value (node->die);
30557 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL;
30558 ctnode = ctnode->next)
30559 note_variable_value (ctnode->root_die);
30560 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30561 note_variable_value (node->die);
30563 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
30564 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
30565 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
30566 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
30567 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
30568 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
30570 /* The early debug phase is now finished. */
30571 early_dwarf_finished = true;
30573 /* Do not generate DWARF assembler now when not producing LTO bytecode. */
30574 if (!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
30575 return;
30577 /* Now as we are going to output for LTO initialize sections and labels
30578 to the LTO variants. We don't need a random-seed postfix as other
30579 LTO sections as linking the LTO debug sections into one in a partial
30580 link is fine. */
30581 init_sections_and_labels (true);
30583 /* The output below is modeled after dwarf2out_finish with all
30584 location related output removed and some LTO specific changes.
30585 Some refactoring might make both smaller and easier to match up. */
30587 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
30588 that have children. */
30589 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
30590 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30591 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
30592 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30593 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30594 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
30596 if (have_macinfo)
30597 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
30598 macinfo_section_label);
30600 save_macinfo_strings ();
30602 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
30603 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
30604 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
30605 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
30607 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
30608 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
30609 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
30611 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
30613 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
30614 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
30615 continue;
30617 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
30618 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
30619 attributes. */
30620 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
30621 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
30622 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
30623 ? debug_line_section_label
30624 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
30626 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
30627 *slot = ctnode;
30630 /* Stick a unique symbol to the main debuginfo section. */
30631 compute_comp_unit_symbol (comp_unit_die ());
30633 /* Output the main compilation unit. We always need it if only for
30634 the CU symbol. */
30635 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), true, NULL);
30637 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
30638 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
30640 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
30641 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
30642 output_abbrev_section ();
30645 /* Have to end the macro section. */
30646 if (have_macinfo)
30648 /* We have to save macinfo state if we need to output it again
30649 for the FAT part of the object. */
30650 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *saved_macinfo_table = macinfo_table;
30651 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30652 macinfo_table = macinfo_table->copy ();
30654 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
30655 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
30656 output_macinfo (debug_skeleton_line_section_label, true);
30657 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
30659 /* Emit a skeleton debug_line section. */
30660 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
30661 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
30662 output_line_info (true);
30664 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
30666 vec_free (macinfo_table);
30667 macinfo_table = saved_macinfo_table;
30672 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
30673 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
30674 output_indirect_strings ();
30676 /* Switch back to the text section. */
30677 switch_to_section (text_section);
30680 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
30681 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
30683 void
30684 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
30686 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
30687 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
30688 used_rtx_array = NULL;
30689 incomplete_types = NULL;
30690 decl_scope_table = NULL;
30691 debug_info_section = NULL;
30692 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
30693 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
30694 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
30695 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
30696 debug_addr_section = NULL;
30697 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
30698 debug_line_section = NULL;
30699 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
30700 debug_loc_section = NULL;
30701 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
30702 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
30703 debug_str_section = NULL;
30704 debug_line_str_section = NULL;
30705 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
30706 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
30707 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
30708 debug_frame_section = NULL;
30709 fde_vec = NULL;
30710 debug_str_hash = NULL;
30711 debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
30712 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
30713 dw2_string_counter = 0;
30714 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
30715 text_section_used = false;
30716 cold_text_section_used = false;
30717 cold_text_section = NULL;
30718 current_unit_personality = NULL;
30720 early_dwarf = false;
30721 early_dwarf_finished = false;
30723 next_die_offset = 0;
30724 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
30725 comdat_type_list = NULL;
30726 limbo_die_list = NULL;
30727 file_table = NULL;
30728 decl_die_table = NULL;
30729 common_block_die_table = NULL;
30730 decl_loc_table = NULL;
30731 call_arg_locations = NULL;
30732 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
30733 call_site_count = -1;
30734 tail_call_site_count = -1;
30735 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
30736 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
30737 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
30738 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
30739 line_info_label_num = 0;
30740 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
30741 text_section_line_info = NULL;
30742 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
30743 separate_line_info = NULL;
30744 info_section_emitted = false;
30745 pubname_table = NULL;
30746 pubtype_table = NULL;
30747 macinfo_table = NULL;
30748 ranges_table = NULL;
30749 ranges_by_label = NULL;
30750 rnglist_idx = 0;
30751 have_location_lists = false;
30752 loclabel_num = 0;
30753 poc_label_num = 0;
30754 last_emitted_file = NULL;
30755 label_num = 0;
30756 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
30757 generic_type_instances = NULL;
30758 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
30759 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
30760 base_types.release ();
30761 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
30762 producer_string = NULL;
30765 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"